diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'doc/classes')
187 files changed, 2334 insertions, 2281 deletions
diff --git a/doc/classes/@GlobalScope.xml b/doc/classes/@GlobalScope.xml index 41836650cd..3b2e260dcb 100644 --- a/doc/classes/@GlobalScope.xml +++ b/doc/classes/@GlobalScope.xml @@ -442,9 +442,14 @@ <param index="0" name="variable" type="Variant" /> <description> Returns the integer hash of the passed [param variable]. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] print(hash("a")) # Prints 177670 - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.Print(GD.Hash("a")); // Prints 177670 + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="instance_from_id"> @@ -452,13 +457,29 @@ <param index="0" name="instance_id" type="int" /> <description> Returns the [Object] that corresponds to [param instance_id]. All Objects have a unique instance ID. See also [method Object.get_instance_id]. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] var foo = "bar" + func _ready(): var id = get_instance_id() var inst = instance_from_id(id) print(inst.foo) # Prints bar - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + public partial class MyNode : Node + { + public string Foo { get; set; } = "bar"; + + public override void _Ready() + { + ulong id = GetInstanceId(); + var inst = (MyNode)InstanceFromId(Id); + GD.Print(inst.Foo); // Prints bar + } + } + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="inverse_lerp"> @@ -494,7 +515,7 @@ <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="x" type="float" /> <description> - Returns whether [code]x[/code] is a finite value, i.e. it is not [constant @GDScript.NAN], positive infinity, or negative infinity. + Returns whether [param x] is a finite value, i.e. it is not [constant @GDScript.NAN], positive infinity, or negative infinity. </description> </method> <method name="is_inf"> @@ -525,11 +546,36 @@ Returns [code]true[/code] if [param x] is a NaN ("Not a Number" or invalid) value. </description> </method> + <method name="is_same"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="a" type="Variant" /> + <param index="1" name="b" type="Variant" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code], for value types, if [param a] and [param b] share the same value. Returns [code]true[/code], for reference types, if the references of [param a] and [param b] are the same. + [codeblock] + # Vector2 is a value type + var vec2_a = Vector2(0, 0) + var vec2_b = Vector2(0, 0) + var vec2_c = Vector2(1, 1) + is_same(vec2_a, vec2_a) # true + is_same(vec2_a, vec2_b) # true + is_same(vec2_a, vec2_c) # false + + # Array is a reference type + var arr_a = [] + var arr_b = [] + is_same(arr_a, arr_a) # true + is_same(arr_a, arr_b) # false + [/codeblock] + These are [Variant] value types: [code]null[/code], [bool], [int], [float], [String], [StringName], [Vector2], [Vector2i], [Vector3], [Vector3i], [Vector4], [Vector4i], [Rect2], [Rect2i], [Transform2D], [Transform3D], [Plane], [Quaternion], [AABB], [Basis], [Projection], [Color], [NodePath], [RID], [Callable] and [Signal]. + These are [Variant] reference types: [Object], [Dictionary], [Array], [PackedByteArray], [PackedInt32Array], [PackedInt64Array], [PackedFloat32Array], [PackedFloat64Array], [PackedStringArray], [PackedVector2Array], [PackedVector3Array] and [PackedColorArray]. + </description> + </method> <method name="is_zero_approx"> <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="x" type="float" /> <description> - Returns [code]true[/code] if [param x] is zero or almost zero. + Returns [code]true[/code] if [param x] is zero or almost zero. The comparison is done using a tolerance calculation with a small internal epsilon. This function is faster than using [method is_equal_approx] with one value as zero. </description> </method> @@ -764,10 +810,16 @@ <method name="print" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Converts one or more arguments of any type to string in the best way possible and prints them to the console. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] var a = [1, 2, 3] print("a", "b", a) # Prints ab[1, 2, 3] - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + var a = new Godot.Collections.Array { 1, 2, 3 }; + GD.Print("a", "b", a); // Prints ab[1, 2, 3] + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] Consider using [method push_error] and [method push_warning] to print error and warning messages instead of [method print] or [method print_rich]. This distinguishes them from print messages used for debugging purposes, while also displaying a stack trace when an error or warning is printed. </description> </method> @@ -775,9 +827,14 @@ <description> Converts one or more arguments of any type to string in the best way possible and prints them to the console. The following BBCode tags are supported: b, i, u, s, indent, code, url, center, right, color, bgcolor, fgcolor. Color tags only support named colors such as [code]red[/code], [i]not[/i] hexadecimal color codes. Unsupported tags will be left as-is in standard output. When printing to standard output, the supported subset of BBCode is converted to ANSI escape codes for the terminal emulator to display. Displaying ANSI escape codes is currently only supported on Linux and macOS. Support for ANSI escape codes may vary across terminal emulators, especially for italic and strikethrough. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] print_rich("[code][b]Hello world![/b][/code]") # Prints out: [b]Hello world![/b] - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PrintRich("[code][b]Hello world![/b][/code]"); // Prints out: [b]Hello world![/b] + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] Consider using [method push_error] and [method push_warning] to print error and warning messages instead of [method print] or [method print_rich]. This distinguishes them from print messages used for debugging purposes, while also displaying a stack trace when an error or warning is printed. </description> </method> @@ -789,53 +846,86 @@ <method name="printerr" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Prints one or more arguments to strings in the best way possible to standard error line. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] printerr("prints to stderr") - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PrintErr("prints to stderr"); + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="printraw" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Prints one or more arguments to strings in the best way possible to the OS terminal. Unlike [method print], no newline is automatically added at the end. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] printraw("A") printraw("B") printraw("C") # Prints ABC to terminal - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PrintRaw("A"); + GD.PrintRaw("B"); + GD.PrintRaw("C"); + // Prints ABC to terminal + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="prints" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Prints one or more arguments to the console with a space between each argument. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] prints("A", "B", "C") # Prints A B C - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PrintS("A", "B", "C"); // Prints A B C + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="printt" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Prints one or more arguments to the console with a tab between each argument. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] printt("A", "B", "C") # Prints A B C - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PrintT("A", "B", "C"); // Prints A B C + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="push_error" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Pushes an error message to Godot's built-in debugger and to the OS terminal. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] push_error("test error") # Prints "test error" to debugger and terminal as error call - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PushError("test error"); // Prints "test error" to debugger and terminal as error call + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] This function does not pause project execution. To print an error message and pause project execution in debug builds, use [code]assert(false, "test error")[/code] instead. </description> </method> <method name="push_warning" qualifiers="vararg"> <description> Pushes a warning message to Godot's built-in debugger and to the OS terminal. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] push_warning("test warning") # Prints "test warning" to debugger and terminal as warning call - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.PushWarning("test warning"); // Prints "test warning" to debugger and terminal as warning call + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="rad_to_deg"> @@ -868,9 +958,14 @@ <return type="float" /> <description> Returns a random floating point value between [code]0.0[/code] and [code]1.0[/code] (inclusive). - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] randf() # Returns e.g. 0.375671 - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.Randf(); // Returns e.g. 0.375671 + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="randf_range"> @@ -879,10 +974,16 @@ <param index="1" name="to" type="float" /> <description> Returns a random floating point value between [param from] and [param to] (inclusive). - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] randf_range(0, 20.5) # Returns e.g. 7.45315 randf_range(-10, 10) # Returns e.g. -3.844535 - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.RandRange(0.0, 20.5); // Returns e.g. 7.45315 + GD.RandRange(-10.0, 10.0); // Returns e.g. -3.844535 + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="randfn"> @@ -897,12 +998,20 @@ <return type="int" /> <description> Returns a random unsigned 32-bit integer. Use remainder to obtain a random value in the interval [code][0, N - 1][/code] (where N is smaller than 2^32). - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] randi() # Returns random integer between 0 and 2^32 - 1 randi() % 20 # Returns random integer between 0 and 19 randi() % 100 # Returns random integer between 0 and 99 randi() % 100 + 1 # Returns random integer between 1 and 100 - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.Randi(); // Returns random integer between 0 and 2^32 - 1 + GD.Randi() % 20; // Returns random integer between 0 and 19 + GD.Randi() % 100; // Returns random integer between 0 and 99 + GD.Randi() % 100 + 1; // Returns random integer between 1 and 100 + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="randi_range"> @@ -911,10 +1020,16 @@ <param index="1" name="to" type="int" /> <description> Returns a random signed 32-bit integer between [param from] and [param to] (inclusive). If [param to] is lesser than [param from], they are swapped. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] randi_range(0, 1) # Returns either 0 or 1 randi_range(-10, 1000) # Returns random integer between -10 and 1000 - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.RandRange(0, 1); // Returns either 0 or 1 + GD.RandRange(-10, 1000); // Returns random integer between -10 and 1000 + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="randomize"> @@ -985,14 +1100,24 @@ <param index="0" name="base" type="int" /> <description> Sets the seed for the random number generator to [param base]. Setting the seed manually can ensure consistent, repeatable results for most random functions. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] var my_seed = "Godot Rocks".hash() seed(my_seed) var a = randf() + randi() seed(my_seed) var b = randf() + randi() # a and b are now identical - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + ulong mySeed = (ulong)GD.Hash("Godot Rocks"); + GD.Seed(mySeed); + var a = GD.Randf() + GD.Randi(); + GD.Seed(mySeed); + var b = GD.Randf() + GD.Randi(); + // a and b are now identical + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="sign"> @@ -1146,7 +1271,13 @@ <method name="str" qualifiers="vararg"> <return type="String" /> <description> - Converts one or more arguments of any [Variant] type to [String] in the best way possible. + Converts one or more arguments of any [Variant] type to a [String] in the best way possible. + [codeblock] + var a = [10, 20, 30] + var b = str(a) + print(len(a)) # Prints 3 (the number of elements in the array). + print(len(b)) # Prints 12 (the length of the string "[10, 20, 30]"). + [/codeblock] </description> </method> <method name="str_to_var"> @@ -1154,11 +1285,18 @@ <param index="0" name="string" type="String" /> <description> Converts a formatted [param string] that was returned by [method var_to_str] to the original [Variant]. - [codeblock] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] var a = '{ "a": 1, "b": 2 }' # a is a String var b = str_to_var(a) # b is a Dictionary print(b["a"]) # Prints 1 - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + string a = "{ \"a\": 1, \"b\": 2 }"; // a is a string + var b = GD.StrToVar(a).AsGodotDictionary(); // b is a Dictionary + GD.Print(b["a"]); // Prints 1 + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="tan"> @@ -1218,15 +1356,21 @@ <param index="0" name="variable" type="Variant" /> <description> Converts a [Variant] [param variable] to a formatted [String] that can then be parsed using [method str_to_var]. - [codeblock] - a = { "a": 1, "b": 2 } + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + var a = { "a": 1, "b": 2 } print(var_to_str(a)) - [/codeblock] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + var a = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary { ["a"] = 1, ["b"] = 2 }; + GD.Print(GD.VarToStr(a)); + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] Prints: [codeblock] { - "a": 1, - "b": 2 + "a": 1, + "b": 2 } [/codeblock] </description> @@ -1767,30 +1911,15 @@ <constant name="KEY_KP_9" value="4194447" enum="Key"> Number 9 on the numeric keypad. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_SUPER_L" value="4194368" enum="Key"> - Left Super key (Windows key). - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_SUPER_R" value="4194369" enum="Key"> - Right Super key (Windows key). - </constant> <constant name="KEY_MENU" value="4194370" enum="Key"> Context menu key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_HYPER_L" value="4194371" enum="Key"> - Left Hyper key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_HYPER_R" value="4194372" enum="Key"> - Right Hyper key. + <constant name="KEY_HYPER" value="4194371" enum="Key"> + Hyper key. (On Linux/X11 only). </constant> <constant name="KEY_HELP" value="4194373" enum="Key"> Help key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_DIRECTION_L" value="4194374" enum="Key"> - Left Direction key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_DIRECTION_R" value="4194375" enum="Key"> - Right Direction key. - </constant> <constant name="KEY_BACK" value="4194376" enum="Key"> Media back key. Not to be confused with the Back button on an Android device. </constant> @@ -1812,21 +1941,6 @@ <constant name="KEY_VOLUMEUP" value="4194382" enum="Key"> Volume up key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_BASSBOOST" value="4194383" enum="Key"> - Bass Boost key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_BASSUP" value="4194384" enum="Key"> - Bass up key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_BASSDOWN" value="4194385" enum="Key"> - Bass down key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_TREBLEUP" value="4194386" enum="Key"> - Treble up key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_TREBLEDOWN" value="4194387" enum="Key"> - Treble down key. - </constant> <constant name="KEY_MEDIAPLAY" value="4194388" enum="Key"> Media play key. </constant> @@ -1911,7 +2025,7 @@ <constant name="KEY_LAUNCHF" value="4194415" enum="Key"> Launch Shortcut F key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_UNKNOWN" value="16777215" enum="Key"> + <constant name="KEY_UNKNOWN" value="8388607" enum="Key"> Unknown key. </constant> <constant name="KEY_SPACE" value="32" enum="Key"> @@ -2121,203 +2235,23 @@ <constant name="KEY_ASCIITILDE" value="126" enum="Key"> ~ key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_NOBREAKSPACE" value="160" enum="Key"> - Non-breakable space key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_EXCLAMDOWN" value="161" enum="Key"> - ¡ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_CENT" value="162" enum="Key"> - ¢ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_STERLING" value="163" enum="Key"> - £ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_CURRENCY" value="164" enum="Key"> - ¤ key. - </constant> <constant name="KEY_YEN" value="165" enum="Key"> ¥ key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_BROKENBAR" value="166" enum="Key"> - ¦ key. - </constant> <constant name="KEY_SECTION" value="167" enum="Key"> § key. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_DIAERESIS" value="168" enum="Key"> - ¨ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_COPYRIGHT" value="169" enum="Key"> - © key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ORDFEMININE" value="170" enum="Key"> - ª key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_GUILLEMOTLEFT" value="171" enum="Key"> - « key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_NOTSIGN" value="172" enum="Key"> - ¬ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_HYPHEN" value="173" enum="Key"> - Soft hyphen key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_REGISTERED" value="174" enum="Key"> - ® key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_MACRON" value="175" enum="Key"> - ¯ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_DEGREE" value="176" enum="Key"> - ° key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_PLUSMINUS" value="177" enum="Key"> - ± key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_TWOSUPERIOR" value="178" enum="Key"> - ² key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_THREESUPERIOR" value="179" enum="Key"> - ³ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ACUTE" value="180" enum="Key"> - ´ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_MU" value="181" enum="Key"> - µ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_PARAGRAPH" value="182" enum="Key"> - ¶ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_PERIODCENTERED" value="183" enum="Key"> - · key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_CEDILLA" value="184" enum="Key"> - ¸ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ONESUPERIOR" value="185" enum="Key"> - ¹ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_MASCULINE" value="186" enum="Key"> - º key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_GUILLEMOTRIGHT" value="187" enum="Key"> - » key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ONEQUARTER" value="188" enum="Key"> - ¼ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ONEHALF" value="189" enum="Key"> - ½ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_THREEQUARTERS" value="190" enum="Key"> - ¾ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_QUESTIONDOWN" value="191" enum="Key"> - ¿ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_AGRAVE" value="192" enum="Key"> - À key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_AACUTE" value="193" enum="Key"> - Á key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ACIRCUMFLEX" value="194" enum="Key"> - Â key. + <constant name="KEY_GLOBE" value="4194416" enum="Key"> + "Globe" key on Mac / iPad keyboard. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ATILDE" value="195" enum="Key"> - Ã key. + <constant name="KEY_KEYBOARD" value="4194417" enum="Key"> + "On-screen keyboard" key iPad keyboard. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ADIAERESIS" value="196" enum="Key"> - Ä key. + <constant name="KEY_JIS_EISU" value="4194418" enum="Key"> + 英数 key on Mac keyboard. </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ARING" value="197" enum="Key"> - Å key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_AE" value="198" enum="Key"> - Æ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_CCEDILLA" value="199" enum="Key"> - Ç key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_EGRAVE" value="200" enum="Key"> - È key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_EACUTE" value="201" enum="Key"> - É key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ECIRCUMFLEX" value="202" enum="Key"> - Ê key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_EDIAERESIS" value="203" enum="Key"> - Ë key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_IGRAVE" value="204" enum="Key"> - Ì key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_IACUTE" value="205" enum="Key"> - Í key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ICIRCUMFLEX" value="206" enum="Key"> - Î key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_IDIAERESIS" value="207" enum="Key"> - Ï key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ETH" value="208" enum="Key"> - Ð key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_NTILDE" value="209" enum="Key"> - Ñ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_OGRAVE" value="210" enum="Key"> - Ò key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_OACUTE" value="211" enum="Key"> - Ó key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_OCIRCUMFLEX" value="212" enum="Key"> - Ô key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_OTILDE" value="213" enum="Key"> - Õ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_ODIAERESIS" value="214" enum="Key"> - Ö key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_MULTIPLY" value="215" enum="Key"> - × key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_OOBLIQUE" value="216" enum="Key"> - Ø key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_UGRAVE" value="217" enum="Key"> - Ù key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_UACUTE" value="218" enum="Key"> - Ú key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_UCIRCUMFLEX" value="219" enum="Key"> - Û key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_UDIAERESIS" value="220" enum="Key"> - Ü key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_YACUTE" value="221" enum="Key"> - Ý key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_THORN" value="222" enum="Key"> - Þ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_SSHARP" value="223" enum="Key"> - ß key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_DIVISION" value="247" enum="Key"> - ÷ key. - </constant> - <constant name="KEY_YDIAERESIS" value="255" enum="Key"> - ÿ key. + <constant name="KEY_JIS_KANA" value="4194419" enum="Key"> + かな key on Mac keyboard. </constant> <constant name="KEY_CODE_MASK" value="8388607" enum="KeyModifierMask" is_bitfield="true"> Key Code mask. @@ -2719,7 +2653,7 @@ Additionally, other keywords can be included: [code]"exp"[/code] for exponential range editing, [code]"radians"[/code] for editing radian angles in degrees, [code]"degrees"[/code] to hint at an angle and [code]"hide_slider"[/code] to hide the slider. </constant> <constant name="PROPERTY_HINT_ENUM" value="2" enum="PropertyHint"> - Hints that an [int], [float], or [String] property is an enumerated value to pick in a list specified via a hint string. + Hints that an [int] or [String] property is an enumerated value to pick in a list specified via a hint string. The hint string is a comma separated list of names such as [code]"Hello,Something,Else"[/code]. Whitespaces are [b]not[/b] removed from either end of a name. For integer and float properties, the first name in the list has value 0, the next 1, and so on. Explicit values can also be specified by appending [code]:integer[/code] to the name, e.g. [code]"Zero,One,Three:3,Four,Six:6"[/code]. </constant> <constant name="PROPERTY_HINT_ENUM_SUGGESTION" value="3" enum="PropertyHint"> @@ -2874,25 +2808,28 @@ <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_ARRAY" value="262144" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> The property is an array. </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_DO_NOT_SHARE_ON_DUPLICATE" value="524288" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> - If the property is a [Resource], a new copy of it is always created when calling [method Node.duplicate] or [method Resource.duplicate]. + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_ALWAYS_DUPLICATE" value="524288" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + When duplicating a resource with [method Resource.duplicate], and this flag is set on a property of that resource, the property should always be duplicated, regardless of the [code]subresources[/code] bool parameter. + </constant> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_NEVER_DUPLICATE" value="1048576" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + When duplicating a resource with [method Resource.duplicate], and this flag is set on a property of that resource, the property should never be duplicated, regardless of the [code]subresources[/code] bool parameter. </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_HIGH_END_GFX" value="1048576" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_HIGH_END_GFX" value="2097152" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> The property is only shown in the editor if modern renderers are supported (GLES3 is excluded). </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_NODE_PATH_FROM_SCENE_ROOT" value="2097152" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_NODE_PATH_FROM_SCENE_ROOT" value="4194304" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_RESOURCE_NOT_PERSISTENT" value="4194304" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_RESOURCE_NOT_PERSISTENT" value="8388608" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_KEYING_INCREMENTS" value="8388608" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_KEYING_INCREMENTS" value="16777216" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_DEFERRED_SET_RESOURCE" value="16777216" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_DEFERRED_SET_RESOURCE" value="33554432" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_EDITOR_INSTANTIATE_OBJECT" value="33554432" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_EDITOR_INSTANTIATE_OBJECT" value="67108864" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_EDITOR_BASIC_SETTING" value="67108864" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_EDITOR_BASIC_SETTING" value="134217728" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> - <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_READ_ONLY" value="134217728" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> + <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_READ_ONLY" value="268435456" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> The property is read-only in the [EditorInspector]. </constant> <constant name="PROPERTY_USAGE_DEFAULT" value="6" enum="PropertyUsageFlags" is_bitfield="true"> diff --git a/doc/classes/AABB.xml b/doc/classes/AABB.xml index ca454cafa3..2c5337eea3 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AABB.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AABB.xml @@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // position (-3, 2, 0), size (1, 1, 1) - var box = new AABB(new Vector3(-3, 2, 0), new Vector3(1, 1, 1)); + var box = new Aabb(new Vector3(-3, 2, 0), new Vector3(1, 1, 1)); // position (-3, -1, 0), size (3, 4, 2), so we fit both the original AABB and Vector3(0, -1, 2) var box2 = box.Expand(new Vector3(0, -1, 2)); [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/AESContext.xml b/doc/classes/AESContext.xml index 7f582e4be7..747968ea91 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AESContext.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AESContext.xml @@ -39,39 +39,38 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; using System.Diagnostics; - public class Example : Node + public partial class MyNode : Node { - public AESContext Aes = new AESContext(); + private AesContext _aes = new AesContext(); public override void _Ready() { string key = "My secret key!!!"; // Key must be either 16 or 32 bytes. string data = "My secret text!!"; // Data size must be multiple of 16 bytes, apply padding if needed. // Encrypt ECB - Aes.Start(AESContext.Mode.EcbEncrypt, key.ToUTF8()); - byte[] encrypted = Aes.Update(data.ToUTF8()); - Aes.Finish(); + _aes.Start(AesContext.Mode.EcbEncrypt, key.ToUtf8()); + byte[] encrypted = _aes.Update(data.ToUtf8()); + _aes.Finish(); // Decrypt ECB - Aes.Start(AESContext.Mode.EcbDecrypt, key.ToUTF8()); - byte[] decrypted = Aes.Update(encrypted); - Aes.Finish(); + _aes.Start(AesContext.Mode.EcbDecrypt, key.ToUtf8()); + byte[] decrypted = _aes.Update(encrypted); + _aes.Finish(); // Check ECB - Debug.Assert(decrypted == data.ToUTF8()); + Debug.Assert(decrypted == data.ToUtf8()); string iv = "My secret iv!!!!"; // IV must be of exactly 16 bytes. // Encrypt CBC - Aes.Start(AESContext.Mode.EcbEncrypt, key.ToUTF8(), iv.ToUTF8()); - encrypted = Aes.Update(data.ToUTF8()); - Aes.Finish(); + _aes.Start(AesContext.Mode.EcbEncrypt, key.ToUtf8(), iv.ToUtf8()); + encrypted = _aes.Update(data.ToUtf8()); + _aes.Finish(); // Decrypt CBC - Aes.Start(AESContext.Mode.EcbDecrypt, key.ToUTF8(), iv.ToUTF8()); - decrypted = Aes.Update(encrypted); - Aes.Finish(); + _aes.Start(AesContext.Mode.EcbDecrypt, key.ToUtf8(), iv.ToUtf8()); + decrypted = _aes.Update(encrypted); + _aes.Finish(); // Check CBC - Debug.Assert(decrypted == data.ToUTF8()); + Debug.Assert(decrypted == data.ToUtf8()); } } [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/AStar3D.xml b/doc/classes/AStar3D.xml index 4e8394195d..f0481c1745 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AStar3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AStar3D.xml @@ -19,15 +19,16 @@ return min(0, abs(u - v) - 1) [/gdscript] [csharp] - public class MyAStar : AStar3D + public partial class MyAStar : AStar3D { - public override float _ComputeCost(int u, int v) + public override float _ComputeCost(long fromId, long toId) { - return Mathf.Abs(u - v); + return Mathf.Abs((int)(fromId - toId)); } - public override float _EstimateCost(int u, int v) + + public override float _EstimateCost(long fromId, long toId) { - return Mathf.Min(0, Mathf.Abs(u - v) - 1); + return Mathf.Min(0, Mathf.Abs((int)(fromId - toId)) - 1); } } [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/AStarGrid2D.xml b/doc/classes/AStarGrid2D.xml index 32599d7f7d..b253a33377 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AStarGrid2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AStarGrid2D.xml @@ -17,11 +17,11 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] AStarGrid2D astarGrid = new AStarGrid2D(); - astarGrid.Size = new Vector2i(32, 32); - astarGrid.CellSize = new Vector2i(16, 16); + astarGrid.Size = new Vector2I(32, 32); + astarGrid.CellSize = new Vector2I(16, 16); astarGrid.Update(); - GD.Print(astarGrid.GetIdPath(Vector2i.Zero, new Vector2i(3, 4))); // prints (0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (3, 4) - GD.Print(astarGrid.GetPointPath(Vector2i.Zero, new Vector2i(3, 4))); // prints (0, 0), (16, 16), (32, 32), (48, 48), (48, 64) + GD.Print(astarGrid.GetIdPath(Vector2I.Zero, new Vector2I(3, 4))); // prints (0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (3, 4) + GD.Print(astarGrid.GetPointPath(Vector2I.Zero, new Vector2I(3, 4))); // prints (0, 0), (16, 16), (32, 32), (48, 48), (48, 64) [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/AcceptDialog.xml b/doc/classes/AcceptDialog.xml index 4da9e41ca8..c0e5d6ad07 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AcceptDialog.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AcceptDialog.xml @@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="button" type="Control" /> <description> - Removes the [param button] from the dialog. Does NOT free the [param button]. The [param button] must be a [Button] added with [method add_button] or [method add_cancel_button] method. After removal, pressing the [param button] will no longer emit this dialog's [signal custom_action] or [signal cancelled] signals. + Removes the [param button] from the dialog. Does NOT free the [param button]. The [param button] must be a [Button] added with [method add_button] or [method add_cancel_button] method. After removal, pressing the [param button] will no longer emit this dialog's [signal custom_action] or [signal canceled] signals. </description> </method> </methods> @@ -81,7 +81,7 @@ <member name="wrap_controls" type="bool" setter="set_wrap_controls" getter="is_wrapping_controls" overrides="Window" default="true" /> </members> <signals> - <signal name="cancelled"> + <signal name="canceled"> <description> Emitted when the dialog is closed or the button created with [method add_cancel_button] is pressed. </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimatableBody3D.xml b/doc/classes/AnimatableBody3D.xml index 2a08c4c8f1..0733780bf7 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimatableBody3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimatableBody3D.xml @@ -7,6 +7,7 @@ Animatable body for 3D physics. An animatable body can't be moved by external forces or contacts, but can be moved by script or animation to affect other bodies in its path. It is ideal for implementing moving objects in the environment, such as moving platforms or doors. When the body is moved manually, either from code or from an [AnimationPlayer] (with [member AnimationPlayer.playback_process_mode] set to [code]physics[/code]), the physics will automatically compute an estimate of their linear and angular velocity. This makes them very useful for moving platforms or other AnimationPlayer-controlled objects (like a door, a bridge that opens, etc). + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="3D Physics Tests Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/675</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite2D.xml b/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite2D.xml index e20fb71c7e..9872c59990 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite2D.xml @@ -5,35 +5,82 @@ </brief_description> <description> [AnimatedSprite2D] is similar to the [Sprite2D] node, except it carries multiple textures as animation frames. Animations are created using a [SpriteFrames] resource, which allows you to import image files (or a folder containing said files) to provide the animation frames for the sprite. The [SpriteFrames] resource can be configured in the editor via the SpriteFrames bottom panel. - After setting up [member frames], [method play] may be called. It's also possible to select an [member animation] and toggle [member playing], even within the editor. - To pause the current animation, set [member playing] to [code]false[/code]. Alternatively, setting [member speed_scale] to [code]0[/code] also preserves the current frame's elapsed time. - [b]Note:[/b] You can associate a set of normal or specular maps by creating additional [SpriteFrames] resources with a [code]_normal[/code] or [code]_specular[/code] suffix. For example, having 3 [SpriteFrames] resources [code]run[/code], [code]run_normal[/code], and [code]run_specular[/code] will make it so the [code]run[/code] animation uses normal and specular maps. </description> <tutorials> <link title="2D Sprite animation">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/2d/2d_sprite_animation.html</link> <link title="2D Dodge The Creeps Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/515</link> </tutorials> <methods> + <method name="get_playing_speed" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="float" /> + <description> + Returns the actual playing speed of current animation or [code]0[/code] if not playing. This speed is the [member speed_scale] property multiplied by [code]custom_speed[/code] argument specified when calling the [method play] method. + Returns a negative value if the current animation is playing backwards. + </description> + </method> + <method name="is_playing" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if an animation is currently playing (even if [member speed_scale] and/or [code]custom_speed[/code] are [code]0[/code]). + </description> + </method> + <method name="pause"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Pauses the currently playing animation. The [member frame] and [member frame_progress] will be kept and calling [method play] or [method play_backwards] without arguments will resume the animation from the current playback position. + See also [method stop]. + </description> + </method> <method name="play"> <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" default="&""" /> - <param index="1" name="backwards" type="bool" default="false" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" default="&""" /> + <param index="1" name="custom_speed" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="2" name="from_end" type="bool" default="false" /> + <description> + Plays the animation with key [param name]. If [param custom_speed] is negative and [param from_end] is [code]true[/code], the animation will play backwards (which is equivalent to calling [method play_backwards]). + If this method is called with that same animation [param name], or with no [param name] parameter, the assigned animation will resume playing if it was paused. + </description> + </method> + <method name="play_backwards"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" default="&""" /> + <description> + Plays the animation with key [param name] in reverse. + This method is a shorthand for [method play] with [code]custom_speed = -1.0[/code] and [code]from_end = true[/code], so see its description for more information. + </description> + </method> + <method name="set_frame_and_progress"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="frame" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="progress" type="float" /> <description> - Plays the animation named [param anim]. If no [param anim] is provided, the current animation is played. If [param backwards] is [code]true[/code], the animation is played in reverse. - [b]Note:[/b] If [member speed_scale] is negative, the animation direction specified by [param backwards] will be inverted. + The setter of [member frame] resets the [member frame_progress] to [code]0.0[/code] implicitly, but this method avoids that. + This is useful when you want to carry over the current [member frame_progress] to another [member frame]. + [b]Example:[/b] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + # Change the animation with keeping the frame index and progress. + var current_frame = animated_sprite.get_frame() + var current_progress = animated_sprite.get_frame_progress() + animated_sprite.play("walk_another_skin") + animated_sprite.set_frame_and_progress(current_frame, current_progress) + [/gdscript] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="stop"> <return type="void" /> <description> - Stops the current [member animation] at the current [member frame]. - [b]Note:[/b] This method resets the current frame's elapsed time and removes the [code]backwards[/code] flag from the current [member animation] (if it was previously set by [method play]). If this behavior is undesired, set [member playing] to [code]false[/code] instead. + Stops the currently playing animation. The animation position is reset to [code]0[/code] and the [code]custom_speed[/code] is reset to [code]1.0[/code]. See also [method pause]. </description> </method> </methods> <members> <member name="animation" type="StringName" setter="set_animation" getter="get_animation" default="&"default""> - The current animation from the [member frames] resource. If this value changes, the [code]frame[/code] counter is reset. + The current animation from the [member sprite_frames] resource. If this value is changed, the [member frame] counter and the [member frame_progress] are reset. + </member> + <member name="autoplay" type="String" setter="set_autoplay" getter="get_autoplay" default=""""> + The key of the animation to play when the scene loads. </member> <member name="centered" type="bool" setter="set_centered" getter="is_centered" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], texture will be centered. @@ -45,32 +92,46 @@ If [code]true[/code], texture is flipped vertically. </member> <member name="frame" type="int" setter="set_frame" getter="get_frame" default="0"> - The displayed animation frame's index. + The displayed animation frame's index. Setting this property also resets [member frame_progress]. If this is not desired, use [method set_frame_and_progress]. </member> - <member name="frames" type="SpriteFrames" setter="set_sprite_frames" getter="get_sprite_frames"> - The [SpriteFrames] resource containing the animation(s). Allows you the option to load, edit, clear, make unique and save the states of the [SpriteFrames] resource. + <member name="frame_progress" type="float" setter="set_frame_progress" getter="get_frame_progress" default="0.0"> + The progress value between [code]0.0[/code] and [code]1.0[/code] until the current frame transitions to the next frame. If the animation is playing backwards, the value transitions from [code]1.0[/code] to [code]0.0[/code]. </member> <member name="offset" type="Vector2" setter="set_offset" getter="get_offset" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> The texture's drawing offset. </member> - <member name="playing" type="bool" setter="set_playing" getter="is_playing" default="false"> - If [code]true[/code], the [member animation] is currently playing. Setting this property to [code]false[/code] pauses the current animation. Use [method stop] to stop the animation at the current frame instead. - [b]Note:[/b] Unlike [method stop], changing this property to [code]false[/code] preserves the current frame's elapsed time and the [code]backwards[/code] flag of the current [member animation] (if it was previously set by [method play]). - [b]Note:[/b] After a non-looping animation finishes, the property still remains [code]true[/code]. - </member> <member name="speed_scale" type="float" setter="set_speed_scale" getter="get_speed_scale" default="1.0"> - The animation speed is multiplied by this value. If set to a negative value, the animation is played in reverse. If set to [code]0[/code], the animation is paused, preserving the current frame's elapsed time. + The speed scaling ratio. For example, if this value is [code]1[/code], then the animation plays at normal speed. If it's [code]0.5[/code], then it plays at half speed. If it's [code]2[/code], then it plays at double speed. + If set to a negative value, the animation is played in reverse. If set to [code]0[/code], the animation will not advance. + </member> + <member name="sprite_frames" type="SpriteFrames" setter="set_sprite_frames" getter="get_sprite_frames"> + The [SpriteFrames] resource containing the animation(s). Allows you the option to load, edit, clear, make unique and save the states of the [SpriteFrames] resource. </member> </members> <signals> + <signal name="animation_changed"> + <description> + Emitted when [member animation] changes. + </description> + </signal> <signal name="animation_finished"> <description> - Emitted when the animation reaches the end, or the start if it is played in reverse. If the animation is looping, this signal is emitted at the end of each loop. + Emitted when the animation reaches the end, or the start if it is played in reverse. When the animation finishes, it pauses the playback. + </description> + </signal> + <signal name="animation_looped"> + <description> + Emitted when the animation loops. </description> </signal> <signal name="frame_changed"> <description> - Emitted when [member frame] changed. + Emitted when [member frame] changes. + </description> + </signal> + <signal name="sprite_frames_changed"> + <description> + Emitted when [member sprite_frames] changes. </description> </signal> </signals> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite3D.xml b/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite3D.xml index 4837ae715f..c39bb99827 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimatedSprite3D.xml @@ -4,59 +4,121 @@ 2D sprite node in 3D world, that can use multiple 2D textures for animation. </brief_description> <description> - [AnimatedSprite3D] is similar to the [Sprite3D] node, except it carries multiple textures as animation [member frames]. Animations are created using a [SpriteFrames] resource, which allows you to import image files (or a folder containing said files) to provide the animation frames for the sprite. The [SpriteFrames] resource can be configured in the editor via the SpriteFrames bottom panel. - After setting up [member frames], [method play] may be called. It's also possible to select an [member animation] and toggle [member playing], even within the editor. - To pause the current animation, set [member playing] to [code]false[/code]. Alternatively, setting [member speed_scale] to [code]0[/code] also preserves the current frame's elapsed time. + [AnimatedSprite3D] is similar to the [Sprite3D] node, except it carries multiple textures as animation [member sprite_frames]. Animations are created using a [SpriteFrames] resource, which allows you to import image files (or a folder containing said files) to provide the animation frames for the sprite. The [SpriteFrames] resource can be configured in the editor via the SpriteFrames bottom panel. </description> <tutorials> <link title="2D Sprite animation (also applies to 3D)">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/2d/2d_sprite_animation.html</link> </tutorials> <methods> + <method name="get_playing_speed" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="float" /> + <description> + Returns the actual playing speed of current animation or [code]0[/code] if not playing. This speed is the [member speed_scale] property multiplied by [code]custom_speed[/code] argument specified when calling the [method play] method. + Returns a negative value if the current animation is playing backwards. + </description> + </method> + <method name="is_playing" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if an animation is currently playing (even if [member speed_scale] and/or [code]custom_speed[/code] are [code]0[/code]). + </description> + </method> + <method name="pause"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Pauses the currently playing animation. The [member frame] and [member frame_progress] will be kept and calling [method play] or [method play_backwards] without arguments will resume the animation from the current playback position. + See also [method stop]. + </description> + </method> <method name="play"> <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" default="&""" /> - <param index="1" name="backwards" type="bool" default="false" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" default="&""" /> + <param index="1" name="custom_speed" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="2" name="from_end" type="bool" default="false" /> + <description> + Plays the animation with key [param name]. If [param custom_speed] is negative and [param from_end] is [code]true[/code], the animation will play backwards (which is equivalent to calling [method play_backwards]). + If this method is called with that same animation [param name], or with no [param name] parameter, the assigned animation will resume playing if it was paused. + </description> + </method> + <method name="play_backwards"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" default="&""" /> + <description> + Plays the animation with key [param name] in reverse. + This method is a shorthand for [method play] with [code]custom_speed = -1.0[/code] and [code]from_end = true[/code], so see its description for more information. + </description> + </method> + <method name="set_frame_and_progress"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="frame" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="progress" type="float" /> <description> - Plays the animation named [param anim]. If no [param anim] is provided, the current animation is played. If [param backwards] is [code]true[/code], the animation is played in reverse. - [b]Note:[/b] If [member speed_scale] is negative, the animation direction specified by [param backwards] will be inverted. + The setter of [member frame] resets the [member frame_progress] to [code]0.0[/code] implicitly, but this method avoids that. + This is useful when you want to carry over the current [member frame_progress] to another [member frame]. + [b]Example:[/b] + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + # Change the animation with keeping the frame index and progress. + var current_frame = animated_sprite.get_frame() + var current_progress = animated_sprite.get_frame_progress() + animated_sprite.play("walk_another_skin") + animated_sprite.set_frame_and_progress(current_frame, current_progress) + [/gdscript] + [/codeblocks] </description> </method> <method name="stop"> <return type="void" /> <description> - Stops the current [member animation] at the current [member frame]. - [b]Note:[/b] This method resets the current frame's elapsed time and removes the [code]backwards[/code] flag from the current [member animation] (if it was previously set by [method play]). If this behavior is undesired, set [member playing] to [code]false[/code] instead. + Stops the currently playing animation. The animation position is reset to [code]0[/code] and the [code]custom_speed[/code] is reset to [code]1.0[/code]. See also [method pause]. </description> </method> </methods> <members> <member name="animation" type="StringName" setter="set_animation" getter="get_animation" default="&"default""> - The current animation from the [code]frames[/code] resource. If this value changes, the [code]frame[/code] counter is reset. + The current animation from the [member sprite_frames] resource. If this value is changed, the [member frame] counter and the [member frame_progress] are reset. </member> - <member name="frame" type="int" setter="set_frame" getter="get_frame" default="0"> - The displayed animation frame's index. + <member name="autoplay" type="String" setter="set_autoplay" getter="get_autoplay" default=""""> + The key of the animation to play when the scene loads. </member> - <member name="frames" type="SpriteFrames" setter="set_sprite_frames" getter="get_sprite_frames"> - The [SpriteFrames] resource containing the animation(s). + <member name="frame" type="int" setter="set_frame" getter="get_frame" default="0"> + The displayed animation frame's index. Setting this property also resets [member frame_progress]. If this is not desired, use [method set_frame_and_progress]. </member> - <member name="playing" type="bool" setter="set_playing" getter="is_playing" default="false"> - If [code]true[/code], the [member animation] is currently playing. Setting this property to [code]false[/code] pauses the current animation. Use [method stop] to stop the animation at the current frame instead. - [b]Note:[/b] Unlike [method stop], changing this property to [code]false[/code] preserves the current frame's elapsed time and the [code]backwards[/code] flag of the current [member animation] (if it was previously set by [method play]). - [b]Note:[/b] After a non-looping animation finishes, the property still remains [code]true[/code]. + <member name="frame_progress" type="float" setter="set_frame_progress" getter="get_frame_progress" default="0.0"> + The progress value between [code]0.0[/code] and [code]1.0[/code] until the current frame transitions to the next frame. If the animation is playing backwards, the value transitions from [code]1.0[/code] to [code]0.0[/code]. </member> <member name="speed_scale" type="float" setter="set_speed_scale" getter="get_speed_scale" default="1.0"> - The animation speed is multiplied by this value. If set to a negative value, the animation is played in reverse. If set to [code]0[/code], the animation is paused, preserving the current frame's elapsed time. + The speed scaling ratio. For example, if this value is [code]1[/code], then the animation plays at normal speed. If it's [code]0.5[/code], then it plays at half speed. If it's [code]2[/code], then it plays at double speed. + If set to a negative value, the animation is played in reverse. If set to [code]0[/code], the animation will not advance. + </member> + <member name="sprite_frames" type="SpriteFrames" setter="set_sprite_frames" getter="get_sprite_frames"> + The [SpriteFrames] resource containing the animation(s). Allows you the option to load, edit, clear, make unique and save the states of the [SpriteFrames] resource. </member> </members> <signals> + <signal name="animation_changed"> + <description> + Emitted when [member animation] changes. + </description> + </signal> <signal name="animation_finished"> <description> - Emitted when the animation reaches the end, or the start if it is played in reverse. If the animation is looping, this signal is emitted at the end of each loop. + Emitted when the animation reaches the end, or the start if it is played in reverse. When the animation finishes, it pauses the playback. + </description> + </signal> + <signal name="animation_looped"> + <description> + Emitted when the animation loops. </description> </signal> <signal name="frame_changed"> <description> - Emitted when [member frame] changed. + Emitted when [member frame] changes. + </description> + </signal> + <signal name="sprite_frames_changed"> + <description> + Emitted when [member sprite_frames] changes. </description> </signal> </signals> diff --git a/doc/classes/Animation.xml b/doc/classes/Animation.xml index c0626dcfe4..74ee13a3d2 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Animation.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Animation.xml @@ -104,6 +104,13 @@ [param stream] is the [AudioStream] resource to play. [param start_offset] is the number of seconds cut off at the beginning of the audio stream, while [param end_offset] is at the ending. </description> </method> + <method name="audio_track_is_use_blend" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="track_idx" type="int" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if the track at [code]idx[/code] will be blended with other animations. + </description> + </method> <method name="audio_track_set_key_end_offset"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="track_idx" type="int" /> @@ -131,6 +138,14 @@ Sets the stream of the key identified by [param key_idx] to value [param stream]. The [param track_idx] must be the index of an Audio Track. </description> </method> + <method name="audio_track_set_use_blend"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="track_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="enable" type="bool" /> + <description> + Sets whether the track will be blended with other animations. If [code]true[/code], the audio playback volume changes depending on the blend value. + </description> + </method> <method name="bezier_track_get_key_in_handle" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Vector2" /> <param index="0" name="track_idx" type="int" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNode.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNode.xml index a33ec2f6dc..bc65e6013b 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNode.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNode.xml @@ -49,6 +49,13 @@ When inheriting from [AnimationRootNode], implement this virtual method to return whether the blend tree editor should display filter editing on this node. </description> </method> + <method name="_is_parameter_read_only" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="parameter" type="StringName" /> + <description> + When inheriting from [AnimationRootNode], implement this virtual method to return whether the [param parameter] is read-only. Parameters are custom local memory used for your nodes, given a resource can be reused in multiple trees. + </description> + </method> <method name="_process" qualifiers="virtual const"> <return type="float" /> <param index="0" name="time" type="float" /> @@ -61,10 +68,10 @@ </description> </method> <method name="add_input"> - <return type="void" /> + <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> <description> - Adds an input to the node. This is only useful for nodes created for use in an [AnimationNodeBlendTree]. + Adds an input to the node. This is only useful for nodes created for use in an [AnimationNodeBlendTree]. If the addition fails, returns [code]false[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="blend_animation"> @@ -108,13 +115,20 @@ Blend another animation node (in case this node contains children animation nodes). This function is only useful if you inherit from [AnimationRootNode] instead, else editors will not display your node for addition. </description> </method> + <method name="find_input" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="int" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> + <description> + Returns the input index which corresponds to [param name]. If not found, returns [code]-1[/code]. + </description> + </method> <method name="get_input_count" qualifiers="const"> <return type="int" /> <description> Amount of inputs in this node, only useful for nodes that go into [AnimationNodeBlendTree]. </description> </method> - <method name="get_input_name"> + <method name="get_input_name" qualifiers="const"> <return type="String" /> <param index="0" name="input" type="int" /> <description> @@ -150,6 +164,14 @@ Adds or removes a path for the filter. </description> </method> + <method name="set_input_name"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="input" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="name" type="String" /> + <description> + Sets the name of the input at the given [param input] index. If the setting fails, returns [code]false[/code]. + </description> + </method> <method name="set_parameter"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeBlendSpace1D.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeBlendSpace1D.xml index 0f1ce127cd..9a7872f50e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeBlendSpace1D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeBlendSpace1D.xml @@ -67,6 +67,9 @@ </method> </methods> <members> + <member name="blend_mode" type="int" setter="set_blend_mode" getter="get_blend_mode" enum="AnimationNodeBlendSpace1D.BlendMode" default="0"> + Controls the interpolation between animations. See [enum BlendMode] constants. + </member> <member name="max_space" type="float" setter="set_max_space" getter="get_max_space" default="1.0"> The blend space's axis's upper limit for the points' position. See [method add_blend_point]. </member> @@ -84,4 +87,15 @@ Label of the virtual axis of the blend space. </member> </members> + <constants> + <constant name="BLEND_MODE_INTERPOLATED" value="0" enum="BlendMode"> + The interpolation between animations is linear. + </constant> + <constant name="BLEND_MODE_DISCRETE" value="1" enum="BlendMode"> + The blend space plays the animation of the node the blending position is closest to. Useful for frame-by-frame 2D animations. + </constant> + <constant name="BLEND_MODE_DISCRETE_CARRY" value="2" enum="BlendMode"> + Similar to [constant BLEND_MODE_DISCRETE], but starts the new animation at the last animation's playback position. + </constant> + </constants> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeOneShot.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeOneShot.xml index 14abc34992..9e8193868c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeOneShot.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeOneShot.xml @@ -28,6 +28,12 @@ </member> </members> <constants> + <constant name="ONE_SHOT_REQUEST_NONE" value="0" enum="OneShotRequest"> + </constant> + <constant name="ONE_SHOT_REQUEST_FIRE" value="1" enum="OneShotRequest"> + </constant> + <constant name="ONE_SHOT_REQUEST_ABORT" value="2" enum="OneShotRequest"> + </constant> <constant name="MIX_MODE_BLEND" value="0" enum="MixMode"> </constant> <constant name="MIX_MODE_ADD" value="1" enum="MixMode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachine.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachine.xml index 0fb789875f..95891a9061 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachine.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachine.xml @@ -161,4 +161,9 @@ </description> </method> </methods> + <members> + <member name="allow_transition_to_self" type="bool" setter="set_allow_transition_to_self" getter="is_allow_transition_to_self" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code], allows teleport to the self state with [method AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.travel]. When the reset option is enabled in [method AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.travel], the animation is restarted. If [code]false[/code], nothing happens on the teleportation to the self state. + </member> + </members> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.xml index 8f53ef0dcf..17a946bb3e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.xml @@ -38,6 +38,12 @@ Returns the playback position within the current animation state. </description> </method> + <method name="get_fading_from_node" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="StringName" /> + <description> + Returns the starting state of currently fading animation. + </description> + </method> <method name="get_travel_path" qualifiers="const"> <return type="PackedStringArray" /> <description> @@ -50,11 +56,19 @@ Returns [code]true[/code] if an animation is playing. </description> </method> + <method name="next"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + If there is a next path by travel or auto advance, immediately transitions from the current state to the next state. + </description> + </method> <method name="start"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="node" type="StringName" /> + <param index="1" name="reset" type="bool" default="true" /> <description> Starts playing the given animation. + If [param reset] is [code]true[/code], the animation is played from the beginning. </description> </method> <method name="stop"> @@ -66,8 +80,11 @@ <method name="travel"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="to_node" type="StringName" /> + <param index="1" name="reset_on_teleport" type="bool" default="true" /> <description> Transitions from the current state to another one, following the shortest path. + If the path does not connect from the current state, the animation will play after the state teleports. + If [param reset_on_teleport] is [code]true[/code], the animation is played from the beginning when the travel cause a teleportation. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachineTransition.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachineTransition.xml index 814b2d0052..bccab4613a 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachineTransition.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeStateMachineTransition.xml @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ $animation_tree.set("parameters/conditions/idle", is_on_floor and (linear_velocity.x == 0)) [/gdscript] [csharp] - GetNode<AnimationTree>("animation_tree").Set("parameters/conditions/idle", IsOnFloor && (LinearVelocity.x == 0)); + GetNode<AnimationTree>("animation_tree").Set("parameters/conditions/idle", IsOnFloor && (LinearVelocity.X == 0)); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </member> @@ -28,6 +28,9 @@ <member name="priority" type="int" setter="set_priority" getter="get_priority" default="1"> Lower priority transitions are preferred when travelling through the tree via [method AnimationNodeStateMachinePlayback.travel] or [member advance_mode] is set to [constant ADVANCE_MODE_AUTO]. </member> + <member name="reset" type="bool" setter="set_reset" getter="is_reset" default="true"> + If [code]true[/code], the destination animation is played back from the beginning when switched. + </member> <member name="switch_mode" type="int" setter="set_switch_mode" getter="get_switch_mode" enum="AnimationNodeStateMachineTransition.SwitchMode" default="0"> The transition type. </member> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeTransition.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeTransition.xml index f6e2fc5eb2..bc3e5716dd 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationNodeTransition.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationNodeTransition.xml @@ -12,16 +12,18 @@ <link title="Third Person Shooter Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/678</link> </tutorials> <methods> - <method name="get_input_caption" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="String" /> + <method name="is_input_reset" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="input" type="int" /> <description> + Returns whether the animation restarts when the animation transitions from the other animation. </description> </method> <method name="is_input_set_as_auto_advance" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="input" type="int" /> <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if auto-advance is enabled for the given [param input] index. </description> </method> <method name="set_input_as_auto_advance"> @@ -29,24 +31,27 @@ <param index="0" name="input" type="int" /> <param index="1" name="enable" type="bool" /> <description> + Enables or disables auto-advance for the given [param input] index. If enabled, state changes to the next input after playing the animation once. If enabled for the last input state, it loops to the first. </description> </method> - <method name="set_input_caption"> + <method name="set_input_reset"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="input" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="caption" type="String" /> + <param index="1" name="enable" type="bool" /> <description> + If [code]true[/code], the destination animation is restarted when the animation transitions. </description> </method> </methods> <members> - <member name="enabled_inputs" type="int" setter="set_enabled_inputs" getter="get_enabled_inputs" default="0"> - The number of enabled input ports for this node. + <member name="allow_transition_to_self" type="bool" setter="set_allow_transition_to_self" getter="is_allow_transition_to_self" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code], allows transition to the self state. When the reset option is enabled in input, the animation is restarted. If [code]false[/code], nothing happens on the transition to the self state. </member> - <member name="from_start" type="bool" setter="set_from_start" getter="is_from_start" default="true"> - If [code]true[/code], the destination animation is played back from the beginning when switched. + <member name="input_count" type="int" setter="set_input_count" getter="get_input_count" default="0"> + The number of enabled input ports for this node. </member> <member name="xfade_curve" type="Curve" setter="set_xfade_curve" getter="get_xfade_curve"> + Determines how cross-fading between animations is eased. If empty, the transition will be linear. </member> <member name="xfade_time" type="float" setter="set_xfade_time" getter="get_xfade_time" default="0.0"> Cross-fading time (in seconds) between each animation connected to the inputs. diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationPlayer.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationPlayer.xml index ca0cbf0ca1..25e4a4549d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationPlayer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationPlayer.xml @@ -15,6 +15,17 @@ <link title="Third Person Shooter Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/678</link> </tutorials> <methods> + <method name="_post_process_key_value" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="Variant" /> + <param index="0" name="animation" type="Animation" /> + <param index="1" name="track" type="int" /> + <param index="2" name="value" type="Variant" /> + <param index="3" name="object" type="Object" /> + <param index="4" name="object_idx" type="int" /> + <description> + A virtual function for processing after key getting during playback. + </description> + </method> <method name="add_animation_library"> <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> @@ -102,13 +113,14 @@ <param index="0" name="anim_from" type="StringName" /> <param index="1" name="anim_to" type="StringName" /> <description> - Gets the blend time (in seconds) between two animations, referenced by their keys. + Returns the blend time (in seconds) between two animations, referenced by their keys. </description> </method> <method name="get_playing_speed" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <description> - Gets the actual playing speed of current animation or 0 if not playing. This speed is the [member playback_speed] property multiplied by [code]custom_speed[/code] argument specified when calling the [method play] method. + Returns the actual playing speed of current animation or [code]0[/code] if not playing. This speed is the [member speed_scale] property multiplied by [code]custom_speed[/code] argument specified when calling the [method play] method. + Returns a negative value if the current animation is playing backwards. </description> </method> <method name="get_queue"> @@ -134,7 +146,7 @@ <method name="is_playing" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns [code]true[/code] if playing an animation. + Returns [code]true[/code] if an animation is currently playing (even if [member speed_scale] and/or [code]custom_speed[/code] are [code]0[/code]). </description> </method> <method name="pause"> @@ -152,7 +164,7 @@ <param index="3" name="from_end" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> Plays the animation with key [param name]. Custom blend times and speed can be set. If [param custom_speed] is negative and [param from_end] is [code]true[/code], the animation will play backwards (which is equivalent to calling [method play_backwards]). - The [AnimationPlayer] keeps track of its current or last played animation with [member assigned_animation]. If this method is called with that same animation [param name], or with no [param name] parameter, the assigned animation will resume playing if it was paused, or restart if it was stopped (see [method stop] for both pause and stop). If the animation was already playing, it will keep playing. + The [AnimationPlayer] keeps track of its current or last played animation with [member assigned_animation]. If this method is called with that same animation [param name], or with no [param name] parameter, the assigned animation will resume playing if it was paused. [b]Note:[/b] The animation will be updated the next time the [AnimationPlayer] is processed. If other variables are updated at the same time this is called, they may be updated too early. To perform the update immediately, call [code]advance(0)[/code]. </description> </method> @@ -208,9 +220,11 @@ </method> <method name="stop"> <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="keep_state" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Stops the currently playing animation. The animation position is reset to [code]0[/code] and the playback speed is reset to [code]1.0[/code]. - See also [method pause]. + Stops the currently playing animation. The animation position is reset to [code]0[/code] and the [code]custom_speed[/code] is reset to [code]1.0[/code]. See also [method pause]. + If [param keep_state] is [code]true[/code], the animation state is not updated visually. + [b]Note:[/b] The method / audio / animation playback tracks will not be processed by this method. </description> </method> </methods> @@ -218,6 +232,10 @@ <member name="assigned_animation" type="String" setter="set_assigned_animation" getter="get_assigned_animation"> If playing, the the current animation's key, otherwise, the animation last played. When set, this changes the animation, but will not play it unless already playing. See also [member current_animation]. </member> + <member name="audio_max_polyphony" type="int" setter="set_audio_max_polyphony" getter="get_audio_max_polyphony" default="32"> + The number of possible simultaneous sounds for each of the assigned AudioStreamPlayers. + For example, if this value is [code]32[/code] and the animation has two audio tracks, the two [AudioStreamPlayer]s assigned can play simultaneously up to [code]32[/code] voices each. + </member> <member name="autoplay" type="String" setter="set_autoplay" getter="get_autoplay" default=""""> The key of the animation to play when the scene loads. </member> @@ -247,9 +265,6 @@ <member name="playback_process_mode" type="int" setter="set_process_callback" getter="get_process_callback" enum="AnimationPlayer.AnimationProcessCallback" default="1"> The process notification in which to update animations. </member> - <member name="playback_speed" type="float" setter="set_speed_scale" getter="get_speed_scale" default="1.0"> - The speed scaling ratio. For example, if this value is 1, then the animation plays at normal speed. If it's 0.5, then it plays at half speed. If it's 2, then it plays at double speed. - </member> <member name="reset_on_save" type="bool" setter="set_reset_on_save_enabled" getter="is_reset_on_save_enabled" default="true"> This is used by the editor. If set to [code]true[/code], the scene will be saved with the effects of the reset animation (the animation with the key [code]"RESET"[/code]) applied as if it had been seeked to time 0, with the editor keeping the values that the scene had before saving. This makes it more convenient to preview and edit animations in the editor, as changes to the scene will not be saved as long as they are set in the reset animation. @@ -257,6 +272,10 @@ <member name="root_node" type="NodePath" setter="set_root" getter="get_root" default="NodePath("..")"> The node from which node path references will travel. </member> + <member name="speed_scale" type="float" setter="set_speed_scale" getter="get_speed_scale" default="1.0"> + The speed scaling ratio. For example, if this value is [code]1[/code], then the animation plays at normal speed. If it's [code]0.5[/code], then it plays at half speed. If it's [code]2[/code], then it plays at double speed. + If set to a negative value, the animation is played in reverse. If set to [code]0[/code], the animation will not advance. + </member> </members> <signals> <signal name="animation_changed"> diff --git a/doc/classes/AnimationTree.xml b/doc/classes/AnimationTree.xml index a17a727d7e..86562c340d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AnimationTree.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AnimationTree.xml @@ -12,6 +12,17 @@ <link title="Third Person Shooter Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/678</link> </tutorials> <methods> + <method name="_post_process_key_value" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="Variant" /> + <param index="0" name="animation" type="Animation" /> + <param index="1" name="track" type="int" /> + <param index="2" name="value" type="Variant" /> + <param index="3" name="object" type="Object" /> + <param index="4" name="object_idx" type="int" /> + <description> + A virtual function for processing after key getting during playback. + </description> + </method> <method name="advance"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="delta" type="float" /> @@ -99,12 +110,16 @@ <member name="anim_player" type="NodePath" setter="set_animation_player" getter="get_animation_player" default="NodePath("")"> The path to the [AnimationPlayer] used for animating. </member> + <member name="audio_max_polyphony" type="int" setter="set_audio_max_polyphony" getter="get_audio_max_polyphony" default="32"> + The number of possible simultaneous sounds for each of the assigned AudioStreamPlayers. + For example, if this value is [code]32[/code] and the animation has two audio tracks, the two [AudioStreamPlayer]s assigned can play simultaneously up to [code]32[/code] voices each. + </member> <member name="process_callback" type="int" setter="set_process_callback" getter="get_process_callback" enum="AnimationTree.AnimationProcessCallback" default="1"> The process mode of this [AnimationTree]. See [enum AnimationProcessCallback] for available modes. </member> <member name="root_motion_track" type="NodePath" setter="set_root_motion_track" getter="get_root_motion_track" default="NodePath("")"> The path to the Animation track used for root motion. Paths must be valid scene-tree paths to a node, and must be specified starting from the parent node of the node that will reproduce the animation. To specify a track that controls properties or bones, append its name after the path, separated by [code]":"[/code]. For example, [code]"character/skeleton:ankle"[/code] or [code]"character/mesh:transform/local"[/code]. - If the track has type [constant Animation.TYPE_POSITION_3D], [constant Animation.TYPE_ROTATION_3D] or [constant Animation.TYPE_SCALE_3D] the transformation will be cancelled visually, and the animation will appear to stay in place. See also [method get_root_motion_position], [method get_root_motion_rotation], [method get_root_motion_scale] and [RootMotionView]. + If the track has type [constant Animation.TYPE_POSITION_3D], [constant Animation.TYPE_ROTATION_3D] or [constant Animation.TYPE_SCALE_3D] the transformation will be canceled visually, and the animation will appear to stay in place. See also [method get_root_motion_position], [method get_root_motion_rotation], [method get_root_motion_scale] and [RootMotionView]. </member> <member name="tree_root" type="AnimationNode" setter="set_tree_root" getter="get_tree_root"> The root animation node of this [AnimationTree]. See [AnimationNode]. diff --git a/doc/classes/Area2D.xml b/doc/classes/Area2D.xml index 3f76cc16ec..8a98921a60 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Area2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Area2D.xml @@ -87,8 +87,9 @@ <member name="gravity_point_center" type="Vector2" setter="set_gravity_point_center" getter="get_gravity_point_center" default="Vector2(0, 1)"> If gravity is a point (see [member gravity_point]), this will be the point of attraction. </member> - <member name="gravity_point_distance_scale" type="float" setter="set_gravity_point_distance_scale" getter="get_gravity_point_distance_scale" default="0.0"> - The falloff factor for point gravity. The greater the value, the faster gravity decreases with distance. + <member name="gravity_point_unit_distance" type="float" setter="set_gravity_point_unit_distance" getter="get_gravity_point_unit_distance" default="0.0"> + The distance at which the gravity strength is equal to [member gravity]. For example, on a planet 100 pixels in radius with a surface gravity of 4.0 px/s², set the [member gravity] to 4.0 and the unit distance to 100.0. The gravity will have falloff according to the inverse square law, so in the example, at 200 pixels from the center the gravity will be 1.0 px/s² (twice the distance, 1/4th the gravity), at 50 pixels it will be 16.0 px/s² (half the distance, 4x the gravity), and so on. + The above is true only when the unit distance is a positive number. When this is set to 0.0, the gravity will be constant regardless of distance. </member> <member name="gravity_space_override" type="int" setter="set_gravity_space_override_mode" getter="get_gravity_space_override_mode" enum="Area2D.SpaceOverride" default="0"> Override mode for gravity calculations within this area. See [enum SpaceOverride] for possible values. diff --git a/doc/classes/Area3D.xml b/doc/classes/Area3D.xml index 8923ac8aae..bd046b7cb8 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Area3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Area3D.xml @@ -7,6 +7,7 @@ 3D area that detects [CollisionObject3D] nodes overlapping, entering, or exiting. Can also alter or override local physics parameters (gravity, damping) and route audio to custom audio buses. To give the area its shape, add a [CollisionShape3D] or a [CollisionPolygon3D] node as a [i]direct[/i] child (or add multiple such nodes as direct children) of the area. [b]Warning:[/b] See [ConcavePolygonShape3D] (also called "trimesh") for a warning about possibly unexpected behavior when using that shape for an area. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="3D Platformer Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/125</link> @@ -85,8 +86,9 @@ <member name="gravity_point_center" type="Vector3" setter="set_gravity_point_center" getter="get_gravity_point_center" default="Vector3(0, -1, 0)"> If gravity is a point (see [member gravity_point]), this will be the point of attraction. </member> - <member name="gravity_point_distance_scale" type="float" setter="set_gravity_point_distance_scale" getter="get_gravity_point_distance_scale" default="0.0"> - The falloff factor for point gravity. The greater the value, the faster gravity decreases with distance. + <member name="gravity_point_unit_distance" type="float" setter="set_gravity_point_unit_distance" getter="get_gravity_point_unit_distance" default="0.0"> + The distance at which the gravity strength is equal to [member gravity]. For example, on a planet 100 meters in radius with a surface gravity of 4.0 m/s², set the [member gravity] to 4.0 and the unit distance to 100.0. The gravity will have falloff according to the inverse square law, so in the example, at 200 meters from the center the gravity will be 1.0 m/s² (twice the distance, 1/4th the gravity), at 50 meters it will be 16.0 m/s² (half the distance, 4x the gravity), and so on. + The above is true only when the unit distance is a positive number. When this is set to 0.0, the gravity will be constant regardless of distance. </member> <member name="gravity_space_override" type="int" setter="set_gravity_space_override_mode" getter="get_gravity_space_override_mode" enum="Area3D.SpaceOverride" default="0"> Override mode for gravity calculations within this area. See [enum SpaceOverride] for possible values. diff --git a/doc/classes/Array.xml b/doc/classes/Array.xml index 21ccf79fe2..213a2254af 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Array.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Array.xml @@ -59,14 +59,14 @@ <param index="2" name="class_name" type="StringName" /> <param index="3" name="script" type="Variant" /> <description> - Creates a typed array from the [param base] array. The base array can't be already typed. See [method set_typed] for more details. + Creates a typed array from the [param base] array. </description> </constructor> <constructor name="Array"> <return type="Array" /> <param index="0" name="from" type="Array" /> <description> - Constructs an [Array] as a copy of the given [Array]. + Returns the same array as [param from]. If you need a copy of the array, use [method duplicate]. </description> </constructor> <constructor name="Array"> @@ -200,6 +200,13 @@ [/codeblock] </description> </method> + <method name="assign"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="array" type="Array" /> + <description> + Assigns elements of another [param array] into the array. Resizes the array to match [param array]. Performs type conversions if the array is typed. + </description> + </method> <method name="back" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Variant" /> <description> @@ -392,7 +399,14 @@ <method name="is_read_only" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns [code]true[/code] if the array is read-only. See [method set_read_only]. Arrays are automatically read-only if declared with [code]const[/code] keyword. + Returns [code]true[/code] if the array is read-only. See [method make_read_only]. Arrays are automatically read-only if declared with [code]const[/code] keyword. + </description> + </method> + <method name="is_same_typed" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="array" type="Array" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if the array is typed the same as [param array]. </description> </method> <method name="is_typed" qualifiers="const"> @@ -401,6 +415,12 @@ Returns [code]true[/code] if the array is typed. Typed arrays can only store elements of their associated type and provide type safety for the [code][][/code] operator. Methods of typed array still return [Variant]. </description> </method> + <method name="make_read_only"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Makes the array read-only, i.e. disabled modifying of the array's elements. Does not apply to nested content, e.g. content of nested arrays. + </description> + </method> <method name="map" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Array" /> <param index="0" name="method" type="Callable" /> @@ -524,23 +544,6 @@ Searches the array in reverse order. Optionally, a start search index can be passed. If negative, the start index is considered relative to the end of the array. </description> </method> - <method name="set_read_only"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="enable" type="bool" /> - <description> - Makes the [Array] read-only, i.e. disabled modifying of the array's elements. Does not apply to nested content, e.g. content of nested arrays. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_typed"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="type" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="class_name" type="StringName" /> - <param index="2" name="script" type="Variant" /> - <description> - Makes the [Array] typed. The [param type] should be one of the [enum Variant.Type] constants. [param class_name] is optional and can only be provided for [constant TYPE_OBJECT]. [param script] can only be provided if [param class_name] is not empty. - The method fails if an array is already typed. - </description> - </method> <method name="shuffle"> <return type="void" /> <description> @@ -620,13 +623,6 @@ [/codeblocks] </description> </method> - <method name="typed_assign"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="array" type="Array" /> - <description> - Assigns a different [Array] to this array reference. It the array is typed, the new array's type must be compatible and its elements will be automatically converted. - </description> - </method> </methods> <operators> <operator name="operator !="> @@ -679,7 +675,7 @@ </description> </operator> <operator name="operator []"> - <return type="void" /> + <return type="Variant" /> <param index="0" name="index" type="int" /> <description> Returns a reference to the element of type [Variant] at the specified location. Arrays start at index 0. [param index] can be a zero or positive value to start from the beginning, or a negative value to start from the end. Out-of-bounds array access causes a run-time error, which will result in an error being printed and the project execution pausing if run from the editor. diff --git a/doc/classes/ArrayMesh.xml b/doc/classes/ArrayMesh.xml index f7764d5e32..6dc66194b8 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ArrayMesh.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ArrayMesh.xml @@ -65,11 +65,15 @@ <param index="1" name="arrays" type="Array" /> <param index="2" name="blend_shapes" type="Array[]" default="[]" /> <param index="3" name="lods" type="Dictionary" default="{}" /> - <param index="4" name="compress_flags" type="int" enum="Mesh.ArrayFormat" default="0" /> + <param index="4" name="flags" type="int" enum="Mesh.ArrayFormat" default="0" /> <description> - Creates a new surface. - Surfaces are created to be rendered using a [param primitive], which may be any of the types defined in [enum Mesh.PrimitiveType]. (As a note, when using indices, it is recommended to only use points, lines, or triangles.) [method Mesh.get_surface_count] will become the [code]surf_idx[/code] for this new surface. - The [param arrays] argument is an array of arrays. See [enum Mesh.ArrayType] for the values used in this array. For example, [code]arrays[0][/code] is the array of vertices. That first vertex sub-array is always required; the others are optional. Adding an index array puts this function into "index mode" where the vertex and other arrays become the sources of data and the index array defines the vertex order. All sub-arrays must have the same length as the vertex array (or be an exact multiple of the vertex array's length, when multiple elements of a sub-array correspond to a single vertex) or be empty, except for [constant Mesh.ARRAY_INDEX] if it is used. + Creates a new surface. [method Mesh.get_surface_count] will become the [code]surf_idx[/code] for this new surface. + Surfaces are created to be rendered using a [param primitive], which may be any of the values defined in [enum Mesh.PrimitiveType]. + The [param arrays] argument is an array of arrays. Each of the [constant Mesh.ARRAY_MAX] elements contains an array with some of the mesh data for this surface as described by the corresponding member of [enum Mesh.ArrayType] or [code]null[/code] if it is not used by the surface. For example, [code]arrays[0][/code] is the array of vertices. That first vertex sub-array is always required; the others are optional. Adding an index array puts this surface into "index mode" where the vertex and other arrays become the sources of data and the index array defines the vertex order. All sub-arrays must have the same length as the vertex array (or be an exact multiple of the vertex array's length, when multiple elements of a sub-array correspond to a single vertex) or be empty, except for [constant Mesh.ARRAY_INDEX] if it is used. + The [param blend_shapes] argument is an array of vertex data for each blend shape. Each element is an array of the same structure as [param arrays], but [constant Mesh.ARRAY_VERTEX], [constant Mesh.ARRAY_NORMAL], and [constant Mesh.ARRAY_TANGENT] are set if and only if they are set in [param arrays] and all other entries are [code]null[/code]. + The [param lods] argument is a dictionary with [float] keys and [PackedInt32Array] values. Each entry in the dictionary represents a LOD level of the surface, where the value is the [constant Mesh.ARRAY_INDEX] array to use for the LOD level and the key is roughly proportional to the distance at which the LOD stats being used. I.e., increasing the key of a LOD also increases the distance that the objects has to be from the camera before the LOD is used. + The [param flags] argument is the bitwise or of, as required: One value of [enum Mesh.ArrayCustomFormat] left shifted by [code]ARRAY_FORMAT_CUSTOMn_SHIFT[/code] for each custom channel in use, [constant Mesh.ARRAY_FLAG_USE_DYNAMIC_UPDATE], [constant Mesh.ARRAY_FLAG_USE_8_BONE_WEIGHTS], or [constant Mesh.ARRAY_FLAG_USES_EMPTY_VERTEX_ARRAY]. + [b]Note:[/b] When using indices, it is recommended to only use points, lines, or triangles. </description> </method> <method name="clear_blend_shapes"> @@ -202,6 +206,7 @@ Overrides the [AABB] with one defined by user for use with frustum culling. Especially useful to avoid unexpected culling when using a shader to offset vertices. </member> <member name="shadow_mesh" type="ArrayMesh" setter="set_shadow_mesh" getter="get_shadow_mesh"> + An optional mesh which is used for rendering shadows and can be used for the depth prepass. Can be used to increase performance of shadow rendering by using a mesh that only contains vertex position data (without normals, UVs, colors, etc.). </member> </members> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/AudioServer.xml b/doc/classes/AudioServer.xml index 36f12dd5c4..ae331f8491 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AudioServer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AudioServer.xml @@ -29,13 +29,6 @@ Adds an [AudioEffect] effect to the bus [param bus_idx] at [param at_position]. </description> </method> - <method name="capture_get_device_list"> - <return type="PackedStringArray" /> - <description> - Returns the names of all audio input devices detected on the system. - [b]Note:[/b] [member ProjectSettings.audio/driver/enable_input] must be [code]true[/code] for audio input to work. See also that setting's description for caveats related to permissions and operating system privacy settings. - </description> - </method> <method name="generate_bus_layout" qualifiers="const"> <return type="AudioBusLayout" /> <description> @@ -117,10 +110,11 @@ Returns the volume of the bus at index [param bus_idx] in dB. </description> </method> - <method name="get_device_list"> + <method name="get_input_device_list"> <return type="PackedStringArray" /> <description> - Returns the names of all audio devices detected on the system. + Returns the names of all audio input devices detected on the system. + [b]Note:[/b] [member ProjectSettings.audio/driver/enable_input] must be [code]true[/code] for audio input to work. See also that setting's description for caveats related to permissions and operating system privacy settings. </description> </method> <method name="get_mix_rate" qualifiers="const"> @@ -129,6 +123,12 @@ Returns the sample rate at the output of the [AudioServer]. </description> </method> + <method name="get_output_device_list"> + <return type="PackedStringArray" /> + <description> + Returns the names of all audio output devices detected on the system. + </description> + </method> <method name="get_output_latency" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <description> @@ -302,12 +302,12 @@ <member name="bus_count" type="int" setter="set_bus_count" getter="get_bus_count" default="1"> Number of available audio buses. </member> - <member name="capture_device" type="String" setter="capture_set_device" getter="capture_get_device" default=""Default""> - Name of the current device for audio input (see [method capture_get_device_list]). On systems with multiple audio inputs (such as analog, USB and HDMI audio), this can be used to select the audio input device. The value [code]"Default"[/code] will record audio on the system-wide default audio input. If an invalid device name is set, the value will be reverted back to [code]"Default"[/code]. + <member name="input_device" type="String" setter="set_input_device" getter="get_input_device" default=""Default""> + Name of the current device for audio input (see [method get_input_device_list]). On systems with multiple audio inputs (such as analog, USB and HDMI audio), this can be used to select the audio input device. The value [code]"Default"[/code] will record audio on the system-wide default audio input. If an invalid device name is set, the value will be reverted back to [code]"Default"[/code]. [b]Note:[/b] [member ProjectSettings.audio/driver/enable_input] must be [code]true[/code] for audio input to work. See also that setting's description for caveats related to permissions and operating system privacy settings. </member> - <member name="device" type="String" setter="set_device" getter="get_device" default=""Default""> - Name of the current device for audio output (see [method get_device_list]). On systems with multiple audio outputs (such as analog, USB and HDMI audio), this can be used to select the audio output device. The value [code]"Default"[/code] will play audio on the system-wide default audio output. If an invalid device name is set, the value will be reverted back to [code]"Default"[/code]. + <member name="output_device" type="String" setter="set_output_device" getter="get_output_device" default=""Default""> + Name of the current device for audio output (see [method get_output_device_list]). On systems with multiple audio outputs (such as analog, USB and HDMI audio), this can be used to select the audio output device. The value [code]"Default"[/code] will play audio on the system-wide default audio output. If an invalid device name is set, the value will be reverted back to [code]"Default"[/code]. </member> <member name="playback_speed_scale" type="float" setter="set_playback_speed_scale" getter="get_playback_speed_scale" default="1.0"> Scales the rate at which audio is played (i.e. setting it to [code]0.5[/code] will make the audio be played at half its speed). diff --git a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlaybackPolyphonic.xml b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlaybackPolyphonic.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8b0951153b --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlaybackPolyphonic.xml @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> +<class name="AudioStreamPlaybackPolyphonic" inherits="AudioStreamPlayback" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> + <brief_description> + Playback instance for [AudioStreamPolyphonic]. + </brief_description> + <description> + Playback instance for [AudioStreamPolyphonic]. After setting the [code]stream[/code] property of [AudioStreamPlayer], [AudioStreamPlayer2D], or [AudioStreamPlayer3D], the playback instance can be obtained by calling [method AudioStreamPlayer.get_stream_playback], [method AudioStreamPlayer2D.get_stream_playback] or [method AudioStreamPlayer3D.get_stream_playback] methods. + </description> + <tutorials> + </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="is_stream_playing" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="stream" type="int" /> + <description> + Return true whether the stream associated with an integer ID is still playing. Check [method play_stream] for information on when this ID becomes invalid. + </description> + </method> + <method name="play_stream"> + <return type="int" /> + <param index="0" name="stream" type="AudioStream" /> + <param index="1" name="from_offset" type="float" default="0" /> + <param index="2" name="volume_db" type="float" default="0" /> + <param index="3" name="pitch_scale" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <description> + Play an [AudioStream] at a given offset, volume and pitch scale. Playback starts immediately. + The return value is an unique integer ID that is associated to this playback stream and which can be used to control it. + This ID becomes invalid when the stream ends (if it does not loop), when the [AudioStreamPlaybackPolyphonic] is stopped, or when [method stop_stream] is called. + This function returns [constant INVALID_ID] if the amount of streams currently playing equals [member AudioStreamPolyphonic.polyphony]. If you need a higher amount of maximum polyphony, raise this value. + </description> + </method> + <method name="set_stream_pitch_scale"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="stream" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="pitch_scale" type="float" /> + <description> + Change the stream pitch scale. The [param stream] argument is an integer ID returned by [method play_stream]. + </description> + </method> + <method name="set_stream_volume"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="stream" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="volume_db" type="float" /> + <description> + Change the stream volume (in db). The [param stream] argument is an integer ID returned by [method play_stream]. + </description> + </method> + <method name="stop_stream"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="stream" type="int" /> + <description> + Stop a stream. The [param stream] argument is an integer ID returned by [method play_stream], which becomes invalid after calling this function. + </description> + </method> + </methods> + <constants> + <constant name="INVALID_ID" value="-1"> + Returned by [method play_stream] in case it could not allocate a stream for playback. + </constant> + </constants> +</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer.xml b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer.xml index 06e183f4e2..9b3a4f7bba 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer.xml @@ -28,6 +28,12 @@ Returns the [AudioStreamPlayback] object associated with this [AudioStreamPlayer]. </description> </method> + <method name="has_stream_playback"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns whether the [AudioStreamPlayer] can return the [AudioStreamPlayback] object or not. + </description> + </method> <method name="play"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="from_position" type="float" default="0.0" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer2D.xml b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer2D.xml index 81755b580f..18869e87cb 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer2D.xml @@ -25,6 +25,12 @@ Returns the [AudioStreamPlayback] object associated with this [AudioStreamPlayer2D]. </description> </method> + <method name="has_stream_playback"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns whether the [AudioStreamPlayer] can return the [AudioStreamPlayback] object or not. + </description> + </method> <method name="play"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="from_position" type="float" default="0.0" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer3D.xml b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer3D.xml index f711210ca1..d5a06dcad6 100644 --- a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPlayer3D.xml @@ -25,6 +25,12 @@ Returns the [AudioStreamPlayback] object associated with this [AudioStreamPlayer3D]. </description> </method> + <method name="has_stream_playback"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns whether the [AudioStreamPlayer] can return the [AudioStreamPlayback] object or not. + </description> + </method> <method name="play"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="from_position" type="float" default="0.0" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/AudioStreamPolyphonic.xml b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPolyphonic.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..baa1fc7037 --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/classes/AudioStreamPolyphonic.xml @@ -0,0 +1,17 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> +<class name="AudioStreamPolyphonic" inherits="AudioStream" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> + <brief_description> + AudioStream that lets the user play custom streams at any time from code, simultaneously using a single player. + </brief_description> + <description> + AudioStream that lets the user play custom streams at any time from code, simultaneously using a single player. + Playback control is done via the [AudioStreamPlaybackPolyphonic] instance set inside the player, which can be obtained via [method AudioStreamPlayer.get_stream_playback], [method AudioStreamPlayer2D.get_stream_playback] or [method AudioStreamPlayer3D.get_stream_playback] methods. Obtaining the playback instance is only valid after the [code]stream[/code] property is set as an [AudioStreamPolyphonic] in those players. + </description> + <tutorials> + </tutorials> + <members> + <member name="polyphony" type="int" setter="set_polyphony" getter="get_polyphony" default="32"> + Maximum amount of simultaneous streams that can be played. + </member> + </members> +</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/BackBufferCopy.xml b/doc/classes/BackBufferCopy.xml index b2c5a1756f..be4a649b50 100644 --- a/doc/classes/BackBufferCopy.xml +++ b/doc/classes/BackBufferCopy.xml @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="BackBufferCopy" inherits="Node2D" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> - Copies a region of the screen (or the whole screen) to a buffer so it can be accessed in your shader scripts through the [code]texture(SCREEN_TEXTURE, ...)[/code] function. + Copies a region of the screen (or the whole screen) to a buffer so it can be accessed in your shader scripts using the screen texture (i.e. a uniform sampler with ``hint_screen_texture``). </brief_description> <description> - Node for back-buffering the currently-displayed screen. The region defined in the [BackBufferCopy] node is buffered with the content of the screen it covers, or the entire screen according to the copy mode set. Use the [code]texture(SCREEN_TEXTURE, ...)[/code] function in your shader scripts to access the buffer. + Node for back-buffering the currently-displayed screen. The region defined in the [BackBufferCopy] node is buffered with the content of the screen it covers, or the entire screen according to the copy mode set. Use the screen texture in your shader scripts to access the buffer. [b]Note:[/b] Since this node inherits from [Node2D] (and not [Control]), anchors and margins won't apply to child [Control]-derived nodes. This can be problematic when resizing the window. To avoid this, add [Control]-derived nodes as [i]siblings[/i] to the [BackBufferCopy] node instead of adding them as children. </description> <tutorials> diff --git a/doc/classes/BaseButton.xml b/doc/classes/BaseButton.xml index aedb8f4420..68f62d1c00 100644 --- a/doc/classes/BaseButton.xml +++ b/doc/classes/BaseButton.xml @@ -70,7 +70,7 @@ [Shortcut] associated to the button. </member> <member name="shortcut_feedback" type="bool" setter="set_shortcut_feedback" getter="is_shortcut_feedback" default="true"> - If [code]true[/code], the button will appear pressed when its shortcut is activated. If [code]false[/code] and [member toggle_mode] is [code]false[/code], the shortcut will activate the button without appearing to press the button. + If [code]true[/code], the button will highlight for a short amount of time when its shortcut is activated. If [code]false[/code] and [member toggle_mode] is [code]false[/code], the shortcut will activate without any visual feedback. </member> <member name="shortcut_in_tooltip" type="bool" setter="set_shortcut_in_tooltip" getter="is_shortcut_in_tooltip_enabled" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], the button will add information about its shortcut in the tooltip. diff --git a/doc/classes/BoneAttachment3D.xml b/doc/classes/BoneAttachment3D.xml index f29525038e..dd01de3607 100644 --- a/doc/classes/BoneAttachment3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/BoneAttachment3D.xml @@ -16,19 +16,6 @@ Returns the [NodePath] to the external [Skeleton3D] node, if one has been set. </description> </method> - <method name="get_override_mode" qualifiers="const" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="int" /> - <description> - Deprecated. Local pose overrides will be removed. - Returns the override mode for the BoneAttachment3D node (0=global / 1=local). - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_override_pose" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether the BoneAttachment3D node is overriding the bone pose of the bone it's attached to. - </description> - </method> <method name="get_use_external_skeleton" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <description> @@ -49,21 +36,6 @@ Sets the [NodePath] to the external skeleton that the BoneAttachment3D node should use. The external [Skeleton3D] node is only used when [code]use_external_skeleton[/code] is set to [code]true[/code]. </description> </method> - <method name="set_override_mode" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="override_mode" type="int" /> - <description> - Deprecated. Local pose overrides will be removed. - Sets the override mode for the BoneAttachment3D node (0=global / 1=local). The override mode defines which of the bone poses the BoneAttachment3D node will override. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_override_pose"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="override_pose" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether the BoneAttachment3D node will override the bone pose of the bone it is attached to. When set to [code]true[/code], the BoneAttachment3D node can change the pose of the bone. - </description> - </method> <method name="set_use_external_skeleton"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="use_external_skeleton" type="bool" /> @@ -79,5 +51,8 @@ <member name="bone_name" type="String" setter="set_bone_name" getter="get_bone_name" default=""""> The name of the attached bone. </member> + <member name="override_pose" type="bool" setter="set_override_pose" getter="get_override_pose" default="false"> + Whether the BoneAttachment3D node will override the bone pose of the bone it is attached to. When set to [code]true[/code], the BoneAttachment3D node can change the pose of the bone. When set to [code]false[/code], the BoneAttachment3D will always be set to the bone's transform. + </member> </members> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Callable.xml b/doc/classes/Callable.xml index d1fdaef29c..8fc44d7536 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Callable.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Callable.xml @@ -14,21 +14,23 @@ func test(): var callable = Callable(self, "print_args") callable.call("hello", "world") # Prints "hello world ". - callable.call(Vector2.UP, 42, callable) # Prints "(0, -1) 42 Node(Node.gd)::print_args". + callable.call(Vector2.UP, 42, callable) # Prints "(0, -1) 42 Node(node.gd)::print_args". callable.call("invalid") # Invalid call, should have at least 2 arguments. [/gdscript] [csharp] - public void PrintArgs(object arg1, object arg2, object arg3 = null) + // Default parameter values are not supported. + public void PrintArgs(Variant arg1, Variant arg2, Variant arg3 = default) { GD.PrintS(arg1, arg2, arg3); } public void Test() { - Callable callable = new Callable(this, nameof(PrintArgs)); - callable.Call("hello", "world"); // Prints "hello world null". + // Invalid calls fail silently. + Callable callable = new Callable(this, MethodName.PrintArgs); + callable.Call("hello", "world"); // Default parameter values are not supported, should have 3 arguments. callable.Call(Vector2.Up, 42, callable); // Prints "(0, -1) 42 Node(Node.cs)::PrintArgs". - callable.Call("invalid"); // Invalid call, should have at least 2 arguments. + callable.Call("invalid"); // Invalid call, should have 3 arguments. } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/Camera2D.xml b/doc/classes/Camera2D.xml index 9315a85e1f..4156c9451a 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Camera2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Camera2D.xml @@ -55,6 +55,18 @@ [b]Note:[/b] The returned value is not the same as [member Node2D.global_position], as it is affected by the drag properties. It is also not the same as the current position if [member position_smoothing_enabled] is [code]true[/code] (see [method get_screen_center_position]). </description> </method> + <method name="is_current" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if this [Camera2D] is the active camera (see [method Viewport.get_camera_2d]). + </description> + </method> + <method name="make_current"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Forces this [Camera2D] to become the current active one. [member enabled] must be [code]true[/code]. + </description> + </method> <method name="reset_smoothing"> <return type="void" /> <description> @@ -83,9 +95,6 @@ <member name="anchor_mode" type="int" setter="set_anchor_mode" getter="get_anchor_mode" enum="Camera2D.AnchorMode" default="1"> The Camera2D's anchor point. See [enum AnchorMode] constants. </member> - <member name="current" type="bool" setter="set_current" getter="is_current" default="false"> - If [code]true[/code], the camera acts as the active camera for its [Viewport] ancestor. Only one camera can be current in a given viewport, so setting a different camera in the same viewport [code]current[/code] will disable whatever camera was already active in that viewport. - </member> <member name="custom_viewport" type="Node" setter="set_custom_viewport" getter="get_custom_viewport"> The custom [Viewport] node attached to the [Camera2D]. If [code]null[/code] or not a [Viewport], uses the default viewport instead. </member> @@ -124,6 +133,10 @@ <member name="editor_draw_screen" type="bool" setter="set_screen_drawing_enabled" getter="is_screen_drawing_enabled" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], draws the camera's screen rectangle in the editor. </member> + <member name="enabled" type="bool" setter="set_enabled" getter="is_enabled" default="true"> + Controls whether the camera can be active or not. If [code]true[/code], the [Camera2D] will become the main camera when it enters the scene tree and there is no active camera currently (see [method Viewport.get_camera_2d]). + When the camera is currently active and [member enabled] is set to [code]false[/code], the next enabled [Camera2D] in the scene tree will become active. + </member> <member name="ignore_rotation" type="bool" setter="set_ignore_rotation" getter="is_ignoring_rotation" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], the camera's rendered view is not affected by its [member Node2D.rotation] and [member Node2D.global_rotation]. </member> diff --git a/doc/classes/CanvasGroup.xml b/doc/classes/CanvasGroup.xml index 37827defec..6eeff8fef3 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CanvasGroup.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CanvasGroup.xml @@ -9,8 +9,10 @@ [codeblock] shader_type canvas_item; + uniform sampler2D screen_texture : hint_screen_texture, repeat_disable, filter_nearest; + void fragment() { - vec4 c = textureLod(SCREEN_TEXTURE, SCREEN_UV, 0.0); + vec4 c = textureLod(screen_texture, SCREEN_UV, 0.0); if (c.a > 0.0001) { c.rgb /= c.a; diff --git a/doc/classes/CanvasItem.xml b/doc/classes/CanvasItem.xml index fbab1d76a0..c3c768c12d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CanvasItem.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CanvasItem.xml @@ -42,10 +42,12 @@ <param index="3" name="end_angle" type="float" /> <param index="4" name="point_count" type="int" /> <param index="5" name="color" type="Color" /> - <param index="6" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="6" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="7" name="antialiased" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Draws a unfilled arc between the given angles. The larger the value of [param point_count], the smoother the curve. See also [method draw_circle]. + Draws an unfilled arc between the given angles with a uniform [param color] and [param width] and optional antialiasing (supported only for positive [param width]). The larger the value of [param point_count], the smoother the curve. See also [method draw_circle]. + If [param width] is negative, then the arc is drawn using [constant RenderingServer.PRIMITIVE_LINE_STRIP]. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the arc will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. + The arc is drawn from [param start_angle] towards the value of [param end_angle] so in clockwise direction if [code]start_angle < end_angle[/code] and counter-clockwise otherwise. Passing the same angles but in reversed order will produce the same arc. If absolute difference of [param start_angle] and [param end_angle] is greater than [constant @GDScript.TAU] radians, then a full circle arc is drawn (i.e. arc will not overlap itself). </description> </method> <method name="draw_char" qualifiers="const"> @@ -95,11 +97,12 @@ <param index="0" name="from" type="Vector2" /> <param index="1" name="to" type="Vector2" /> <param index="2" name="color" type="Color" /> - <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="4" name="dash" type="float" default="2.0" /> <param index="5" name="aligned" type="bool" default="true" /> <description> Draws a dashed line from a 2D point to another, with a given color and width. See also [method draw_multiline] and [method draw_polyline]. + If [param width] is negative, then a two-point primitives will be drawn instead of a four-point ones. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the line parts will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="draw_end_animation"> @@ -130,10 +133,11 @@ <param index="0" name="from" type="Vector2" /> <param index="1" name="to" type="Vector2" /> <param index="2" name="color" type="Color" /> - <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="4" name="antialiased" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> Draws a line from a 2D point to another, with a given color and width. It can be optionally antialiased. See also [method draw_multiline] and [method draw_polyline]. + If [param width] is negative, then a two-point primitive will be drawn instead of a four-point one. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the line will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="draw_mesh"> @@ -165,18 +169,20 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="points" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="1" name="color" type="Color" /> - <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <description> Draws multiple disconnected lines with a uniform [param color]. When drawing large amounts of lines, this is faster than using individual [method draw_line] calls. To draw interconnected lines, use [method draw_polyline] instead. + If [param width] is negative, then two-point primitives will be drawn instead of a four-point ones. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the lines will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="draw_multiline_colors"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="points" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="1" name="colors" type="PackedColorArray" /> - <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <description> Draws multiple disconnected lines with a uniform [param width] and segment-by-segment coloring. Colors assigned to line segments match by index between [param points] and [param colors]. When drawing large amounts of lines, this is faster than using individual [method draw_line] calls. To draw interconnected lines, use [method draw_polyline_colors] instead. + If [param width] is negative, then two-point primitives will be drawn instead of a four-point ones. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the lines will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="draw_multiline_string" qualifiers="const"> @@ -238,20 +244,22 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="points" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="1" name="color" type="Color" /> - <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="3" name="antialiased" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Draws interconnected line segments with a uniform [param color] and [param width] and optional antialiasing. When drawing large amounts of lines, this is faster than using individual [method draw_line] calls. To draw disconnected lines, use [method draw_multiline] instead. See also [method draw_polygon]. + Draws interconnected line segments with a uniform [param color] and [param width] and optional antialiasing (supported only for positive [param width]). When drawing large amounts of lines, this is faster than using individual [method draw_line] calls. To draw disconnected lines, use [method draw_multiline] instead. See also [method draw_polygon]. + If [param width] is negative, the polyline is drawn using [constant RenderingServer.PRIMITIVE_LINE_STRIP]. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the polyline will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="draw_polyline_colors"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="points" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="1" name="colors" type="PackedColorArray" /> - <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="2" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="3" name="antialiased" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Draws interconnected line segments with a uniform [param width] and segment-by-segment coloring, and optional antialiasing. Colors assigned to line segments match by index between [param points] and [param colors]. When drawing large amounts of lines, this is faster than using individual [method draw_line] calls. To draw disconnected lines, use [method draw_multiline_colors] instead. See also [method draw_polygon]. + Draws interconnected line segments with a uniform [param width] and segment-by-segment coloring, and optional antialiasing (supported only for positive [param width]). Colors assigned to line segments match by index between [param points] and [param colors]. When drawing large amounts of lines, this is faster than using individual [method draw_line] calls. To draw disconnected lines, use [method draw_multiline_colors] instead. See also [method draw_polygon]. + If [param width] is negative, then the polyline is drawn using [constant RenderingServer.PRIMITIVE_LINE_STRIP]. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the polyline will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="draw_primitive"> @@ -260,7 +268,6 @@ <param index="1" name="colors" type="PackedColorArray" /> <param index="2" name="uvs" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="3" name="texture" type="Texture2D" default="null" /> - <param index="4" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> <description> Draws a custom primitive. 1 point for a point, 2 points for a line, 3 points for a triangle, and 4 points for a quad. If 0 points or more than 4 points are specified, nothing will be drawn and an error message will be printed. See also [method draw_line], [method draw_polyline], [method draw_polygon], and [method draw_rect]. </description> @@ -270,10 +277,12 @@ <param index="0" name="rect" type="Rect2" /> <param index="1" name="color" type="Color" /> <param index="2" name="filled" type="bool" default="true" /> - <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <description> Draws a rectangle. If [param filled] is [code]true[/code], the rectangle will be filled with the [param color] specified. If [param filled] is [code]false[/code], the rectangle will be drawn as a stroke with the [param color] and [param width] specified. + If [param width] is negative, then two-point primitives will be drawn instead of a four-point ones. This means that when the CanvasItem is scaled, the lines will remain thin. If this behavior is not desired, then pass a positive [param width] like [code]1.0[/code]. [b]Note:[/b] [param width] is only effective if [param filled] is [code]false[/code]. + [b]Note:[/b] Unfilled rectangles drawn with a negative [param width] may not display perfectly. For example, corners may be missing or brighter due to overlapping lines (for a translucent [param color]). </description> </method> <method name="draw_set_transform"> diff --git a/doc/classes/CharacterBody3D.xml b/doc/classes/CharacterBody3D.xml index 821117122c..2ff207acb7 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CharacterBody3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CharacterBody3D.xml @@ -5,8 +5,9 @@ </brief_description> <description> Character bodies are special types of bodies that are meant to be user-controlled. They are not affected by physics at all; to other types of bodies, such as a rigid body, these are the same as a [AnimatableBody3D]. However, they have two main uses: - [b]Kinematic characters:[/b] Character bodies have an API for moving objects with walls and slopes detection ([method move_and_slide] method), in addition to collision detection (also done with [method PhysicsBody3D.move_and_collide]). This makes them really useful to implement characters that move in specific ways and collide with the world, but don't require advanced physics. - [b]Kinematic motion:[/b] Character bodies can also be used for kinematic motion (same functionality as [AnimatableBody3D]), which allows them to be moved by code and push other bodies on their path. + [i]Kinematic characters:[/i] Character bodies have an API for moving objects with walls and slopes detection ([method move_and_slide] method), in addition to collision detection (also done with [method PhysicsBody3D.move_and_collide]). This makes them really useful to implement characters that move in specific ways and collide with the world, but don't require advanced physics. + [i]Kinematic motion:[/i] Character bodies can also be used for kinematic motion (same functionality as [AnimatableBody3D]), which allows them to be moved by code and push other bodies on their path. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Kinematic character (2D)">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/physics/kinematic_character_2d.html</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/CodeEdit.xml b/doc/classes/CodeEdit.xml index 3ceb8967a0..df40d2a4cf 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CodeEdit.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CodeEdit.xml @@ -132,12 +132,6 @@ Perform an indent as if the user activated the "ui_text_indent" action. </description> </method> - <method name="do_unindent"> - <return type="void" /> - <description> - Perform an unindent as if the user activated the "ui_text_unindent" action. - </description> - </method> <method name="fold_all_lines"> <return type="void" /> <description> @@ -423,7 +417,7 @@ <method name="unindent_lines"> <return type="void" /> <description> - Unindents selected lines, or in the case of no selection the caret line by one. + Unindents selected lines, or in the case of no selection the caret line by one. Same as performing "ui_text_unindent" action. </description> </method> <method name="update_code_completion_options"> diff --git a/doc/classes/CollisionObject3D.xml b/doc/classes/CollisionObject3D.xml index c302963b92..01b0d88326 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CollisionObject3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CollisionObject3D.xml @@ -5,6 +5,7 @@ </brief_description> <description> CollisionObject3D is the base class for physics objects. It can hold any number of collision [Shape3D]s. Each shape must be assigned to a [i]shape owner[/i]. The CollisionObject3D can have any number of shape owners. Shape owners are not nodes and do not appear in the editor, but are accessible through code using the [code]shape_owner_*[/code] methods. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> @@ -216,13 +217,13 @@ <signal name="mouse_entered"> <description> Emitted when the mouse pointer enters any of this object's shapes. Requires [member input_ray_pickable] to be [code]true[/code] and at least one [member collision_layer] bit to be set. - [b]Note:[/b] Due to the lack of continuous collision detection, this signal may not be emitted in the expected order if the mouse moves fast enough and the [CollisionObject2D]'s area is small. This signal may also not be emitted if another [CollisionObject2D] is overlapping the [CollisionObject2D] in question. + [b]Note:[/b] Due to the lack of continuous collision detection, this signal may not be emitted in the expected order if the mouse moves fast enough and the [CollisionObject3D]'s area is small. This signal may also not be emitted if another [CollisionObject3D] is overlapping the [CollisionObject3D] in question. </description> </signal> <signal name="mouse_exited"> <description> Emitted when the mouse pointer exits all this object's shapes. Requires [member input_ray_pickable] to be [code]true[/code] and at least one [member collision_layer] bit to be set. - [b]Note:[/b] Due to the lack of continuous collision detection, this signal may not be emitted in the expected order if the mouse moves fast enough and the [CollisionObject2D]'s area is small. This signal may also not be emitted if another [CollisionObject2D] is overlapping the [CollisionObject2D] in question. + [b]Note:[/b] Due to the lack of continuous collision detection, this signal may not be emitted in the expected order if the mouse moves fast enough and the [CollisionObject3D]'s area is small. This signal may also not be emitted if another [CollisionObject3D] is overlapping the [CollisionObject3D] in question. </description> </signal> </signals> @@ -232,7 +233,7 @@ Automatically re-added to the physics simulation when the [Node] is processed again. </constant> <constant name="DISABLE_MODE_MAKE_STATIC" value="1" enum="DisableMode"> - When [member Node.process_mode] is set to [constant Node.PROCESS_MODE_DISABLED], make the body static. Doesn't affect [Area2D]. [PhysicsBody3D] can't be affected by forces or other bodies while static. + When [member Node.process_mode] is set to [constant Node.PROCESS_MODE_DISABLED], make the body static. Doesn't affect [Area3D]. [PhysicsBody3D] can't be affected by forces or other bodies while static. Automatically set [PhysicsBody3D] back to its original mode when the [Node] is processed again. </constant> <constant name="DISABLE_MODE_KEEP_ACTIVE" value="2" enum="DisableMode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/CollisionPolygon3D.xml b/doc/classes/CollisionPolygon3D.xml index 7d718cff27..29e55367a8 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CollisionPolygon3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CollisionPolygon3D.xml @@ -6,6 +6,7 @@ <description> Allows editing a concave or convex collision polygon's vertices on a selected plane. Can also set a depth perpendicular to that plane. This class is only available in the editor. It will not appear in the scene tree at run-time. Creates several [ConvexPolygonShape3D]s at run-time to represent the original polygon using convex decomposition. [b]Note:[/b] Since this is an editor-only helper, properties modified during gameplay will have no effect. + [b]Warning:[/b] A non-uniformly scaled CollisionPolygon3D node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change its [member polygon]'s vertices instead. </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> diff --git a/doc/classes/CollisionShape3D.xml b/doc/classes/CollisionShape3D.xml index 304b46ba27..c5d05670e9 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CollisionShape3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CollisionShape3D.xml @@ -6,6 +6,7 @@ <description> Editor facility for creating and editing collision shapes in 3D space. Set the [member shape] property to configure the shape. [b]IMPORTANT[/b]: this is an Editor-only helper to create shapes, use [method CollisionObject3D.shape_owner_get_shape] to get the actual shape. You can use this node to represent all sorts of collision shapes, for example, add this to an [Area3D] to give it a detection shape, or add it to a [PhysicsBody3D] to create a solid object. + [b]Warning:[/b] A non-uniformly scaled CollisionShape3D node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size of its [member shape] resource instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Physics introduction">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/physics/physics_introduction.html</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/Color.xml b/doc/classes/Color.xml index d1387d088d..cee0e3ef7d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Color.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Color.xml @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ <return type="Color" /> <param index="0" name="over" type="Color" /> <description> - Returns a new color resulting from overlaying this color over the given color. In a painting program, you can imagine it as the [param over] color painted over this colour (including alpha). + Returns a new color resulting from overlaying this color over the given color. In a painting program, you can imagine it as the [param over] color painted over this color (including alpha). [codeblocks] [gdscript] var bg = Color(0.0, 1.0, 0.0, 0.5) # Green with alpha of 50% @@ -233,7 +233,6 @@ <description> Returns a new color from [param rgba], an HTML hexadecimal color string. [param rgba] is not case-sensitive, and may be prefixed by a hash sign ([code]#[/code]). [param rgba] must be a valid three-digit or six-digit hexadecimal color string, and may contain an alpha channel value. If [param rgba] does not contain an alpha channel value, an alpha channel value of 1.0 is applied. If [param rgba] is invalid, returns an empty color. - [b]Note:[/b] In C#, this method is not implemented. The same functionality is provided by the Color constructor. [codeblocks] [gdscript] var blue = Color.html("#0000ff") # blue is Color(0.0, 0.0, 1.0, 1.0) @@ -264,13 +263,13 @@ Color.html_is_valid("#55aaFF5") # Returns false [/gdscript] [csharp] - Color.IsHtmlValid("#55AAFF"); // Returns true - Color.IsHtmlValid("#55AAFF20"); // Returns true - Color.IsHtmlValid("55AAFF"); // Returns true - Color.IsHtmlValid("#F2C"); // Returns true + Color.HtmlIsValid("#55AAFF"); // Returns true + Color.HtmlIsValid("#55AAFF20"); // Returns true + Color.HtmlIsValid("55AAFF"); // Returns true + Color.HtmlIsValid("#F2C"); // Returns true - Color.IsHtmlValid("#AABBC"); // Returns false - Color.IsHtmlValid("#55aaFF5"); // Returns false + Color.HtmlIsValid("#AABBC"); // Returns false + Color.HtmlIsValid("#55aaFF5"); // Returns false [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/ConfirmationDialog.xml b/doc/classes/ConfirmationDialog.xml index 48b4df9126..ac2ea5be17 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ConfirmationDialog.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ConfirmationDialog.xml @@ -8,10 +8,10 @@ To get cancel action, you can use: [codeblocks] [gdscript] - get_cancel_button().pressed.connect(self.cancelled) + get_cancel_button().pressed.connect(self.canceled) [/gdscript] [csharp] - GetCancelButton().Pressed += Cancelled; + GetCancelButton().Pressed += Canceled; [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/Control.xml b/doc/classes/Control.xml index 08964cf21d..d74ddba369 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Control.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Control.xml @@ -37,11 +37,11 @@ return typeof(data) == TYPE_DICTIONARY and data.has("expected") [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override bool CanDropData(Vector2 position, object data) + public override bool _CanDropData(Vector2 atPosition, Variant data) { // Check position if it is relevant to you // Otherwise, just check data - return data is Godot.Collections.Dictionary && (data as Godot.Collections.Dictionary).Contains("expected"); + return data.VariantType == Variant.Type.Dictionary && data.AsGodotDictionary().Contains("expected"); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -57,17 +57,19 @@ [gdscript] func _can_drop_data(position, data): return typeof(data) == TYPE_DICTIONARY and data.has("color") + func _drop_data(position, data): var color = data["color"] [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override bool CanDropData(Vector2 position, object data) + public override bool _CanDropData(Vector2 atPosition, Variant data) { - return data is Godot.Collections.Dictionary && (data as Godot.Collections.Dictionary).Contains("color"); + return data.VariantType == Variant.Type.Dictionary && dict.AsGodotDictionary().Contains("color"); } - public override void DropData(Vector2 position, object data) + + public override void _DropData(Vector2 atPosition, Variant data) { - Color color = (Color)(data as Godot.Collections.Dictionary)["color"]; + Color color = data.AsGodotDictionary()["color"].AsColor(); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -87,11 +89,11 @@ return mydata [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override object GetDragData(Vector2 position) + public override Variant _GetDragData(Vector2 atPosition) { - object mydata = MakeData(); // This is your custom method generating the drag data. - SetDragPreview(MakePreview(mydata)); // This is your custom method generating the preview of the drag data. - return mydata; + var myData = MakeData(); // This is your custom method generating the drag data. + SetDragPreview(MakePreview(myData)); // This is your custom method generating the preview of the drag data. + return myData; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -121,10 +123,9 @@ [csharp] public override void _GuiInput(InputEvent @event) { - if (@event is InputEventMouseButton) + if (@event is InputEventMouseButton mb) { - var mb = @event as InputEventMouseButton; - if (mb.ButtonIndex == (int)ButtonList.Left && mb.Pressed) + if (mb.ButtonIndex == MouseButton.Left && mb.Pressed) { GD.Print("I've been clicked D:"); } @@ -168,7 +169,7 @@ return label [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override Godot.Control _MakeCustomTooltip(String forText) + public override Control _MakeCustomTooltip(string forText) { var label = new Label(); label.Text = forText; @@ -180,14 +181,14 @@ [codeblocks] [gdscript] func _make_custom_tooltip(for_text): - var tooltip = preload("res://SomeTooltipScene.tscn").instantiate() + var tooltip = preload("res://some_tooltip_scene.tscn").instantiate() tooltip.get_node("Label").text = for_text return tooltip [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override Godot.Control _MakeCustomTooltip(String forText) + public override Control _MakeCustomTooltip(string forText) { - Node tooltip = ResourceLoader.Load<PackedScene>("res://SomeTooltipScene.tscn").Instantiate(); + Node tooltip = ResourceLoader.Load<PackedScene>("res://some_tooltip_scene.tscn").Instantiate(); tooltip.GetNode<Label>("Label").Text = forText; return tooltip; } @@ -196,12 +197,12 @@ </description> </method> <method name="_structured_text_parser" qualifiers="virtual const"> - <return type="Vector2i[]" /> + <return type="Vector3i[]" /> <param index="0" name="args" type="Array" /> <param index="1" name="text" type="String" /> <description> User defined BiDi algorithm override function. - Returns an [Array] of [Vector2i] text ranges, in the left-to-right order. Ranges should cover full source [param text] without overlaps. BiDi algorithm will be used on each range separately. + Returns an [Array] of [Vector3i] text ranges and text base directions, in the left-to-right order. Ranges should cover full source [param text] without overlaps. BiDi algorithm will be used on each range separately. </description> </method> <method name="accept_event"> @@ -229,11 +230,11 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // Given the child Label node "MyLabel", override its font color with a custom value. - GetNode<Label>("MyLabel").AddThemeColorOverride("font_color", new Color(1, 0.5f, 0)) + GetNode<Label>("MyLabel").AddThemeColorOverride("font_color", new Color(1, 0.5f, 0)); // Reset the font color of the child label. - GetNode<Label>("MyLabel").RemoveThemeColorOverride("font_color") + GetNode<Label>("MyLabel").RemoveThemeColorOverride("font_color"); // Alternatively it can be overridden with the default value from the Label type. - GetNode<Label>("MyLabel").AddThemeColorOverride("font_color", GetThemeColor("font_color", "Label")) + GetNode<Label>("MyLabel").AddThemeColorOverride("font_color", GetThemeColor("font_color", "Label")); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> @@ -383,7 +384,9 @@ <method name="get_global_rect" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Rect2" /> <description> - Returns the position and size of the control relative to the [CanvasLayer]. See [member global_position] and [member size]. + Returns the position and size of the control relative to the containing canvas. See [member global_position] and [member size]. + [b]Note:[/b] If the node itself or any parent [CanvasItem] between the node and the canvas have a non default rotation or skew, the resulting size is likely not meaningful. + [b]Note:[/b] Setting [member Viewport.gui_snap_controls_to_pixels] to [code]true[/code] can lead to rounding inaccuracies between the displayed control and the returned [Rect2]. </description> </method> <method name="get_minimum_size" qualifiers="const"> @@ -414,7 +417,9 @@ <method name="get_rect" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Rect2" /> <description> - Returns the position and size of the control relative to the top-left corner of the parent Control. See [member position] and [member size]. + Returns the position and size of the control in the coordinate system of the containing node. See [member position], [member scale] and [member size]. + [b]Note:[/b] If [member rotation] is not the default rotation, the resulting size is not meaningful. + [b]Note:[/b] Setting [member Viewport.gui_snap_controls_to_pixels] to [code]true[/code] can lead to rounding inaccuracies between the displayed control and the returned [Rect2]. </description> </method> <method name="get_screen_position" qualifiers="const"> @@ -538,12 +543,12 @@ [codeblocks] [gdscript] func _process(delta): - grab_click_focus() #when clicking another Control node, this node will be clicked instead + grab_click_focus() # When clicking another Control node, this node will be clicked instead. [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override void _Process(float delta) + public override void _Process(double delta) { - GrabClickFocus(); //when clicking another Control node, this node will be clicked instead + GrabClickFocus(); // When clicking another Control node, this node will be clicked instead. } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -808,16 +813,16 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] [Export] - public Color Color = new Color(1, 0, 0, 1); + private Color _color = new Color(1, 0, 0, 1); - public override object GetDragData(Vector2 position) + public override Variant _GetDragData(Vector2 atPosition) { // Use a control that is not in the tree var cpb = new ColorPickerButton(); - cpb.Color = Color; - cpb.RectSize = new Vector2(50, 50); + cpb.Color = _color; + cpb.Size = new Vector2(50, 50); SetDragPreview(cpb); - return Color; + return _color; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -895,6 +900,7 @@ <param index="0" name="position" type="Vector2" /> <description> Moves the mouse cursor to [param position], relative to [member position] of this [Control]. + [b]Note:[/b] [method warp_mouse] is only supported on Windows, macOS and Linux. It has no effect on Android, iOS and Web. </description> </method> </methods> @@ -991,7 +997,7 @@ By default, the node's pivot is its top-left corner. When you change its [member rotation] or [member scale], it will rotate or scale around this pivot. Set this property to [member size] / 2 to pivot around the Control's center. </member> <member name="position" type="Vector2" setter="_set_position" getter="get_position" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> - The node's position, relative to its parent. It corresponds to the rectangle's top-left corner. The property is not affected by [member pivot_offset]. + The node's position, relative to its containing node. It corresponds to the rectangle's top-left corner. The property is not affected by [member pivot_offset]. </member> <member name="rotation" type="float" setter="set_rotation" getter="get_rotation" default="0.0"> The node's rotation around its pivot, in radians. See [member pivot_offset] to change the pivot's position. @@ -1008,7 +1014,7 @@ The [Node] which must be a parent of the focused [Control] for the shortcut to be activated. If [code]null[/code], the shortcut can be activated when any control is focused (a global shortcut). This allows shortcuts to be accepted only when the user has a certain area of the GUI focused. </member> <member name="size" type="Vector2" setter="_set_size" getter="get_size" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> - The size of the node's bounding rectangle, in pixels. [Container] nodes update this property automatically. + The size of the node's bounding rectangle, in the node's coordinate system. [Container] nodes update this property automatically. </member> <member name="size_flags_horizontal" type="int" setter="set_h_size_flags" getter="get_h_size_flags" enum="Control.SizeFlags" default="1"> Tells the parent [Container] nodes how they should resize and place the node on the X axis. Use one of the [enum SizeFlags] constants to change the flags. See the constants to learn what each does. diff --git a/doc/classes/ConvexPolygonShape3D.xml b/doc/classes/ConvexPolygonShape3D.xml index 32dc8f673b..66d2280280 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ConvexPolygonShape3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ConvexPolygonShape3D.xml @@ -4,7 +4,7 @@ Convex polygon shape resource for 3D physics. </brief_description> <description> - 3D convex polygon shape resource to be added as a [i]direct[/i] child of a [PhysicsBody3D] or [Area3D] using a [CollisionShape3D] node. Unlike [ConcavePolygonShape3D], [ConvexPolygonShape3D] cannot store concave polygon shapes. [ConvexPolygonShape2D]s can be manually drawn in the editor using the [CollisionPolygon3D] node. + 3D convex polygon shape resource to be added as a [i]direct[/i] child of a [PhysicsBody3D] or [Area3D] using a [CollisionShape3D] node. Unlike [ConcavePolygonShape3D], [ConvexPolygonShape3D] cannot store concave polygon shapes. [ConvexPolygonShape3D]s can be manually drawn in the editor using the [CollisionPolygon3D] node. [b]Convex decomposition:[/b] Concave objects' collisions can be represented accurately using [i]several[/i] [ConvexPolygonShape3D]s. This allows dynamic physics bodies to have complex concave collisions (at a performance cost). This is available in the editor by selecting the [MeshInstance3D], going to the [b]Mesh[/b] menu and choosing [b]Create Multiple Convex Collision Siblings[/b]. Alternatively, [method MeshInstance3D.create_multiple_convex_collisions] can be called in a script to perform this decomposition at run-time. [b]Performance:[/b] [ConvexPolygonShape3D] is faster to check collisions against compared to [ConcavePolygonShape3D], but it is slower than primitive collision shapes such as [SphereShape3D] or [BoxShape3D]. Its use should generally be limited to medium-sized objects that cannot have their collision accurately represented by a primitive shape. </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/Crypto.xml b/doc/classes/Crypto.xml index ade63225dc..a7e7e756c6 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Crypto.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Crypto.xml @@ -9,9 +9,11 @@ [codeblocks] [gdscript] extends Node + var crypto = Crypto.new() var key = CryptoKey.new() var cert = X509Certificate.new() + func _ready(): # Generate new RSA key. key = crypto.generate_rsa(4096) @@ -35,35 +37,35 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; using System.Diagnostics; - public class CryptoNode : Node + public partial class MyNode : Node { - public Crypto Crypto = new Crypto(); - public CryptoKey Key = new CryptoKey(); - public X509Certificate Cert = new X509Certificate(); + private Crypto _crypto = new Crypto(); + private CryptoKey _key = new CryptoKey(); + private X509Certificate _cert = new X509Certificate(); + public override void _Ready() { // Generate new RSA key. - Key = Crypto.GenerateRsa(4096); + _key = _crypto.GenerateRsa(4096); // Generate new self-signed certificate with the given key. - Cert = Crypto.GenerateSelfSignedCertificate(Key, "CN=mydomain.com,O=My Game Company,C=IT"); + _cert = _crypto.GenerateSelfSignedCertificate(_key, "CN=mydomain.com,O=My Game Company,C=IT"); // Save key and certificate in the user folder. - Key.Save("user://generated.key"); - Cert.Save("user://generated.crt"); + _key.Save("user://generated.key"); + _cert.Save("user://generated.crt"); // Encryption string data = "Some data"; - byte[] encrypted = Crypto.Encrypt(Key, data.ToUTF8()); + byte[] encrypted = _crypto.Encrypt(_key, data.ToUtf8()); // Decryption - byte[] decrypted = Crypto.Decrypt(Key, encrypted); + byte[] decrypted = _crypto.Decrypt(_key, encrypted); // Signing - byte[] signature = Crypto.Sign(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256, Data.SHA256Buffer(), Key); + byte[] signature = _crypto.Sign(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256, Data.Sha256Buffer(), _key); // Verifying - bool verified = Crypto.Verify(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256, Data.SHA256Buffer(), signature, Key); + bool verified = _crypto.Verify(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256, Data.Sha256Buffer(), signature, _key); // Checks Debug.Assert(verified); - Debug.Assert(data.ToUTF8() == decrypted); + Debug.Assert(data.ToUtf8() == decrypted); } } [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/Cubemap.xml b/doc/classes/Cubemap.xml index 46ddede9b1..01ec4c40d7 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Cubemap.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Cubemap.xml @@ -11,4 +11,12 @@ </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderCubemap]). + </description> + </method> + </methods> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/CubemapArray.xml b/doc/classes/CubemapArray.xml index 2fd55b66c6..1b410671c1 100644 --- a/doc/classes/CubemapArray.xml +++ b/doc/classes/CubemapArray.xml @@ -12,4 +12,12 @@ </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderCubemapArray]). + </description> + </method> + </methods> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Curve2D.xml b/doc/classes/Curve2D.xml index b5e75dff68..fe597d0955 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Curve2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Curve2D.xml @@ -162,6 +162,8 @@ <param index="0" name="max_stages" type="int" default="5" /> <param index="1" name="tolerance_length" type="float" default="20.0" /> <description> + Returns a list of points along the curve, with almost uniform density. [param max_stages] controls how many subdivisions a curve segment may face before it is considered approximate enough. Each subdivision splits the segment in half, so the default 5 stages may mean up to 32 subdivisions per curve segment. Increase with care! + [param tolerance_length] controls the maximal distance between two neighboring points, before the segment has to be subdivided. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/Curve3D.xml b/doc/classes/Curve3D.xml index 362d792b39..72ac95a700 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Curve3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Curve3D.xml @@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ <param index="1" name="tolerance_length" type="float" default="0.2" /> <description> Returns a list of points along the curve, with almost uniform density. [param max_stages] controls how many subdivisions a curve segment may face before it is considered approximate enough. Each subdivision splits the segment in half, so the default 5 stages may mean up to 32 subdivisions per curve segment. Increase with care! - [param tolerance_length] controls the maximal distance between two neighbouring points, before the segment has to be subdivided. + [param tolerance_length] controls the maximal distance between two neighboring points, before the segment has to be subdivided. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/DTLSServer.xml b/doc/classes/DTLSServer.xml index 9af8be99ef..ae1ba10ec7 100644 --- a/doc/classes/DTLSServer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/DTLSServer.xml @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ Below a small example of how to use it: [codeblocks] [gdscript] - # ServerNode.gd + # server_node.gd extends Node var dtls := DTLSServer.new() @@ -38,45 +38,46 @@ p.put_packet("Hello DTLS client".to_utf8()) [/gdscript] [csharp] - using Godot; - using System; // ServerNode.cs - public class ServerNode : Node + using Godot; + + public partial class ServerNode : Node { - public DTLSServer Dtls = new DTLSServer(); - public UDPServer Server = new UDPServer(); - public Godot.Collections.Array<PacketPeerDTLS> Peers = new Godot.Collections.Array<PacketPeerDTLS>(); + private DtlsServer _dtls = new DtlsServer(); + private UdpServer _server = new UdpServer(); + private Godot.Collections.Array<PacketPeerDTLS> _peers = new Godot.Collections.Array<PacketPeerDTLS>(); + public override void _Ready() { - Server.Listen(4242); + _server.Listen(4242); var key = GD.Load<CryptoKey>("key.key"); // Your private key. var cert = GD.Load<X509Certificate>("cert.crt"); // Your X509 certificate. - Dtls.Setup(key, cert); + _dtls.Setup(key, cert); } - public override void _Process(float delta) + public override void _Process(double delta) { while (Server.IsConnectionAvailable()) { - PacketPeerUDP peer = Server.TakeConnection(); - PacketPeerDTLS dtlsPeer = Dtls.TakeConnection(peer); - if (dtlsPeer.GetStatus() != PacketPeerDTLS.Status.Handshaking) + PacketPeerUDP peer = _server.TakeConnection(); + PacketPeerDTLS dtlsPeer = _dtls.TakeConnection(peer); + if (dtlsPeer.GetStatus() != PacketPeerDtls.Status.Handshaking) { continue; // It is normal that 50% of the connections fails due to cookie exchange. } GD.Print("Peer connected!"); - Peers.Add(dtlsPeer); + _peers.Add(dtlsPeer); } - foreach (var p in Peers) + foreach (var p in _peers) { p.Poll(); // Must poll to update the state. - if (p.GetStatus() == PacketPeerDTLS.Status.Connected) + if (p.GetStatus() == PacketPeerDtls.Status.Connected) { while (p.GetAvailablePacketCount() > 0) { - GD.Print("Received Message From Client: " + p.GetPacket().GetStringFromUTF8()); - p.PutPacket("Hello Dtls Client".ToUTF8()); + GD.Print($"Received Message From Client: {p.GetPacket().GetStringFromUtf8()}"); + p.PutPacket("Hello DTLS Client".ToUtf8()); } } } @@ -86,7 +87,7 @@ [/codeblocks] [codeblocks] [gdscript] - # ClientNode.gd + # client_node.gd extends Node var dtls := PacketPeerDTLS.new() @@ -108,34 +109,36 @@ connected = true [/gdscript] [csharp] + // ClientNode.cs using Godot; using System.Text; - // ClientNode.cs - public class ClientNode : Node + + public partial class ClientNode : Node { - public PacketPeerDTLS Dtls = new PacketPeerDTLS(); - public PacketPeerUDP Udp = new PacketPeerUDP(); - public bool Connected = false; + private PacketPeerDtls _dtls = new PacketPeerDtls(); + private PacketPeerUdp _udp = new PacketPeerUdp(); + private bool _connected = false; + public override void _Ready() { - Udp.ConnectToHost("127.0.0.1", 4242); - Dtls.ConnectToPeer(Udp, false); // Use true in production for certificate validation! + _udp.ConnectToHost("127.0.0.1", 4242); + _dtls.ConnectToPeer(_udp, validateCerts: false); // Use true in production for certificate validation! } - public override void _Process(float delta) + public override void _Process(double delta) { - Dtls.Poll(); - if (Dtls.GetStatus() == PacketPeerDTLS.Status.Connected) + _dtls.Poll(); + if (_dtls.GetStatus() == PacketPeerDtls.Status.Connected) { - if (!Connected) + if (!_connected) { // Try to contact server - Dtls.PutPacket("The Answer Is..42!".ToUTF8()); + _dtls.PutPacket("The Answer Is..42!".ToUtf8()); } - while (Dtls.GetAvailablePacketCount() > 0) + while (_dtls.GetAvailablePacketCount() > 0) { - GD.Print("Connected: " + Dtls.GetPacket().GetStringFromUTF8()); - Connected = true; + GD.Print($"Connected: {_dtls.GetPacket().GetStringFromUtf8()}"); + _connected = true; } } } @@ -148,11 +151,9 @@ <methods> <method name="setup"> <return type="int" enum="Error" /> - <param index="0" name="key" type="CryptoKey" /> - <param index="1" name="certificate" type="X509Certificate" /> - <param index="2" name="chain" type="X509Certificate" default="null" /> + <param index="0" name="server_options" type="TLSOptions" /> <description> - Setup the DTLS server to use the given [param key] and provide the given [param certificate] to clients. You can pass the optional [param chain] parameter to provide additional CA chain information along with the certificate. + Setup the DTLS server to use the given [param server_options]. See [method TLSOptions.server]. </description> </method> <method name="take_connection"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Dictionary.xml b/doc/classes/Dictionary.xml index 5f99ba82b8..a5a50b4c6a 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Dictionary.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Dictionary.xml @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ You can access a dictionary's value by referencing its corresponding key. In the above example, [code]points_dict["White"][/code] will return [code]50[/code]. You can also write [code]points_dict.White[/code], which is equivalent. However, you'll have to use the bracket syntax if the key you're accessing the dictionary with isn't a fixed string (such as a number or variable). [codeblocks] [gdscript] - @export(String, "White", "Yellow", "Orange") var my_color + @export_enum("White", "Yellow", "Orange") var my_color: String var points_dict = {"White": 50, "Yellow": 75, "Orange": 100} func _ready(): # We can't use dot syntax here as `my_color` is a variable. @@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ [csharp] [Export(PropertyHint.Enum, "White,Yellow,Orange")] public string MyColor { get; set; } - public Godot.Collections.Dictionary pointsDict = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary + private Godot.Collections.Dictionary _pointsDict = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary { {"White", 50}, {"Yellow", 75}, @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ public override void _Ready() { - int points = (int)pointsDict[MyColor]; + int points = (int)_pointsDict[MyColor]; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -153,7 +153,7 @@ <return type="Dictionary" /> <param index="0" name="from" type="Dictionary" /> <description> - Returns the same array as [param from]. If you need a copy of the array, use [method duplicate]. + Returns the same dictionary as [param from]. If you need a copy of the dictionary, use [method duplicate]. </description> </constructor> </constructors> @@ -271,12 +271,24 @@ Returns [code]true[/code] if the dictionary is empty (its size is [code]0[/code]). See also [method size]. </description> </method> + <method name="is_read_only" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if the dictionary is read-only. See [method make_read_only]. Dictionaries are automatically read-only if declared with [code]const[/code] keyword. + </description> + </method> <method name="keys" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Array" /> <description> Returns the list of keys in the dictionary. </description> </method> + <method name="make_read_only"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Makes the dictionary read-only, i.e. disables modification of the dictionary's contents. Does not apply to nested content, e.g. content of nested dictionaries. + </description> + </method> <method name="merge"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="dictionary" type="Dictionary" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/DirAccess.xml b/doc/classes/DirAccess.xml index 181d2eb485..27f2eb7f2f 100644 --- a/doc/classes/DirAccess.xml +++ b/doc/classes/DirAccess.xml @@ -44,11 +44,11 @@ { if (dir.CurrentIsDir()) { - GD.Print("Found directory: " + fileName); + GD.Print($"Found directory: {fileName}"); } else { - GD.Print("Found file: " + fileName); + GD.Print($"Found file: {fileName}"); } fileName = dir.GetNext(); } diff --git a/doc/classes/DisplayServer.xml b/doc/classes/DisplayServer.xml index 5da6cf8102..6f4a7fc13d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/DisplayServer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/DisplayServer.xml @@ -190,6 +190,7 @@ <description> Adds a new checkable item with text [param label] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -211,6 +212,7 @@ <description> Adds a new checkable item with text [param label] and icon [param icon] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -232,6 +234,7 @@ <description> Adds a new item with text [param label] and icon [param icon] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -254,6 +257,7 @@ Adds a new radio-checkable item with text [param label] and icon [param icon] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. [b]Note:[/b] Radio-checkable items just display a checkmark, but don't have any built-in checking behavior and must be checked/unchecked manually. See [method global_menu_set_item_checked] for more info on how to control it. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -274,6 +278,7 @@ <description> Adds a new item with text [param label] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -285,7 +290,7 @@ <method name="global_menu_add_multistate_item"> <return type="int" /> <param index="0" name="menu_root" type="String" /> - <param index="1" name="labe" type="String" /> + <param index="1" name="label" type="String" /> <param index="2" name="max_states" type="int" /> <param index="3" name="default_state" type="int" /> <param index="4" name="callback" type="Callable" /> @@ -294,10 +299,11 @@ <param index="7" name="accelerator" type="int" enum="Key" default="0" /> <param index="8" name="index" type="int" default="-1" /> <description> - Adds a new item with text [param labe] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. + Adds a new item with text [param label] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Contrarily to normal binary items, multistate items can have more than two states, as defined by [param max_states]. Each press or activate of the item will increase the state by one. The default value is defined by [param default_state]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. [b]Note:[/b] By default, there's no indication of the current item state, it should be changed manually. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -319,6 +325,7 @@ Adds a new radio-checkable item with text [param label] to the global menu with ID [param menu_root]. Returns index of the inserted item, it's not guaranteed to be the same as [param index] value. [b]Note:[/b] Radio-checkable items just display a checkmark, but don't have any built-in checking behavior and must be checked/unchecked manually. See [method global_menu_set_item_checked] for more info on how to control it. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] and [param key_callback] Callables need to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callables will be the value passed to [param tag]. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. [b]Supported system menu IDs:[/b] [codeblock] @@ -562,6 +569,7 @@ <param index="2" name="callback" type="Callable" /> <description> Sets the callback of the item at index [param idx]. Callback is emitted when an item is pressed. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param callback] Callable needs to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callable will be the value passed to the tag parameter when the menu item was created. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. </description> </method> @@ -623,6 +631,7 @@ <param index="2" name="key_callback" type="Callable" /> <description> Sets the callback of the item at index [param idx]. Callback is emitted when its accelerator is activated. + [b]Note:[/b] The [param key_callback] Callable needs to accept exactly one Variant parameter, the parameter passed to the Callable will be the value passed to the tag parameter when the menu item was created. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on macOS. </description> </method> @@ -1090,6 +1099,7 @@ <param index="0" name="position" type="Vector2i" /> <description> Sets the mouse cursor position to the given [param position] relative to an origin at the upper left corner of the currently focused game Window Manager window. + [b]Note:[/b] [method warp_mouse] is only supported on Windows, macOS and Linux. It has no effect on Android, iOS and Web. </description> </method> <method name="window_can_draw" qualifiers="const"> @@ -1434,9 +1444,9 @@ <param index="0" name="vsync_mode" type="int" enum="DisplayServer.VSyncMode" /> <param index="1" name="window_id" type="int" default="0" /> <description> - Sets the V-Sync mode of the given window. + Sets the V-Sync mode of the given window. See also [member ProjectSettings.display/window/vsync/vsync_mode]. See [enum DisplayServer.VSyncMode] for possible values and how they affect the behavior of your application. - Depending on the platform and used renderer, the engine will fall back to [constant VSYNC_ENABLED], if the desired mode is not supported. + Depending on the platform and used renderer, the engine will fall back to [constant VSYNC_ENABLED] if the desired mode is not supported. </description> </method> <method name="window_set_window_buttons_offset"> @@ -1694,7 +1704,10 @@ Use [method window_get_safe_title_margins] to determine area under the title bar that is not covered by decorations. [b]Note:[/b] This flag is implemented on macOS. </constant> - <constant name="WINDOW_FLAG_MAX" value="7" enum="WindowFlags"> + <constant name="WINDOW_FLAG_MOUSE_PASSTHROUGH" value="7" enum="WindowFlags"> + All mouse events are passed to the underlying window of the same application. + </constant> + <constant name="WINDOW_FLAG_MAX" value="8" enum="WindowFlags"> Max value of the [enum WindowFlags]. </constant> <constant name="WINDOW_EVENT_MOUSE_ENTER" value="0" enum="WindowEvent"> diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorCommandPalette.xml b/doc/classes/EditorCommandPalette.xml index 380c79fc1a..448a622ae4 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorCommandPalette.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorCommandPalette.xml @@ -16,7 +16,7 @@ [csharp] EditorCommandPalette commandPalette = GetEditorInterface().GetCommandPalette(); // ExternalCommand is a function that will be called with the command is executed. - Callable commandCallable = new Callable(this, nameof(ExternalCommand)); + Callable commandCallable = new Callable(this, MethodName.ExternalCommand); commandPalette.AddCommand("command", "test/command", commandCallable) [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorFileSystem.xml b/doc/classes/EditorFileSystem.xml index e8df6ae7fe..5f33c68a7d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorFileSystem.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorFileSystem.xml @@ -71,12 +71,6 @@ This will not import the file. To reimport, call [method reimport_files] or [method scan] methods. </description> </method> - <method name="update_script_classes"> - <return type="void" /> - <description> - Scans the script files and updates the list of custom class names. - </description> - </method> </methods> <signals> <signal name="filesystem_changed"> @@ -96,6 +90,11 @@ Emitted if at least one resource is reloaded when the filesystem is scanned. </description> </signal> + <signal name="script_classes_updated"> + <description> + Emitted when the list of global script classes gets updated. + </description> + </signal> <signal name="sources_changed"> <param index="0" name="exist" type="bool" /> <description> diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorImportPlugin.xml b/doc/classes/EditorImportPlugin.xml index c395815117..b30ce5a528 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorImportPlugin.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorImportPlugin.xml @@ -37,8 +37,8 @@ return [{"name": "my_option", "default_value": false}] func _import(source_file, save_path, options, platform_variants, gen_files): - var file = File.new() - if file.open(source_file, File.READ) != OK: + var file = FileAccess.open(source_file, FileAccess.READ) + if file == null: return FAILED var mesh = ArrayMesh.new() # Fill the Mesh with data read in "file", left as an exercise to the reader. @@ -48,61 +48,67 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; - public class MySpecialPlugin : EditorImportPlugin + public partial class MySpecialPlugin : EditorImportPlugin { - public override String GetImporterName() + public override string _GetImporterName() { return "my.special.plugin"; } - public override String GetVisibleName() + public override string _GetVisibleName() { return "Special Mesh"; } - public override Godot.Collections.Array GetRecognizedExtensions() + public override string[] _GetRecognizedExtensions() { - return new Godot.Collections.Array{"special", "spec"}; + return new string[] { "special", "spec" }; } - public override String GetSaveExtension() + public override string _GetSaveExtension() { return "mesh"; } - public override String GetResourceType() + public override string _GetResourceType() { return "Mesh"; } - public override int GetPresetCount() + public override int _GetPresetCount() { return 1; } - public override String GetPresetName(int i) + public override string _GetPresetName(int presetIndex) { return "Default"; } - public override Godot.Collections.Array GetImportOptions(int i) + public override Godot.Collections.Array<Godot.Collections.Dictionary> _GetImportOptions(string path, int presetIndex) { - return new Godot.Collections.Array{new Godot.Collections.Dictionary{{"name", "myOption"}, {"defaultValue", false}}}; + return new Godot.Collections.Array<Godot.Collections.Dictionary> + { + new Godot.Collections.Dictionary + { + { "name", "myOption" }, + { "defaultValue", false }, + } + }; } - public override int Import(String sourceFile, String savePath, Godot.Collections.Dictionary options, Godot.Collections.Array platformVariants, Godot.Collections.Array genFiles) + public override int _Import(string sourceFile, string savePath, Godot.Collections.Dictionary options, Godot.Collections.Array<string> platformVariants, Godot.Collections.Array<string> genFiles) { - var file = new File(); - if (file.Open(sourceFile, File.ModeFlags.Read) != Error.Ok) + using var file = FileAccess.Open(sourceFile, FileAccess.ModeFlags.Read); + if (file.GetError() != Error.Ok) { return (int)Error.Failed; } var mesh = new ArrayMesh(); // Fill the Mesh with data read in "file", left as an exercise to the reader. - String filename = savePath + "." + GetSaveExtension(); + string filename = $"{savePath}.{_GetSaveExtension()}"; return (int)ResourceSaver.Save(mesh, filename); } } diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorPlugin.xml b/doc/classes/EditorPlugin.xml index b44c1d7ffa..f4b912de9e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorPlugin.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorPlugin.xml @@ -41,6 +41,7 @@ <param index="0" name="object" type="Variant" /> <description> This function is used for plugins that edit specific object types (nodes or resources). It requests the editor to edit the given object. + [param object] can be [code]null[/code] if the plugin was editing an object, but there is no longer any selected object handled by this plugin. It can be used to cleanup editing state. </description> </method> <method name="_enable_plugin" qualifiers="virtual"> @@ -68,21 +69,22 @@ return EditorPlugin.AFTER_GUI_INPUT_PASS [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override void _Forward3dDrawOverViewport(Godot.Control overlay) + public override void _Forward3DDrawOverViewport(Control viewportControl) { // Draw a circle at cursor position. - overlay.DrawCircle(overlay.GetLocalMousePosition(), 64, Colors.White); + viewportControl.DrawCircle(viewportControl.GetLocalMousePosition(), 64, Colors.White); } - public override EditorPlugin.AfterGUIInput _Forward3dGuiInput(Godot.Camera3D camera, InputEvent @event) + public override EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput _Forward3DGuiInput(Camera3D viewportCamera, InputEvent @event) { if (@event is InputEventMouseMotion) { // Redraw viewport when cursor is moved. UpdateOverlays(); - return EditorPlugin.AFTER_GUI_INPUT_STOP; + return EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput.Stop; } - return EditorPlugin.AFTER_GUI_INPUT_PASS; + return EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput.Pass; + } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> @@ -110,9 +112,9 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // Prevents the InputEvent from reaching other Editor classes. - public override EditorPlugin.AfterGUIInput _Forward3dGuiInput(Camera3D camera, InputEvent @event) + public override EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput _Forward3DGuiInput(Camera3D camera, InputEvent @event) { - return EditorPlugin.AFTER_GUI_INPUT_STOP; + return EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput.Stop; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -126,9 +128,9 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // Consumes InputEventMouseMotion and forwards other InputEvent types. - public override EditorPlugin.AfterGUIInput _Forward3dGuiInput(Camera3D camera, InputEvent @event) + public override EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput _Forward3DGuiInput(Camera3D camera, InputEvent @event) { - return @event is InputEventMouseMotion ? EditorPlugin.AFTER_GUI_INPUT_STOP : EditorPlugin.AFTER_GUI_INPUT_PASS; + return @event is InputEventMouseMotion ? EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput.Stop : EditorPlugin.AfterGuiInput.Pass; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -143,7 +145,7 @@ [gdscript] func _forward_canvas_draw_over_viewport(overlay): # Draw a circle at cursor position. - overlay.draw_circle(overlay.get_local_mouse_position(), 64, Color.white) + overlay.draw_circle(overlay.get_local_mouse_position(), 64, Color.WHITE) func _forward_canvas_gui_input(event): if event is InputEventMouseMotion: @@ -153,13 +155,13 @@ return false [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override void ForwardCanvasDrawOverViewport(Godot.Control overlay) + public override void _ForwardCanvasDrawOverViewport(Control viewportControl) { // Draw a circle at cursor position. - overlay.DrawCircle(overlay.GetLocalMousePosition(), 64, Colors.White); + viewportControl.DrawCircle(viewportControl.GetLocalMousePosition(), 64, Colors.White); } - public override bool ForwardCanvasGuiInput(InputEvent @event) + public override bool _ForwardCanvasGuiInput(InputEvent @event) { if (@event is InputEventMouseMotion) { @@ -168,6 +170,7 @@ return true; } return false; + } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> @@ -212,12 +215,13 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // Consumes InputEventMouseMotion and forwards other InputEvent types. - public override bool ForwardCanvasGuiInput(InputEvent @event) + public override bool _ForwardCanvasGuiInput(InputEvent @event) { - if (@event is InputEventMouseMotion) { + if (@event is InputEventMouseMotion) + { return true; } - return false + return false; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -244,7 +248,7 @@ return get_editor_interface().get_base_control().get_theme_icon("Node", "EditorIcons") [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override Texture2D GetPluginIcon() + public override Texture2D _GetPluginIcon() { // You can use a custom icon: return ResourceLoader.Load<Texture2D>("res://addons/my_plugin/my_plugin_icon.svg"); @@ -347,7 +351,7 @@ [codeblock] func _set_state(data): zoom = data.get("zoom", 1.0) - preferred_color = data.get("my_color", Color.white) + preferred_color = data.get("my_color", Color.WHITE) [/codeblock] </description> </method> @@ -359,7 +363,7 @@ [codeblock] func _set_window_layout(configuration): $Window.position = configuration.get_value("MyPlugin", "window_position", Vector2()) - $Icon.modulate = configuration.get_value("MyPlugin", "icon_color", Color.white) + $Icon.modulate = configuration.get_value("MyPlugin", "icon_color", Color.WHITE) [/codeblock] </description> </method> @@ -408,6 +412,7 @@ <description> Adds a custom type, which will appear in the list of nodes or resources. An icon can be optionally passed. When a given node or resource is selected, the base type will be instantiated (e.g. "Node3D", "Control", "Resource"), then the script will be loaded and set to this object. + [b]Note:[/b] The base type is the base engine class which this type's class hierarchy inherits, not any custom type parent classes. You can use the virtual method [method _handles] to check if your custom object is being edited by checking the script or using the [code]is[/code] keyword. During run-time, this will be a simple object with a script so this function does not need to be called then. [b]Note:[/b] Custom types added this way are not true classes. They are just a helper to create a node with specific script. @@ -467,6 +472,14 @@ See [method add_inspector_plugin] for an example of how to register a plugin. </description> </method> + <method name="add_resource_conversion_plugin"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="plugin" type="EditorResourceConversionPlugin" /> + <description> + Registers a new [EditorResourceConversionPlugin]. Resource conversion plugins are used to add custom resource converters to the editor inspector. + See [EditorResourceConversionPlugin] for an example of how to create a resource conversion plugin. + </description> + </method> <method name="add_scene_format_importer_plugin"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="scene_format_importer" type="EditorSceneFormatImporter" /> @@ -632,6 +645,13 @@ Removes a gizmo plugin registered by [method add_node_3d_gizmo_plugin]. </description> </method> + <method name="remove_resource_conversion_plugin"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="plugin" type="EditorResourceConversionPlugin" /> + <description> + Removes a resource conversion plugin registered by [method add_resource_conversion_plugin]. + </description> + </method> <method name="remove_scene_format_importer_plugin"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="scene_format_importer" type="EditorSceneFormatImporter" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorResourceConversionPlugin.xml b/doc/classes/EditorResourceConversionPlugin.xml index c40bb1d91e..6bdfbbe40c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorResourceConversionPlugin.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorResourceConversionPlugin.xml @@ -1,8 +1,28 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="EditorResourceConversionPlugin" inherits="RefCounted" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> + Plugin for adding custom converters from one resource format to another in the editor resource picker context menu; for example, converting a [StandardMaterial3D] to a [ShaderMaterial]. </brief_description> <description> + [EditorResourceConversionPlugin] is invoked when the context menu is brought up for a resource in the editor inspector. Relevant conversion plugins will appear as menu options to convert the given resource to a target type. + Below shows an example of a basic plugin that will convert an [ImageTexture] to a [PortableCompressedTexture2D]. + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + extends EditorResourceConversionPlugin + + func _handles(resource : Resource): + return resource is ImageTexture + + func _converts_to(): + return "PortableCompressedTexture2D" + + func _convert(itex : Resource): + var ptex = PortableCompressedTexture2D.new() + ptex.create_from_image(itex.get_image(), PortableCompressedTexture2D.COMPRESSION_MODE_LOSSLESS) + return ptex + [/gdscript] + [/codeblocks] + To use an [EditorResourceConversionPlugin], register it using the [method EditorPlugin.add_resource_conversion_plugin] method first. </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> @@ -11,17 +31,20 @@ <return type="Resource" /> <param index="0" name="resource" type="Resource" /> <description> + Takes an input [Resource] and converts it to the type given in [method _converts_to]. The returned [Resource] is the result of the conversion, and the input [Resource] remains unchanged. </description> </method> <method name="_converts_to" qualifiers="virtual const"> <return type="String" /> <description> + Returns the class name of the target type of [Resource] that this plugin converts source resources to. </description> </method> <method name="_handles" qualifiers="virtual const"> <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="resource" type="Resource" /> <description> + Called to determine whether a particular [Resource] can be converted to the target resource type by this plugin. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorScenePostImport.xml b/doc/classes/EditorScenePostImport.xml index d2ad8d1bed..44bc72ea49 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorScenePostImport.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorScenePostImport.xml @@ -10,12 +10,14 @@ [gdscript] @tool # Needed so it runs in editor. extends EditorScenePostImport + # This sample changes all node names. # Called right after the scene is imported and gets the root node. func _post_import(scene): # Change all node names to "modified_[oldnodename]" iterate(scene) return scene # Remember to return the imported scene + func iterate(node): if node != null: node.name = "modified_" + node.name @@ -30,17 +32,18 @@ [Tool] public partial class NodeRenamer : EditorScenePostImport { - public override Object _PostImport(Node scene) + public override GodotObject _PostImport(Node scene) { // Change all node names to "modified_[oldnodename]" Iterate(scene); return scene; // Remember to return the imported scene } + public void Iterate(Node node) { if (node != null) { - node.Name = "modified_" + node.Name; + node.Name = $"modified_{node.Name}"; foreach (Node child in node.GetChildren()) { Iterate(child); diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorScript.xml b/doc/classes/EditorScript.xml index a02fd215d8..33d2f40d0b 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorScript.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorScript.xml @@ -17,10 +17,9 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; [Tool] - public class HelloEditor : EditorScript + public partial class HelloEditor : EditorScript { public override void _Run() { diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorSettings.xml b/doc/classes/EditorSettings.xml index 98f4789163..1bf8cbf175 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorSettings.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorSettings.xml @@ -22,7 +22,7 @@ settings.SetSetting("some/property", Value); // `settings.get("some/property", value)` also works as this class overrides `_get()` internally. settings.GetSetting("some/property"); - Godot.Collections.Array listOfSettings = settings.GetPropertyList(); + Godot.Collections.Array<Godot.Collections.Dictionary> listOfSettings = settings.GetPropertyList(); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] This class shouldn't be instantiated directly. Instead, access the singleton using [method EditorInterface.get_editor_settings]. @@ -433,12 +433,24 @@ The size to use for port previews in the visual shader uniforms (toggled by clicking the "eye" icon next to an output). The value is defined in pixels at 100% zoom, and will scale with zoom automatically. </member> <member name="filesystem/directories/autoscan_project_path" type="String" setter="" getter=""> - The folder where projects should be scanned for (recursively), in a way similar to the project manager's [b]Scan[/b]button. This can be set to the same value as [member filesystem/directories/default_project_path] for convenience. + The folder where projects should be scanned for (recursively), in a way similar to the project manager's [b]Scan[/b] button. This can be set to the same value as [member filesystem/directories/default_project_path] for convenience. [b]Note:[/b] Setting this path to a folder with very large amounts of files/folders can slow down the project manager startup significantly. To keep the project manager quick to start up, it is recommended to set this value to a folder as "specific" as possible. </member> <member name="filesystem/directories/default_project_path" type="String" setter="" getter=""> The folder where new projects should be created by default when clicking the project manager's [b]New Project[/b] button. This can be set to the same value as [member filesystem/directories/autoscan_project_path] for convenience. </member> + <member name="filesystem/external_programs/3d_model_editor" type="String" setter="" getter=""> + The program that opens 3D model scene files when clicking "Open in External Program" option in Filesystem Dock. If not specified, the file will be opened in the system's default program. + </member> + <member name="filesystem/external_programs/audio_editor" type="String" setter="" getter=""> + The program that opens audio files when clicking "Open in External Program" option in Filesystem Dock. If not specified, the file will be opened in the system's default program. + </member> + <member name="filesystem/external_programs/raster_image_editor" type="String" setter="" getter=""> + The program that opens raster image files when clicking "Open in External Program" option in Filesystem Dock. If not specified, the file will be opened in the system's default program. + </member> + <member name="filesystem/external_programs/vector_image_editor" type="String" setter="" getter=""> + The program that opens vector image files when clicking "Open in External Program" option in Filesystem Dock. If not specified, the file will be opened in the system's default program. + </member> <member name="filesystem/file_dialog/display_mode" type="int" setter="" getter=""> The display mode to use in the editor's file dialogs. - [b]Thumbnails[/b] takes more space, but displays dynamic resource thumbnails, making resources easier to preview without having to open them. @@ -499,7 +511,7 @@ </member> <member name="interface/editor/editor_language" type="String" setter="" getter=""> The language to use for the editor interface. - Translations are provided by the community. If you spot a mistake, [url=https://docs.godotengine.org/en/latest/community/contributing/editor_and_docs_localization.html]contribute to editor translations on Weblate![/url] + Translations are provided by the community. If you spot a mistake, [url=$DOCS_URL/contributing/documentation/editor_and_docs_localization.html]contribute to editor translations on Weblate![/url] </member> <member name="interface/editor/expand_to_title" type="bool" setter="" getter=""> Expanding main editor window content to the title, if supported by [DisplayServer]. See [constant DisplayServer.WINDOW_FLAG_EXTEND_TO_TITLE]. @@ -595,6 +607,10 @@ <member name="interface/theme/draw_extra_borders" type="bool" setter="" getter=""> If [code]true[/code], draws additional borders around interactive UI elements in the editor. This is automatically enabled when using the [b]Black (OLED)[/b] theme preset, as this theme preset uses a fully black background. </member> + <member name="interface/theme/enable_touchscreen_touch_area" type="bool" setter="" getter=""> + If [code]true[/code], increases the touch area for the UI elements to improve usability on touchscreen devices. + [b]Note:[/b] Defaults to [code]true[/code] on touchscreen devices. + </member> <member name="interface/theme/icon_and_font_color" type="int" setter="" getter=""> The icon and font color scheme to use in the editor. - [b]Auto[/b] determines the color scheme to use automatically based on [member interface/theme/base_color]. @@ -741,7 +757,7 @@ </member> <member name="text_editor/behavior/indent/type" type="int" setter="" getter=""> The indentation style to use (tabs or spaces). - [b]Note:[/b] The [url=https://docs.godotengine.org/en/latest/getting_started/scripting/gdscript/gdscript_styleguide.html]GDScript style guide[/url] recommends using tabs for indentation. It is advised to change this setting only if you need to work on a project that currently uses spaces for indentation. + [b]Note:[/b] The [url=$DOCS_URL/getting_started/scripting/gdscript/gdscript_styleguide.html]GDScript style guide[/url] recommends using tabs for indentation. It is advised to change this setting only if you need to work on a project that currently uses spaces for indentation. </member> <member name="text_editor/behavior/navigation/drag_and_drop_selection" type="bool" setter="" getter=""> If [code]true[/code], allows drag-and-dropping text in the script editor to move text. Disable this if you find yourself accidentally drag-and-dropping text in the script editor. @@ -782,7 +798,7 @@ If [code]true[/code], the code completion tooltip will appear below the current line unless there is no space on screen below the current line. If [code]false[/code], the code completion tooltip will appear above the current line. </member> <member name="text_editor/completion/use_single_quotes" type="bool" setter="" getter=""> - If [code]true[/code], performs string autocompletion with single quotes. If [code]false[/code], performs string autocompletion with double quotes (which matches the [url=https://docs.godotengine.org/en/latest/tutorials/scripting/gdscript/gdscript_styleguide.html]GDScript style guide[/url]). + If [code]true[/code], performs string autocompletion with single quotes. If [code]false[/code], performs string autocompletion with double quotes (which matches the [url=$DOCS_URL/tutorials/scripting/gdscript/gdscript_styleguide.html]GDScript style guide[/url]). </member> <member name="text_editor/help/class_reference_examples" type="int" setter="" getter=""> Controls which multi-line code blocks should be displayed in the editor help. This setting does not affect single-line code literals in the editor help. diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorTranslationParserPlugin.xml b/doc/classes/EditorTranslationParserPlugin.xml index df10c645ef..40b469de0a 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorTranslationParserPlugin.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorTranslationParserPlugin.xml @@ -15,8 +15,7 @@ extends EditorTranslationParserPlugin func _parse_file(path, msgids, msgids_context_plural): - var file = File.new() - file.open(path, File.READ) + var file = FileAccess.open(path, FileAccess.READ) var text = file.get_as_text() var split_strs = text.split(",", false) for s in split_strs: @@ -28,27 +27,25 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; [Tool] - public class CustomParser : EditorTranslationParserPlugin + public partial class CustomParser : EditorTranslationParserPlugin { - public override void ParseFile(string path, Godot.Collections.Array msgids, Godot.Collections.Array msgidsContextPlural) + public override void _ParseFile(string path, Godot.Collections.Array<string> msgids, Godot.Collections.Array<Godot.Collections.Array> msgidsContextPlural) { - var file = new File(); - file.Open(path, File.ModeFlags.Read); + using var file = FileAccess.Open(path, FileAccess.ModeFlags.Read); string text = file.GetAsText(); - string[] splitStrs = text.Split(",", false); - foreach (var s in splitStrs) + string[] splitStrs = text.Split(",", allowEmpty: false); + foreach (string s in splitStrs) { msgids.Add(s); - //GD.Print("Extracted string: " + s) + //GD.Print($"Extracted string: {s}"); } } - public override Godot.Collections.Array GetRecognizedExtensions() + public override string[] _GetRecognizedExtensions() { - return new Godot.Collections.Array{"csv"}; + return new string[] { "csv" }; } } [/csharp] @@ -85,16 +82,16 @@ return ["gd"] [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override void ParseFile(string path, Godot.Collections.Array msgids, Godot.Collections.Array msgidsContextPlural) + public override void _ParseFile(string path, Godot.Collections.Array<string> msgids, Godot.Collections.Array<Godot.Collections.Array> msgidsContextPlural) { var res = ResourceLoader.Load<Script>(path, "Script"); string text = res.SourceCode; // Parsing logic. } - public override Godot.Collections.Array GetRecognizedExtensions() + public override string[] _GetRecognizedExtensions() { - return new Godot.Collections.Array{"gd"}; + return new string[] { "gd" }; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/EditorUndoRedoManager.xml b/doc/classes/EditorUndoRedoManager.xml index cd96e740e8..4d6938e6aa 100644 --- a/doc/classes/EditorUndoRedoManager.xml +++ b/doc/classes/EditorUndoRedoManager.xml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="EditorUndoRedoManager" inherits="RefCounted" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> +<class name="EditorUndoRedoManager" inherits="Object" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> Manages undo history of scenes opened in the editor. </brief_description> diff --git a/doc/classes/Expression.xml b/doc/classes/Expression.xml index 4670e0c382..fd5a921836 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Expression.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Expression.xml @@ -24,23 +24,23 @@ $LineEdit.text = str(result) [/gdscript] [csharp] - public Expression expression = new Expression(); + private Expression _expression = new Expression(); public override void _Ready() { - GetNode("LineEdit").TextSubmitted += OnTextEntered; + GetNode<LineEdit>("LineEdit").TextSubmitted += OnTextEntered; } private void OnTextEntered(string command) { - Error error = expression.Parse(command); + Error error = _expression.Parse(command); if (error != Error.Ok) { - GD.Print(expression.GetErrorText()); + GD.Print(_expression.GetErrorText()); return; } - object result = expression.Execute(); - if (!expression.HasExecuteFailed()) + Variant result = _expression.Execute(); + if (!_expression.HasExecuteFailed()) { GetNode<LineEdit>("LineEdit").Text = result.ToString(); } diff --git a/doc/classes/FileAccess.xml b/doc/classes/FileAccess.xml index be0c8fd6ca..687a64b8ff 100644 --- a/doc/classes/FileAccess.xml +++ b/doc/classes/FileAccess.xml @@ -348,8 +348,8 @@ f.Seek(0); // Go back to start to read the stored value. ushort read1 = f.Get16(); // 65494 ushort read2 = f.Get16(); // 121 - short converted1 = BitConverter.ToInt16(BitConverter.GetBytes(read1), 0); // -42 - short converted2 = BitConverter.ToInt16(BitConverter.GetBytes(read2), 0); // 121 + short converted1 = (short)read1; // -42 + short converted2 = (short)read2; // 121 } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/FileSystemDock.xml b/doc/classes/FileSystemDock.xml index 00f5c7ddff..f76bc2c279 100644 --- a/doc/classes/FileSystemDock.xml +++ b/doc/classes/FileSystemDock.xml @@ -51,5 +51,10 @@ <description> </description> </signal> + <signal name="resource_removed"> + <param index="0" name="resource" type="Resource" /> + <description> + </description> + </signal> </signals> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/GPUParticles2D.xml b/doc/classes/GPUParticles2D.xml index c7d10078e8..29779e4a77 100644 --- a/doc/classes/GPUParticles2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/GPUParticles2D.xml @@ -5,7 +5,8 @@ </brief_description> <description> 2D particle node used to create a variety of particle systems and effects. [GPUParticles2D] features an emitter that generates some number of particles at a given rate. - Use the [code]process_material[/code] property to add a [ParticleProcessMaterial] to configure particle appearance and behavior. Alternatively, you can add a [ShaderMaterial] which will be applied to all particles. + Use the [member process_material] property to add a [ParticleProcessMaterial] to configure particle appearance and behavior. Alternatively, you can add a [ShaderMaterial] which will be applied to all particles. + 2D particles can optionally collide with [LightOccluder2D] nodes (note: they don't collide with [PhysicsBody2D] nodes). </description> <tutorials> <link title="Particle systems (2D)">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/2d/particle_systems_2d.html</link> @@ -42,6 +43,7 @@ Number of particles emitted in one emission cycle. </member> <member name="collision_base_size" type="float" setter="set_collision_base_size" getter="get_collision_base_size" default="1.0"> + Multiplier for particle's collision radius. [code]1.0[/code] corresponds to the size of the sprite. </member> <member name="draw_order" type="int" setter="set_draw_order" getter="get_draw_order" enum="GPUParticles2D.DrawOrder" default="1"> Particle draw order. Uses [enum DrawOrder] values. diff --git a/doc/classes/Geometry2D.xml b/doc/classes/Geometry2D.xml index 0142018f1a..f015026bc1 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Geometry2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Geometry2D.xml @@ -160,14 +160,13 @@ var polygon = PackedVector2Array([Vector2(0, 0), Vector2(100, 0), Vector2(100, 100), Vector2(0, 100)]) var offset = Vector2(50, 50) polygon = Transform2D(0, offset) * polygon - print(polygon) # prints [Vector2(50, 50), Vector2(150, 50), Vector2(150, 150), Vector2(50, 150)] + print(polygon) # prints [(50, 50), (150, 50), (150, 150), (50, 150)] [/gdscript] [csharp] var polygon = new Vector2[] { new Vector2(0, 0), new Vector2(100, 0), new Vector2(100, 100), new Vector2(0, 100) }; var offset = new Vector2(50, 50); - // TODO: This code is not valid right now. Ping @aaronfranke about it before Godot 4.0 is out. - //polygon = (Vector2[]) new Transform2D(0, offset).Xform(polygon); - //GD.Print(polygon); // prints [Vector2(50, 50), Vector2(150, 50), Vector2(150, 150), Vector2(50, 150)] + polygon = new Transform2D(0, offset) * polygon; + GD.Print((Variant)polygon); // prints [(50, 50), (150, 50), (150, 150), (50, 150)] [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/GeometryInstance3D.xml b/doc/classes/GeometryInstance3D.xml index 1ae4718536..127c5daf95 100644 --- a/doc/classes/GeometryInstance3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/GeometryInstance3D.xml @@ -21,7 +21,10 @@ <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> <param index="1" name="value" type="Variant" /> <description> - Set the value of a shader parameter for this instance only. + Set the value of a shader uniform for this instance only ([url=$DOCS_URL/tutorials/shaders/shader_reference/shading_language.html#per-instance-uniforms]per-instance uniform[/url]). See also [method ShaderMaterial.set_shader_parameter] to assign a uniform on all instances using the same [ShaderMaterial]. + [b]Note:[/b] For a shader uniform to be assignable on a per-instance basis, it [i]must[/i] be defined with [code]instance uniform ...[/code] rather than [code]uniform ...[/code] in the shader code. + [b]Note:[/b] [param name] is case-sensitive and must match the name of the uniform in the code exactly (not the capitalized name in the inspector). + [b]Note:[/b] Per-instance shader uniforms are currently only available in 3D, so there is no 2D equivalent of this method. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/GraphEdit.xml b/doc/classes/GraphEdit.xml index ea4e4b53ba..490637374d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/GraphEdit.xml +++ b/doc/classes/GraphEdit.xml @@ -72,8 +72,9 @@ return from != to [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override bool _IsNodeHoverValid(String from, int fromSlot, String to, int toSlot) { - return from != to; + public override bool _IsNodeHoverValid(StringName fromNode, int fromPort, StringName toNode, int toPort) + { + return fromNode != toNode; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/HMACContext.xml b/doc/classes/HMACContext.xml index 706ee30963..fbdc6b5e64 100644 --- a/doc/classes/HMACContext.xml +++ b/doc/classes/HMACContext.xml @@ -26,25 +26,24 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; using System.Diagnostics; - public class CryptoNode : Node + public partial class MyNode : Node { - private HMACContext ctx = new HMACContext(); + private HmacContext _ctx = new HmacContext(); public override void _Ready() { - byte[] key = "supersecret".ToUTF8(); - Error err = ctx.Start(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256, key); + byte[] key = "supersecret".ToUtf8(); + Error err = _ctx.Start(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256, key); Debug.Assert(err == Error.Ok); - byte[] msg1 = "this is ".ToUTF8(); - byte[] msg2 = "super duper secret".ToUTF8(); - err = ctx.Update(msg1); + byte[] msg1 = "this is ".ToUtf8(); + byte[] msg2 = "super duper secret".ToUtf8(); + err = _ctx.Update(msg1); Debug.Assert(err == Error.Ok); - err = ctx.Update(msg2); + err = _ctx.Update(msg2); Debug.Assert(err == Error.Ok); - byte[] hmac = ctx.Finish(); + byte[] hmac = _ctx.Finish(); GD.Print(hmac.HexEncode()); } } diff --git a/doc/classes/HTTPClient.xml b/doc/classes/HTTPClient.xml index b3ed38d250..4973f3fddf 100644 --- a/doc/classes/HTTPClient.xml +++ b/doc/classes/HTTPClient.xml @@ -30,13 +30,10 @@ <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="host" type="String" /> <param index="1" name="port" type="int" default="-1" /> - <param index="2" name="use_tls" type="bool" default="false" /> - <param index="3" name="verify_host" type="bool" default="true" /> + <param index="2" name="tls_options" type="TLSOptions" default="null" /> <description> Connects to a host. This needs to be done before any requests are sent. - The host should not have http:// prepended but will strip the protocol identifier if provided. - If no [param port] is specified (or [code]-1[/code] is used), it is automatically set to 80 for HTTP and 443 for HTTPS (if [param use_tls] is enabled). - [param verify_host] will check the TLS identity of the host if set to [code]true[/code]. + If no [param port] is specified (or [code]-1[/code] is used), it is automatically set to 80 for HTTP and 443 for HTTPS. You can pass the optional [param tls_options] parameter to customize the trusted certification authorities, or the common name verification when using HTTPS. See [method TLSOptions.client] and [method TLSOptions.client_unsafe]. </description> </method> <method name="get_response_body_length" qualifiers="const"> @@ -108,7 +105,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] var fields = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary { { "username", "user" }, { "password", "pass" } }; - string queryString = new HTTPClient().QueryStringFromDict(fields); + string queryString = httpClient.QueryStringFromDict(fields); // Returns "username=user&password=pass" [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -120,8 +117,13 @@ # Returns "single=123&not_valued&multiple=22&multiple=33&multiple=44" [/gdscript] [csharp] - var fields = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary{{"single", 123}, {"notValued", null}, {"multiple", new Godot.Collections.Array{22, 33, 44}}}; - string queryString = new HTTPClient().QueryStringFromDict(fields); + var fields = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary + { + { "single", 123 }, + { "notValued", default }, + { "multiple", new Godot.Collections.Array { 22, 33, 44 } }, + }; + string queryString = httpClient.QueryStringFromDict(fields); // Returns "single=123&not_valued&multiple=22&multiple=33&multiple=44" [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -154,7 +156,7 @@ [csharp] var fields = new Godot.Collections.Dictionary { { "username", "user" }, { "password", "pass" } }; string queryString = new HTTPClient().QueryStringFromDict(fields); - string[] headers = {"Content-Type: application/x-www-form-urlencoded", "Content-Length: " + queryString.Length}; + string[] headers = { "Content-Type: application/x-www-form-urlencoded", $"Content-Length: {queryString.Length}" }; var result = new HTTPClient().Request(HTTPClient.Method.Post, "index.php", headers, queryString); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/HTTPRequest.xml b/doc/classes/HTTPRequest.xml index c504e26d58..5a0b12e198 100644 --- a/doc/classes/HTTPRequest.xml +++ b/doc/classes/HTTPRequest.xml @@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ // Perform a POST request. The URL below returns JSON as of writing. // Note: Don't make simultaneous requests using a single HTTPRequest node. // The snippet below is provided for reference only. - string body = new JSON().Stringify(new Godot.Collections.Dictionary + string body = new Json().Stringify(new Godot.Collections.Dictionary { { "name", "Godette" } }); @@ -69,14 +69,14 @@ } // Called when the HTTP request is completed. - private void HttpRequestCompleted(int result, int response_code, string[] headers, byte[] body) + private void HttpRequestCompleted(long result, long responseCode, string[] headers, byte[] body) { - var json = new JSON(); - json.Parse(body.GetStringFromUTF8()); - var response = json.GetData() as Godot.Collections.Dictionary; + var json = new Json(); + json.Parse(body.GetStringFromUtf8()); + var response = json.GetData().AsGodotDictionary(); // Will print the user agent string used by the HTTPRequest node (as recognized by httpbin.org). - GD.Print((response["headers"] as Godot.Collections.Dictionary)["User-Agent"]); + GD.Print((response["headers"].AsGodotDictionary())["User-Agent"]); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -128,9 +128,9 @@ } // Called when the HTTP request is completed. - private void HttpRequestCompleted(int result, int response_code, string[] headers, byte[] body) + private void HttpRequestCompleted(long result, long responseCode, string[] headers, byte[] body) { - if (result != (int)HTTPRequest.Result.Success) + if (result != (long)HTTPRequest.Result.Success) { GD.PushError("Image couldn't be downloaded. Try a different image."); } @@ -187,9 +187,8 @@ <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="url" type="String" /> <param index="1" name="custom_headers" type="PackedStringArray" default="PackedStringArray()" /> - <param index="2" name="tls_validate_domain" type="bool" default="true" /> - <param index="3" name="method" type="int" enum="HTTPClient.Method" default="0" /> - <param index="4" name="request_data" type="String" default="""" /> + <param index="2" name="method" type="int" enum="HTTPClient.Method" default="0" /> + <param index="3" name="request_data" type="String" default="""" /> <description> Creates request on the underlying [HTTPClient]. If there is no configuration errors, it tries to connect using [method HTTPClient.connect_to_host] and passes parameters onto [method HTTPClient.request]. Returns [constant OK] if request is successfully created. (Does not imply that the server has responded), [constant ERR_UNCONFIGURED] if not in the tree, [constant ERR_BUSY] if still processing previous request, [constant ERR_INVALID_PARAMETER] if given string is not a valid URL format, or [constant ERR_CANT_CONNECT] if not using thread and the [HTTPClient] cannot connect to host. @@ -201,9 +200,8 @@ <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="url" type="String" /> <param index="1" name="custom_headers" type="PackedStringArray" default="PackedStringArray()" /> - <param index="2" name="tls_validate_domain" type="bool" default="true" /> - <param index="3" name="method" type="int" enum="HTTPClient.Method" default="0" /> - <param index="4" name="request_data_raw" type="PackedByteArray" default="PackedByteArray()" /> + <param index="2" name="method" type="int" enum="HTTPClient.Method" default="0" /> + <param index="3" name="request_data_raw" type="PackedByteArray" default="PackedByteArray()" /> <description> Creates request on the underlying [HTTPClient] using a raw array of bytes for the request body. If there is no configuration errors, it tries to connect using [method HTTPClient.connect_to_host] and passes parameters onto [method HTTPClient.request]. Returns [constant OK] if request is successfully created. (Does not imply that the server has responded), [constant ERR_UNCONFIGURED] if not in the tree, [constant ERR_BUSY] if still processing previous request, [constant ERR_INVALID_PARAMETER] if given string is not a valid URL format, or [constant ERR_CANT_CONNECT] if not using thread and the [HTTPClient] cannot connect to host. @@ -227,6 +225,13 @@ The proxy server is unset if [param host] is empty or [param port] is -1. </description> </method> + <method name="set_tls_options"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="client_options" type="TLSOptions" /> + <description> + Sets the [TLSOptions] to be used when connecting to an HTTPS server. See [method TLSOptions.client]. + </description> + </method> </methods> <members> <member name="accept_gzip" type="bool" setter="set_accept_gzip" getter="is_accepting_gzip" default="true"> diff --git a/doc/classes/HashingContext.xml b/doc/classes/HashingContext.xml index 6e3092e618..5223cbf52f 100644 --- a/doc/classes/HashingContext.xml +++ b/doc/classes/HashingContext.xml @@ -8,18 +8,17 @@ The [enum HashType] enum shows the supported hashing algorithms. [codeblocks] [gdscript] - const CHUNK_SIZE = 102 + const CHUNK_SIZE = 1024 func hash_file(path): - var ctx = HashingContext.new() - var file = File.new() - # Start a SHA-256 context. - ctx.start(HashingContext.HASH_SHA256) # Check that file exists. - if not file.file_exists(path): + if not FileAccess.file_exists(path): return + # Start a SHA-256 context. + var ctx = HashingContext.new() + ctx.start(HashingContext.HASH_SHA256) # Open the file to hash. - file.open(path, File.READ) + var file = FileAccess.open(path, FileAccess.READ) # Update the context after reading each chunk. while not file.eof_reached(): ctx.update(file.get_buffer(CHUNK_SIZE)) @@ -33,17 +32,16 @@ public void HashFile(string path) { - var ctx = new HashingContext(); - var file = new File(); - // Start a SHA-256 context. - ctx.Start(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256); // Check that file exists. - if (!file.FileExists(path)) + if (!FileAccess.FileExists(path)) { return; } + // Start a SHA-256 context. + var ctx = new HashingContext(); + ctx.Start(HashingContext.HashType.Sha256); // Open the file to hash. - file.Open(path, File.ModeFlags.Read); + using var file = FileAccess.Open(path, FileAccess.ModeFlags.Read); // Update the context after reading each chunk. while (!file.EofReached()) { @@ -52,8 +50,7 @@ // Get the computed hash. byte[] res = ctx.Finish(); // Print the result as hex string and array. - - GD.PrintT(res.HexEncode(), res); + GD.PrintT(res.HexEncode(), (Variant)res); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/HeightMapShape3D.xml b/doc/classes/HeightMapShape3D.xml index 206981e547..f34870c500 100644 --- a/doc/classes/HeightMapShape3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/HeightMapShape3D.xml @@ -14,10 +14,10 @@ Height map data, pool array must be of [member map_width] * [member map_depth] size. </member> <member name="map_depth" type="int" setter="set_map_depth" getter="get_map_depth" default="2"> - Depth of the height map data. Changing this will resize the [member map_data]. + Number of vertices in the depth of the height map. Changing this will resize the [member map_data]. </member> <member name="map_width" type="int" setter="set_map_width" getter="get_map_width" default="2"> - Width of the height map data. Changing this will resize the [member map_data]. + Number of vertices in the width of the height map. Changing this will resize the [member map_data]. </member> </members> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Image.xml b/doc/classes/Image.xml index ed1b40488e..5b07124b91 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Image.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Image.xml @@ -75,12 +75,10 @@ <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="mode" type="int" enum="Image.CompressMode" /> <param index="1" name="source" type="int" enum="Image.CompressSource" default="0" /> - <param index="2" name="lossy_quality" type="float" default="0.7" /> - <param index="3" name="astc_format" type="int" enum="Image.ASTCFormat" default="0" /> + <param index="2" name="astc_format" type="int" enum="Image.ASTCFormat" default="0" /> <description> Compresses the image to use less memory. Can not directly access pixel data while the image is compressed. Returns error if the chosen compression mode is not available. The [param mode] parameter helps to pick the best compression method for DXT and ETC2 formats. It is ignored for ASTC compression. - The [param lossy_quality] parameter is optional for compressors that support it. For ASTC compression, the [param astc_format] parameter must be supplied. </description> </method> @@ -88,12 +86,10 @@ <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="mode" type="int" enum="Image.CompressMode" /> <param index="1" name="channels" type="int" enum="Image.UsedChannels" /> - <param index="2" name="lossy_quality" type="float" default="0.7" /> - <param index="3" name="astc_format" type="int" enum="Image.ASTCFormat" default="0" /> + <param index="2" name="astc_format" type="int" enum="Image.ASTCFormat" default="0" /> <description> Compresses the image to use less memory. Can not directly access pixel data while the image is compressed. Returns error if the chosen compression mode is not available. This is an alternative to [method compress] that lets the user supply the channels used in order for the compressor to pick the best DXT and ETC2 formats. For other formats (non DXT or ETC2), this argument is ignored. - The [param lossy_quality] parameter is optional for compressors that support it. For ASTC compression, the [param astc_format] parameter must be supplied. </description> </method> @@ -489,7 +485,7 @@ var img = Image.new() img.create(img_width, img_height, false, Image.FORMAT_RGBA8) - img.set_pixel(1, 2, Color.red) # Sets the color at (1, 2) to red. + img.set_pixel(1, 2, Color.RED) # Sets the color at (1, 2) to red. [/gdscript] [csharp] int imgWidth = 10; @@ -517,7 +513,7 @@ var img = Image.new() img.create(img_width, img_height, false, Image.FORMAT_RGBA8) - img.set_pixelv(Vector2i(1, 2), Color.red) # Sets the color at (1, 2) to red. + img.set_pixelv(Vector2i(1, 2), Color.RED) # Sets the color at (1, 2) to red. [/gdscript] [csharp] int imgWidth = 10; @@ -525,7 +521,7 @@ var img = new Image(); img.Create(imgWidth, imgHeight, false, Image.Format.Rgba8); - img.SetPixelv(new Vector2i(1, 2), Colors.Red); // Sets the color at (1, 2) to red. + img.SetPixelv(new Vector2I(1, 2), Colors.Red); // Sets the color at (1, 2) to red. [/csharp] [/codeblocks] This is the same as [method set_pixel], but with a [Vector2i] argument instead of two integer arguments. diff --git a/doc/classes/ImporterMesh.xml b/doc/classes/ImporterMesh.xml index b80857a7bf..10479dfcfe 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ImporterMesh.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ImporterMesh.xml @@ -27,9 +27,13 @@ <param index="5" name="name" type="String" default="""" /> <param index="6" name="flags" type="int" default="0" /> <description> - Creates a new surface, analogous to [method ArrayMesh.add_surface_from_arrays]. - Surfaces are created to be rendered using a [param primitive], which may be any of the types defined in [enum Mesh.PrimitiveType]. (As a note, when using indices, it is recommended to only use points, lines, or triangles.) [method Mesh.get_surface_count] will become the [code]surf_idx[/code] for this new surface. - The [param arrays] argument is an array of arrays. See [enum Mesh.ArrayType] for the values used in this array. For example, [code]arrays[0][/code] is the array of vertices. That first vertex sub-array is always required; the others are optional. Adding an index array puts this function into "index mode" where the vertex and other arrays become the sources of data and the index array defines the vertex order. All sub-arrays must have the same length as the vertex array (or be an exact multiple of the vertex array's length, when multiple elements of a sub-array correspond to a single vertex) or be empty, except for [constant Mesh.ARRAY_INDEX] if it is used. + Creates a new surface. [method Mesh.get_surface_count] will become the [code]surf_idx[/code] for this new surface. + Surfaces are created to be rendered using a [param primitive], which may be any of the values defined in [enum Mesh.PrimitiveType]. + The [param arrays] argument is an array of arrays. Each of the [constant Mesh.ARRAY_MAX] elements contains an array with some of the mesh data for this surface as described by the corresponding member of [enum Mesh.ArrayType] or [code]null[/code] if it is not used by the surface. For example, [code]arrays[0][/code] is the array of vertices. That first vertex sub-array is always required; the others are optional. Adding an index array puts this surface into "index mode" where the vertex and other arrays become the sources of data and the index array defines the vertex order. All sub-arrays must have the same length as the vertex array (or be an exact multiple of the vertex array's length, when multiple elements of a sub-array correspond to a single vertex) or be empty, except for [constant Mesh.ARRAY_INDEX] if it is used. + The [param blend_shapes] argument is an array of vertex data for each blend shape. Each element is an array of the same structure as [param arrays], but [constant Mesh.ARRAY_VERTEX], [constant Mesh.ARRAY_NORMAL], and [constant Mesh.ARRAY_TANGENT] are set if and only if they are set in [param arrays] and all other entries are [code]null[/code]. + The [param lods] argument is a dictionary with [float] keys and [PackedInt32Array] values. Each entry in the dictionary represents a LOD level of the surface, where the value is the [constant Mesh.ARRAY_INDEX] array to use for the LOD level and the key is roughly proportional to the distance at which the LOD stats being used. I.e., increasing the key of a LOD also increases the distance that the objects has to be from the camera before the LOD is used. + The [param flags] argument is the bitwise or of, as required: One value of [enum Mesh.ArrayCustomFormat] left shifted by [code]ARRAY_FORMAT_CUSTOMn_SHIFT[/code] for each custom channel in use, [constant Mesh.ARRAY_FLAG_USE_DYNAMIC_UPDATE], [constant Mesh.ARRAY_FLAG_USE_8_BONE_WEIGHTS], or [constant Mesh.ARRAY_FLAG_USES_EMPTY_VERTEX_ARRAY]. + [b]Note:[/b] When using indices, it is recommended to only use points, lines, or triangles. </description> </method> <method name="clear"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Input.xml b/doc/classes/Input.xml index a0d2d93a7d..70e629974d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Input.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Input.xml @@ -224,11 +224,18 @@ Returns [code]true[/code] if the system knows the specified device. This means that it sets all button and axis indices. Unknown joypads are not expected to match these constants, but you can still retrieve events from them. </description> </method> + <method name="is_key_label_pressed" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="keycode" type="int" enum="Key" /> + <description> + Returns [code]true[/code] if you are pressing the key with the [param keycode] printed on it. You can pass a [enum Key] constant or any Unicode character code. + </description> + </method> <method name="is_key_pressed" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="keycode" type="int" enum="Key" /> <description> - Returns [code]true[/code] if you are pressing the key in the current keyboard layout. You can pass a [enum Key] constant. + Returns [code]true[/code] if you are pressing the Latin key in the current keyboard layout. You can pass a [enum Key] constant. [method is_key_pressed] is only recommended over [method is_physical_key_pressed] in non-game applications. This ensures that shortcut keys behave as expected depending on the user's keyboard layout, as keyboard shortcuts are generally dependent on the keyboard layout in non-game applications. If in doubt, use [method is_physical_key_pressed]. [b]Note:[/b] Due to keyboard ghosting, [method is_key_pressed] may return [code]false[/code] even if one of the action's keys is pressed. See [url=$DOCS_URL/tutorials/inputs/input_examples.html#keyboard-events]Input examples[/url] in the documentation for more information. </description> @@ -297,6 +304,7 @@ [param hotspot] must be within [param image]'s size. [b]Note:[/b] [AnimatedTexture]s aren't supported as custom mouse cursors. If using an [AnimatedTexture], only the first frame will be displayed. [b]Note:[/b] Only images imported with the [b]Lossless[/b], [b]Lossy[/b] or [b]Uncompressed[/b] compression modes are supported. The [b]Video RAM[/b] compression mode can't be used for custom cursors. + [b]Note:[/b] On the web platform, the maximum allowed cursor image size is 128×128. Cursor images larger than 32×32 will also only be displayed if the mouse cursor image is entirely located within the page for [url=https://chromestatus.com/feature/5825971391299584]security reasons[/url]. </description> </method> <method name="set_default_cursor_shape"> @@ -367,6 +375,7 @@ <description> Sets the mouse position to the specified vector, provided in pixels and relative to an origin at the upper left corner of the currently focused Window Manager game window. Mouse position is clipped to the limits of the screen resolution, or to the limits of the game window if [enum MouseMode] is set to [constant MOUSE_MODE_CONFINED] or [constant MOUSE_MODE_CONFINED_HIDDEN]. + [b]Note:[/b] [method warp_mouse] is only supported on Windows, macOS and Linux. It has no effect on Android, iOS and Web. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/InputEventKey.xml b/doc/classes/InputEventKey.xml index c3d682de9e..4d10a183d4 100644 --- a/doc/classes/InputEventKey.xml +++ b/doc/classes/InputEventKey.xml @@ -5,15 +5,42 @@ </brief_description> <description> Stores key presses on the keyboard. Supports key presses, key releases and [member echo] events. + [b]Note:[/b] Events received from the keyboard usually have all properties set. Event mappings should have only one of the [member keycode], [member physical_keycode] or [member unicode] set. + When events are compared, properties are checked in the following priority - [member keycode], [member physical_keycode] and [member unicode], events with the first matching value will be considered equal. </description> <tutorials> <link title="InputEvent">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/inputs/inputevent.html</link> </tutorials> <methods> + <method name="as_text_key_label" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="String" /> + <description> + Returns a [String] representation of the event's [member key_label] and modifiers. + </description> + </method> + <method name="as_text_keycode" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="String" /> + <description> + Returns a [String] representation of the event's [member keycode] and modifiers. + </description> + </method> + <method name="as_text_physical_keycode" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="String" /> + <description> + Returns a [String] representation of the event's [member physical_keycode] and modifiers. + </description> + </method> + <method name="get_key_label_with_modifiers" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="int" enum="Key" /> + <description> + Returns the localized key label combined with modifier keys such as [kbd]Shift[/kbd] or [kbd]Alt[/kbd]. See also [InputEventWithModifiers]. + To get a human-readable representation of the [InputEventKey] with modifiers, use [code]OS.get_keycode_string(event.get_key_label_with_modifiers())[/code] where [code]event[/code] is the [InputEventKey]. + </description> + </method> <method name="get_keycode_with_modifiers" qualifiers="const"> <return type="int" enum="Key" /> <description> - Returns the keycode combined with modifier keys such as [kbd]Shift[/kbd] or [kbd]Alt[/kbd]. See also [InputEventWithModifiers]. + Returns the Latin keycode combined with modifier keys such as [kbd]Shift[/kbd] or [kbd]Alt[/kbd]. See also [InputEventWithModifiers]. To get a human-readable representation of the [InputEventKey] with modifiers, use [code]OS.get_keycode_string(event.get_keycode_with_modifiers())[/code] where [code]event[/code] is the [InputEventKey]. </description> </method> @@ -29,19 +56,36 @@ <member name="echo" type="bool" setter="set_echo" getter="is_echo" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], the key was already pressed before this event. It means the user is holding the key down. </member> + <member name="key_label" type="int" setter="set_key_label" getter="get_key_label" enum="Key" default="0"> + Represents the localized label printed on the key in the current keyboard layout, which corresponds to one of the [enum Key] constants or any valid Unicode character. + For keyboard layouts with a single label on the key, it is equivalent to [member keycode]. + To get a human-readable representation of the [InputEventKey], use [code]OS.get_keycode_string(event.key_label)[/code] where [code]event[/code] is the [InputEventKey]. + [codeblock] + +-----+ +-----+ + | Q | | Q | - "Q" - keycode + | Й | | ض | - "Й" and "ض" - key_label + +-----+ +-----+ + [/codeblock] + </member> <member name="keycode" type="int" setter="set_keycode" getter="get_keycode" enum="Key" default="0"> - The key keycode, which corresponds to one of the [enum Key] constants. Represent key in the current keyboard layout. + Latin label printed on the key in the current keyboard layout, which corresponds to one of the [enum Key] constants. To get a human-readable representation of the [InputEventKey], use [code]OS.get_keycode_string(event.keycode)[/code] where [code]event[/code] is the [InputEventKey]. + [codeblock] + +-----+ +-----+ + | Q | | Q | - "Q" - keycode + | Й | | ض | - "Й" and "ض" - key_label + +-----+ +-----+ + [/codeblock] </member> <member name="physical_keycode" type="int" setter="set_physical_keycode" getter="get_physical_keycode" enum="Key" default="0"> - Key physical keycode, which corresponds to one of the [enum Key] constants. Represent the physical location of a key on the 101/102-key US QWERTY keyboard. + Represents the physical location of a key on the 101/102-key US QWERTY keyboard, which corresponds to one of the [enum Key] constants. To get a human-readable representation of the [InputEventKey], use [code]OS.get_keycode_string(event.keycode)[/code] where [code]event[/code] is the [InputEventKey]. </member> <member name="pressed" type="bool" setter="set_pressed" getter="is_pressed" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], the key's state is pressed. If [code]false[/code], the key's state is released. </member> <member name="unicode" type="int" setter="set_unicode" getter="get_unicode" default="0"> - The key Unicode identifier (when relevant). Unicode identifiers for the composite characters and complex scripts may not be available unless IME input mode is active. See [method Window.set_ime_active] for more information. + The key Unicode character code (when relevant), shifted by modifier keys. Unicode character codes for composite characters and complex scripts may not be available unless IME input mode is active. See [method Window.set_ime_active] for more information. </member> </members> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/InputEventMIDI.xml b/doc/classes/InputEventMIDI.xml index 67e7ced2e8..e4ba380741 100644 --- a/doc/classes/InputEventMIDI.xml +++ b/doc/classes/InputEventMIDI.xml @@ -35,9 +35,9 @@ GD.Print(OS.GetConnectedMidiInputs()); } - public override void _Input(InputEvent inputEvent) + public override void _Input(InputEvent @event) { - if (inputEvent is InputEventMIDI midiEvent) + if (@event is InputEventMIDI midiEvent) { PrintMIDIInfo(midiEvent); } @@ -46,14 +46,14 @@ private void PrintMIDIInfo(InputEventMIDI midiEvent) { GD.Print(midiEvent); - GD.Print("Channel " + midiEvent.Channel); - GD.Print("Message " + midiEvent.Message); - GD.Print("Pitch " + midiEvent.Pitch); - GD.Print("Velocity " + midiEvent.Velocity); - GD.Print("Instrument " + midiEvent.Instrument); - GD.Print("Pressure " + midiEvent.Pressure); - GD.Print("Controller number: " + midiEvent.ControllerNumber); - GD.Print("Controller value: " + midiEvent.ControllerValue); + GD.Print($"Channel {midiEvent.Channel}"); + GD.Print($"Message {midiEvent.Message}"); + GD.Print($"Pitch {midiEvent.Pitch}"); + GD.Print($"Velocity {midiEvent.Velocity}"); + GD.Print($"Instrument {midiEvent.Instrument}"); + GD.Print($"Pressure {midiEvent.Pressure}"); + GD.Print($"Controller number: {midiEvent.ControllerNumber}"); + GD.Print($"Controller value: {midiEvent.ControllerValue}"); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/InputEventWithModifiers.xml b/doc/classes/InputEventWithModifiers.xml index c6311d780c..26b88e6ff2 100644 --- a/doc/classes/InputEventWithModifiers.xml +++ b/doc/classes/InputEventWithModifiers.xml @@ -10,6 +10,12 @@ <link title="InputEvent">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/inputs/inputevent.html</link> </tutorials> <methods> + <method name="get_modifiers_mask" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="int" enum="KeyModifierMask" /> + <description> + Returns the keycode combination of modifier keys. + </description> + </method> <method name="is_command_or_control_pressed" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <description> diff --git a/doc/classes/JSON.xml b/doc/classes/JSON.xml index 93731cf553..6fe53dfaac 100644 --- a/doc/classes/JSON.xml +++ b/doc/classes/JSON.xml @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="JSON" inherits="RefCounted" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> +<class name="JSON" inherits="Resource" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> Helper class for creating and parsing JSON data. </brief_description> @@ -49,13 +49,21 @@ Returns an empty string if the last call to [method parse] was successful, or the error message if it failed. </description> </method> + <method name="get_parsed_text" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="String" /> + <description> + Return the text parsed by [method parse] as long as the function is instructed to keep it. + </description> + </method> <method name="parse"> <return type="int" enum="Error" /> - <param index="0" name="json_string" type="String" /> + <param index="0" name="json_text" type="String" /> + <param index="1" name="keep_text" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Attempts to parse the [param json_string] provided. + Attempts to parse the [param json_text] provided. Returns an [enum Error]. If the parse was successful, it returns [constant OK] and the result can be retrieved using [member data]. If unsuccessful, use [method get_error_line] and [method get_error_message] for identifying the source of the failure. Non-static variant of [method parse_string], if you want custom error handling. + The optional [param keep_text] argument instructs the parser to keep a copy of the original text. This text can be obtained later by using the [method get_parsed_text] function and is used when saving the resource (instead of generating new text from [member data]). </description> </method> <method name="parse_string" qualifiers="static"> diff --git a/doc/classes/JavaScriptBridge.xml b/doc/classes/JavaScriptBridge.xml index 340c296eef..f79c11b334 100644 --- a/doc/classes/JavaScriptBridge.xml +++ b/doc/classes/JavaScriptBridge.xml @@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ </brief_description> <description> The JavaScriptBridge singleton is implemented only in the Web export. It's used to access the browser's JavaScript context. This allows interaction with embedding pages or calling third-party JavaScript APIs. - [b]Note:[/b] This singleton can be disabled at build-time to improve security. By default, the JavaScriptBridge singleton is enabled. Official export templates also have the JavaScriptBridge singleton enabled. See [url=$DOCS_URL/development/compiling/compiling_for_web.html]Compiling for the Web[/url] in the documentation for more information. + [b]Note:[/b] This singleton can be disabled at build-time to improve security. By default, the JavaScriptBridge singleton is enabled. Official export templates also have the JavaScriptBridge singleton enabled. See [url=$DOCS_URL/contributing/development/compiling/compiling_for_web.html]Compiling for the Web[/url] in the documentation for more information. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Exporting for the Web: Calling JavaScript from script">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/export/exporting_for_web.html#calling-javascript-from-script</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/Label3D.xml b/doc/classes/Label3D.xml index 0cbca2224e..cfb47ff4c3 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Label3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Label3D.xml @@ -32,9 +32,18 @@ </method> </methods> <members> + <member name="alpha_antialiasing_edge" type="float" setter="set_alpha_antialiasing_edge" getter="get_alpha_antialiasing_edge" default="0.0"> + Threshold at which antialiasing will be applied on the alpha channel. + </member> + <member name="alpha_antialiasing_mode" type="int" setter="set_alpha_antialiasing" getter="get_alpha_antialiasing" enum="BaseMaterial3D.AlphaAntiAliasing" default="0"> + The type of alpha antialiasing to apply. See [enum BaseMaterial3D.AlphaAntiAliasing]. + </member> <member name="alpha_cut" type="int" setter="set_alpha_cut_mode" getter="get_alpha_cut_mode" enum="Label3D.AlphaCutMode" default="0"> The alpha cutting mode to use for the sprite. See [enum AlphaCutMode] for possible values. </member> + <member name="alpha_hash_scale" type="float" setter="set_alpha_hash_scale" getter="get_alpha_hash_scale" default="1.0"> + The hashing scale for Alpha Hash. Recommended values between [code]0[/code] and [code]2[/code]. + </member> <member name="alpha_scissor_threshold" type="float" setter="set_alpha_scissor_threshold" getter="get_alpha_scissor_threshold" default="0.5"> Threshold at which the alpha scissor will discard values. </member> @@ -152,5 +161,8 @@ This mode draws fully opaque pixels in the depth prepass. This is slower than [constant ALPHA_CUT_DISABLED] or [constant ALPHA_CUT_DISCARD], but it allows displaying translucent areas and smooth edges while using proper sorting. [b]Note:[/b] When using text with overlapping glyphs (e.g., cursive scripts), this mode might have transparency sorting issues between the main text and the outline. </constant> + <constant name="ALPHA_CUT_HASH" value="3" enum="AlphaCutMode"> + This mode draws cuts off all values below a spatially-deterministic threshold, the rest will remain opaque. + </constant> </constants> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Light3D.xml b/doc/classes/Light3D.xml index fe7756faaf..95c39d535e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Light3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Light3D.xml @@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ A typical household lightbulb can range from around 600 lumens to 1,200 lumens, a candle is about 13 lumens, while a streetlight can be approximately 60,000 lumens. </member> <member name="light_intensity_lux" type="float" setter="set_param" getter="get_param"> - Used by [DirectionalLight3D]s when [member ProjectSettings.rendering/lights_and_shadows/use_physical_light_units] is [code]true[/code]. Sets the intensity of the light source measured in Lux. Lux is a measure pf luminous flux per unit area, it is equal to one lumen per square metre. Lux is the measure of how much light hits a surface at a given time. + Used by [DirectionalLight3D]s when [member ProjectSettings.rendering/lights_and_shadows/use_physical_light_units] is [code]true[/code]. Sets the intensity of the light source measured in Lux. Lux is a measure of luminous flux per unit area, it is equal to one lumen per square meter. Lux is the measure of how much light hits a surface at a given time. On a clear sunny day a surface in direct sunlight may be approximately 100,000 lux, a typical room in a home may be approximately 50 lux, while the moonlit ground may be approximately 0.1 lux. </member> <member name="light_negative" type="bool" setter="set_negative" getter="is_negative" default="false"> diff --git a/doc/classes/LightmapGI.xml b/doc/classes/LightmapGI.xml index 53dae1a8e6..723e6bbf21 100644 --- a/doc/classes/LightmapGI.xml +++ b/doc/classes/LightmapGI.xml @@ -93,22 +93,28 @@ <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_OK" value="0" enum="BakeError"> Lightmap baking was successful. </constant> - <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_LIGHTMAPPER" value="1" enum="BakeError"> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_SCENE_ROOT" value="1" enum="BakeError"> + Lightmap baking failed because the root node for the edited scene could not be accessed. + </constant> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_FOREIGN_DATA" value="2" enum="BakeError"> + Lightmap baking failed as the lightmap data resource is embedded in a foreign resource. + </constant> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_LIGHTMAPPER" value="3" enum="BakeError"> Lightmap baking failed as there is no lightmapper available in this Godot build. </constant> - <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_SAVE_PATH" value="2" enum="BakeError"> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_SAVE_PATH" value="4" enum="BakeError"> Lightmap baking failed as the [LightmapGIData] save path isn't configured in the resource. </constant> - <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_MESHES" value="3" enum="BakeError"> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_NO_MESHES" value="5" enum="BakeError"> Lightmap baking failed as there are no meshes whose [member GeometryInstance3D.gi_mode] is [constant GeometryInstance3D.GI_MODE_STATIC] and with valid UV2 mapping in the current scene. You may need to select 3D scenes in the Import dock and change their global illumination mode accordingly. </constant> - <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_MESHES_INVALID" value="4" enum="BakeError"> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_MESHES_INVALID" value="6" enum="BakeError"> Lightmap baking failed as the lightmapper failed to analyze some of the meshes marked as static for baking. </constant> - <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_CANT_CREATE_IMAGE" value="5" enum="BakeError"> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_CANT_CREATE_IMAGE" value="7" enum="BakeError"> Lightmap baking failed as the resulting image couldn't be saved or imported by Godot after it was saved. </constant> - <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_USER_ABORTED" value="6" enum="BakeError"> + <constant name="BAKE_ERROR_USER_ABORTED" value="8" enum="BakeError"> The user aborted the lightmap baking operation (typically by clicking the [b]Cancel[/b] button in the progress dialog). </constant> <constant name="ENVIRONMENT_MODE_DISABLED" value="0" enum="EnvironmentMode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/LineEdit.xml b/doc/classes/LineEdit.xml index b8383aaed9..8ed8622030 100644 --- a/doc/classes/LineEdit.xml +++ b/doc/classes/LineEdit.xml @@ -61,6 +61,45 @@ <return type="PopupMenu" /> <description> Returns the [PopupMenu] of this [LineEdit]. By default, this menu is displayed when right-clicking on the [LineEdit]. + You can add custom menu items or remove standard ones. Make sure your IDs don't conflict with the standard ones (see [enum MenuItems]). For example: + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + func _ready(): + var menu = get_menu() + # Remove all items after "Redo". + menu.item_count = menu.get_item_index(MENU_REDO) + 1 + # Add custom items. + menu.add_separator() + menu.add_item("Insert Date", MENU_MAX + 1) + # Connect callback. + menu.id_pressed.connect(_on_item_pressed) + + func _on_item_pressed(id): + if id == MENU_MAX + 1: + insert_text_at_caret(Time.get_date_string_from_system()) + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + public override void _Ready() + { + var menu = GetMenu(); + // Remove all items after "Redo". + menu.ItemCount = menu.GetItemIndex(LineEdit.MenuItems.Redo) + 1; + // Add custom items. + menu.AddSeparator(); + menu.AddItem("Insert Date", LineEdit.MenuItems.Max + 1); + // Add event handler. + menu.IdPressed += OnItemPressed; + } + + public void OnItemPressed(int id) + { + if (id == LineEdit.MenuItems.Max + 1) + { + InsertTextAtCaret(Time.GetDateStringFromSystem()); + } + } + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] [b]Warning:[/b] This is a required internal node, removing and freeing it may cause a crash. If you wish to hide it or any of its children, use their [member Window.visible] property. </description> </method> @@ -296,70 +335,76 @@ <constant name="MENU_REDO" value="6" enum="MenuItems"> Reverse the last undo action. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_INHERITED" value="7" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_SUBMENU_TEXT_DIR" value="7" enum="MenuItems"> + ID of "Text Writing Direction" submenu. + </constant> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_INHERITED" value="8" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to inherited. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_AUTO" value="8" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_AUTO" value="9" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to automatic. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_LTR" value="9" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_LTR" value="10" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to left-to-right. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_RTL" value="10" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_RTL" value="11" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to right-to-left. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DISPLAY_UCC" value="11" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DISPLAY_UCC" value="12" enum="MenuItems"> Toggles control character display. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRM" value="12" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_SUBMENU_INSERT_UCC" value="13" enum="MenuItems"> + ID of "Insert Control Character" submenu. + </constant> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRM" value="14" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts left-to-right mark (LRM) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLM" value="13" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLM" value="15" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts right-to-left mark (RLM) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRE" value="14" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRE" value="16" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of left-to-right embedding (LRE) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLE" value="15" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLE" value="17" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of right-to-left embedding (RLE) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRO" value="16" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRO" value="18" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of left-to-right override (LRO) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLO" value="17" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLO" value="19" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of right-to-left override (RLO) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDF" value="18" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDF" value="20" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts pop direction formatting (PDF) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ALM" value="19" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ALM" value="21" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts Arabic letter mark (ALM) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRI" value="20" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRI" value="22" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts left-to-right isolate (LRI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLI" value="21" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLI" value="23" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts right-to-left isolate (RLI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_FSI" value="22" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_FSI" value="24" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts first strong isolate (FSI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDI" value="23" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDI" value="25" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts pop direction isolate (PDI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWJ" value="24" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWJ" value="26" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts zero width joiner (ZWJ) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWNJ" value="25" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWNJ" value="27" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts zero width non-joiner (ZWNJ) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_WJ" value="26" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_WJ" value="28" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts word joiner (WJ) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_SHY" value="27" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_SHY" value="29" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts soft hyphen (SHY) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_MAX" value="28" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_MAX" value="30" enum="MenuItems"> Represents the size of the [enum MenuItems] enum. </constant> <constant name="KEYBOARD_TYPE_DEFAULT" value="0" enum="VirtualKeyboardType"> diff --git a/doc/classes/MainLoop.xml b/doc/classes/MainLoop.xml index 674adb1772..260efb0eab 100644 --- a/doc/classes/MainLoop.xml +++ b/doc/classes/MainLoop.xml @@ -29,29 +29,28 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] using Godot; - using System; - public class CustomMainLoop : MainLoop + public partial class CustomMainLoop : MainLoop { - public float TimeElapsed = 0; + private double _timeElapsed = 0; public override void _Initialize() { GD.Print("Initialized:"); - GD.Print($" Starting Time: {TimeElapsed}"); + GD.Print($" Starting Time: {_timeElapsed}"); } - public override bool _Process(float delta) + public override bool _Process(double delta) { - TimeElapsed += delta; + _timeElapsed += delta; // Return true to end the main loop. - return Input.GetMouseButtonMask() != 0 || Input.IsKeyPressed((int)KeyList.Escape); + return Input.GetMouseButtonMask() != 0 || Input.IsKeyPressed(Key.Escape); } private void _Finalize() { GD.Print("Finalized:"); - GD.Print($" End Time: {TimeElapsed}"); + GD.Print($" End Time: {_timeElapsed}"); } } [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/Marshalls.xml b/doc/classes/Marshalls.xml index 102e4b75ed..1eeb0be7ce 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Marshalls.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Marshalls.xml @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="Marshalls" inherits="Object" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> - Data transformation (marshalling) and encoding helpers. + Data transformation (marshaling) and encoding helpers. </brief_description> <description> Provides data transformation and encoding utility functions. diff --git a/doc/classes/Material.xml b/doc/classes/Material.xml index c5d567c1fe..bdd5cee797 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Material.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Material.xml @@ -31,6 +31,12 @@ <description> </description> </method> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderMaterial]). + </description> + </method> <method name="inspect_native_shader_code"> <return type="void" /> <description> diff --git a/doc/classes/Mesh.xml b/doc/classes/Mesh.xml index 94e80ffb2b..ece3199aab 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Mesh.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Mesh.xml @@ -114,6 +114,12 @@ [b]Note:[/b] This method typically returns the vertices in reverse order (e.g. clockwise to counterclockwise). </description> </method> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderMesh]). + </description> + </method> <method name="create_trimesh_shape" qualifiers="const"> <return type="ConcavePolygonShape3D" /> <description> @@ -227,10 +233,10 @@ Contains custom color channel 3. [PackedByteArray] if [code](format >> [constant ARRAY_FORMAT_CUSTOM3_SHIFT]) & [constant ARRAY_FORMAT_CUSTOM_MASK])[/code] is [constant ARRAY_CUSTOM_RGBA8_UNORM], [constant ARRAY_CUSTOM_RGBA8_UNORM], [constant ARRAY_CUSTOM_RG_HALF] or [constant ARRAY_CUSTOM_RGBA_HALF]. [PackedFloat32Array] otherwise. </constant> <constant name="ARRAY_BONES" value="10" enum="ArrayType"> - [PackedFloat32Array] or [PackedInt32Array] of bone indices. Each element is a group of 4 numbers. + [PackedFloat32Array] or [PackedInt32Array] of bone indices. Contains either 4 or 8 numbers per vertex depending on the presence of the [constant ARRAY_FLAG_USE_8_BONE_WEIGHTS] flag. </constant> <constant name="ARRAY_WEIGHTS" value="11" enum="ArrayType"> - [PackedFloat32Array] of bone weights. Each element in groups of 4 floats. + [PackedFloat32Array] or [PackedFloat64Array] of bone weights in the range [code]0.0[/code] to [code]1.0[/code] (inclusive). Contains either 4 or 8 numbers per vertex depending on the presence of the [constant ARRAY_FLAG_USE_8_BONE_WEIGHTS] flag. </constant> <constant name="ARRAY_INDEX" value="12" enum="ArrayType"> [PackedInt32Array] of integers used as indices referencing vertices, colors, normals, tangents, and textures. All of those arrays must have the same number of elements as the vertex array. No index can be beyond the vertex array size. When this index array is present, it puts the function into "index mode," where the index selects the *i*'th vertex, normal, tangent, color, UV, etc. This means if you want to have different normals or colors along an edge, you have to duplicate the vertices. @@ -341,6 +347,9 @@ <constant name="ARRAY_FLAG_USE_8_BONE_WEIGHTS" value="134217728" enum="ArrayFormat" is_bitfield="true"> Flag used to mark that the mesh contains up to 8 bone influences per vertex. This flag indicates that [constant ARRAY_BONES] and [constant ARRAY_WEIGHTS] elements will have double length. </constant> + <constant name="ARRAY_FLAG_USES_EMPTY_VERTEX_ARRAY" value="268435456" enum="ArrayFormat" is_bitfield="true"> + Flag used to mark that the mesh intentionally contains no vertex array. + </constant> <constant name="BLEND_SHAPE_MODE_NORMALIZED" value="0" enum="BlendShapeMode"> Blend shapes are normalized. </constant> diff --git a/doc/classes/MultiplayerAPI.xml b/doc/classes/MultiplayerAPI.xml index 3ce6ce41b4..020ce4f468 100644 --- a/doc/classes/MultiplayerAPI.xml +++ b/doc/classes/MultiplayerAPI.xml @@ -138,10 +138,10 @@ Used with [method Node.rpc_config] to disable a method or property for all RPC calls, making it unavailable. Default for all methods. </constant> <constant name="RPC_MODE_ANY_PEER" value="1" enum="RPCMode"> - Used with [method Node.rpc_config] to set a method to be callable remotely by any peer. Analogous to the [code]@rpc(any)[/code] annotation. Calls are accepted from all remote peers, no matter if they are node's authority or not. + Used with [method Node.rpc_config] to set a method to be callable remotely by any peer. Analogous to the [code]@rpc("any")[/code] annotation. Calls are accepted from all remote peers, no matter if they are node's authority or not. </constant> <constant name="RPC_MODE_AUTHORITY" value="2" enum="RPCMode"> - Used with [method Node.rpc_config] to set a method to be callable remotely only by the current multiplayer authority (which is the server by default). Analogous to the [code]@rpc(authority)[/code] annotation. See [method Node.set_multiplayer_authority]. + Used with [method Node.rpc_config] to set a method to be callable remotely only by the current multiplayer authority (which is the server by default). Analogous to the [code]@rpc("authority")[/code] annotation. See [method Node.set_multiplayer_authority]. </constant> </constants> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Mutex.xml b/doc/classes/Mutex.xml index 74f29bdc48..78694ce813 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Mutex.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Mutex.xml @@ -18,9 +18,9 @@ </description> </method> <method name="try_lock"> - <return type="int" enum="Error" /> + <return type="bool" /> <description> - Tries locking this [Mutex], but does not block. Returns [constant OK] on success, [constant ERR_BUSY] otherwise. + Tries locking this [Mutex], but does not block. Returns [code]true[/code] on success, [code]false[/code] otherwise. [b]Note:[/b] This function returns [constant OK] if the thread already has ownership of the mutex. </description> </method> diff --git a/doc/classes/NavigationAgent2D.xml b/doc/classes/NavigationAgent2D.xml index b561748b30..92fd8bcc6a 100644 --- a/doc/classes/NavigationAgent2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/NavigationAgent2D.xml @@ -4,8 +4,8 @@ 2D Agent used in navigation for collision avoidance. </brief_description> <description> - 2D Agent that is used in navigation to reach a location while avoiding static and dynamic obstacles. The dynamic obstacles are avoided using RVO collision avoidance. The agent needs navigation data to work correctly. [NavigationAgent2D] is physics safe. - [b]Note:[/b] After setting [member target_location] it is required to use the [method get_next_location] function once every physics frame to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. The returned vector position from this function should be used as the next movement position for the agent's parent Node. + 2D Agent that is used in navigation to reach a position while avoiding static and dynamic obstacles. The dynamic obstacles are avoided using RVO collision avoidance. The agent needs navigation data to work correctly. [NavigationAgent2D] is physics safe. + [b]Note:[/b] After setting [member target_position] it is required to use the [method get_next_path_position] function once every physics frame to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. The returned vector position from this function should be used as the next movement position for the agent's parent Node. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Using NavigationAgents">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/navigation/navigation_using_navigationagents.html</link> @@ -14,13 +14,13 @@ <method name="distance_to_target" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <description> - Returns the distance to the target location, using the agent's global position. The user must set [member target_location] in order for this to be accurate. + Returns the distance to the target position, using the agent's global position. The user must set [member target_position] in order for this to be accurate. </description> </method> <method name="get_current_navigation_path" qualifiers="const"> <return type="PackedVector2Array" /> <description> - Returns this agent's current path from start to finish in global coordinates. The path only updates when the target location is changed or the agent requires a repath. The path array is not intended to be used in direct path movement as the agent has its own internal path logic that would get corrupted by changing the path array manually. Use the intended [method get_next_location] once every physics frame to receive the next path point for the agents movement as this function also updates the internal path logic. + Returns this agent's current path from start to finish in global coordinates. The path only updates when the target position is changed or the agent requires a repath. The path array is not intended to be used in direct path movement as the agent has its own internal path logic that would get corrupted by changing the path array manually. Use the intended [method get_next_path_position] once every physics frame to receive the next path point for the agents movement as this function also updates the internal path logic. </description> </method> <method name="get_current_navigation_path_index" qualifiers="const"> @@ -35,10 +35,10 @@ Returns the path query result for the path the agent is currently following. </description> </method> - <method name="get_final_location"> + <method name="get_final_position"> <return type="Vector2" /> <description> - Returns the reachable final location in global coordinates. This can change if the navigation path is altered in any way. Because of this, it would be best to check this each frame. + Returns the reachable final position in global coordinates. This can change if the navigation path is altered in any way. Because of this, it would be best to check this each frame. </description> </method> <method name="get_navigation_layer_value" qualifiers="const"> @@ -54,10 +54,10 @@ Returns the [RID] of the navigation map for this NavigationAgent node. This function returns always the map set on the NavigationAgent node and not the map of the abstract agent on the NavigationServer. If the agent map is changed directly with the NavigationServer API the NavigationAgent node will not be aware of the map change. Use [method set_navigation_map] to change the navigation map for the NavigationAgent and also update the agent on the NavigationServer. </description> </method> - <method name="get_next_location"> + <method name="get_next_path_position"> <return type="Vector2" /> <description> - Returns the next location in global coordinates that can be moved to, making sure that there are no static objects in the way. If the agent does not have a navigation path, it will return the position of the agent's parent. The use of this function once every physics frame is required to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. + Returns the next position in global coordinates that can be moved to, making sure that there are no static objects in the way. If the agent does not have a navigation path, it will return the position of the agent's parent. The use of this function once every physics frame is required to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. </description> </method> <method name="get_rid" qualifiers="const"> @@ -69,19 +69,19 @@ <method name="is_navigation_finished"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns true if the navigation path's final location has been reached. + Returns true if the navigation path's final position has been reached. </description> </method> <method name="is_target_reachable"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns true if [member target_location] is reachable. + Returns true if [member target_position] is reachable. </description> </method> <method name="is_target_reached" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns true if [member target_location] is reached. It may not always be possible to reach the target location. It should always be possible to reach the final location though. See [method get_final_location]. + Returns true if [member target_position] is reached. It may not always be possible to reach the target position. It should always be possible to reach the final position though. See [method get_final_position]. </description> </method> <method name="set_navigation_layer_value"> @@ -111,6 +111,21 @@ <member name="avoidance_enabled" type="bool" setter="set_avoidance_enabled" getter="get_avoidance_enabled" default="false"> If [code]true[/code] the agent is registered for an RVO avoidance callback on the [NavigationServer2D]. When [method NavigationAgent2D.set_velocity] is used and the processing is completed a [code]safe_velocity[/code] Vector2 is received with a signal connection to [signal velocity_computed]. Avoidance processing with many registered agents has a significant performance cost and should only be enabled on agents that currently require it. </member> + <member name="debug_enabled" type="bool" setter="set_debug_enabled" getter="get_debug_enabled" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code] shows debug visuals for this agent. + </member> + <member name="debug_path_custom_color" type="Color" setter="set_debug_path_custom_color" getter="get_debug_path_custom_color" default="Color(1, 1, 1, 1)"> + If [member debug_use_custom] is [code]true[/code] uses this color for this agent instead of global color. + </member> + <member name="debug_path_custom_line_width" type="float" setter="set_debug_path_custom_line_width" getter="get_debug_path_custom_line_width" default="1.0"> + If [member debug_use_custom] is [code]true[/code] uses this line width for rendering paths for this agent instead of global line width. + </member> + <member name="debug_path_custom_point_size" type="float" setter="set_debug_path_custom_point_size" getter="get_debug_path_custom_point_size" default="4.0"> + If [member debug_use_custom] is [code]true[/code] uses this rasterized point size for rendering path points for this agent instead of global point size. + </member> + <member name="debug_use_custom" type="bool" setter="set_debug_use_custom" getter="get_debug_use_custom" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code] uses the defined [member debug_path_custom_color] for this agent instead of global color. + </member> <member name="max_neighbors" type="int" setter="set_max_neighbors" getter="get_max_neighbors" default="10"> The maximum number of neighbors for the agent to consider. </member> @@ -127,7 +142,7 @@ The distance threshold before a path point is considered to be reached. This will allow an agent to not have to hit a path point on the path exactly, but in the area. If this value is set to high the NavigationAgent will skip points on the path which can lead to leaving the navigation mesh. If this value is set to low the NavigationAgent will be stuck in a repath loop cause it will constantly overshoot or undershoot the distance to the next point on each physics frame update. </member> <member name="path_max_distance" type="float" setter="set_path_max_distance" getter="get_path_max_distance" default="100.0"> - The maximum distance the agent is allowed away from the ideal path to the final location. This can happen due to trying to avoid collisions. When the maximum distance is exceeded, it recalculates the ideal path. + The maximum distance the agent is allowed away from the ideal path to the final position. This can happen due to trying to avoid collisions. When the maximum distance is exceeded, it recalculates the ideal path. </member> <member name="path_metadata_flags" type="int" setter="set_path_metadata_flags" getter="get_path_metadata_flags" enum="NavigationPathQueryParameters2D.PathMetadataFlags" default="7"> Additional information to return with the navigation path. @@ -139,8 +154,8 @@ <member name="target_desired_distance" type="float" setter="set_target_desired_distance" getter="get_target_desired_distance" default="10.0"> The distance threshold before the final target point is considered to be reached. This will allow an agent to not have to hit the point of the final target exactly, but only the area. If this value is set to low the NavigationAgent will be stuck in a repath loop cause it will constantly overshoot or undershoot the distance to the final target point on each physics frame update. </member> - <member name="target_location" type="Vector2" setter="set_target_location" getter="get_target_location" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> - The user-defined target location. Setting this property will clear the current navigation path. + <member name="target_position" type="Vector2" setter="set_target_position" getter="get_target_position" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> + The user-defined target position. Setting this property will clear the current navigation path. </member> <member name="time_horizon" type="float" setter="set_time_horizon" getter="get_time_horizon" default="1.0"> The minimal amount of time for which this agent's velocities, that are computed with the collision avoidance algorithm, are safe with respect to other agents. The larger the number, the sooner the agent will respond to other agents, but less freedom in choosing its velocities. Must be positive. @@ -152,7 +167,7 @@ <description> Notifies when a navigation link has been reached. The details dictionary may contain the following keys depending on the value of [member path_metadata_flags]: - - [code]location[/code]: The start location of the link that was reached. + - [code]position[/code]: The start position of the link that was reached. - [code]type[/code]: Always [constant NavigationPathQueryResult2D.PATH_SEGMENT_TYPE_LINK]. - [code]rid[/code]: The [RID] of the link. - [code]owner[/code]: The object which manages the link (usually [NavigationLink2D]). @@ -160,7 +175,7 @@ </signal> <signal name="navigation_finished"> <description> - Notifies when the final location is reached. + Notifies when the final position is reached. </description> </signal> <signal name="path_changed"> @@ -170,7 +185,7 @@ </signal> <signal name="target_reached"> <description> - Notifies when the player-defined [member target_location] is reached. + Notifies when the player-defined [member target_position] is reached. </description> </signal> <signal name="velocity_computed"> @@ -184,7 +199,7 @@ <description> Notifies when a waypoint along the path has been reached. The details dictionary may contain the following keys depending on the value of [member path_metadata_flags]: - - [code]location[/code]: The location of the waypoint that was reached. + - [code]position[/code]: The position of the waypoint that was reached. - [code]type[/code]: The type of navigation primitive (region or link) that contains this waypoint. - [code]rid[/code]: The [RID] of the containing navigation primitive (region or link). - [code]owner[/code]: The object which manages the containing navigation primitive (region or link). diff --git a/doc/classes/NavigationAgent3D.xml b/doc/classes/NavigationAgent3D.xml index a1b007ee56..0ed11bc477 100644 --- a/doc/classes/NavigationAgent3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/NavigationAgent3D.xml @@ -4,8 +4,8 @@ 3D Agent used in navigation for collision avoidance. </brief_description> <description> - 3D Agent that is used in navigation to reach a location while avoiding static and dynamic obstacles. The dynamic obstacles are avoided using RVO collision avoidance. The agent needs navigation data to work correctly. [NavigationAgent3D] is physics safe. - [b]Note:[/b] After setting [member target_location] it is required to use the [method get_next_location] function once every physics frame to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. The returned vector position from this function should be used as the next movement position for the agent's parent Node. + 3D Agent that is used in navigation to reach a position while avoiding static and dynamic obstacles. The dynamic obstacles are avoided using RVO collision avoidance. The agent needs navigation data to work correctly. [NavigationAgent3D] is physics safe. + [b]Note:[/b] After setting [member target_position] it is required to use the [method get_next_path_position] function once every physics frame to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. The returned vector position from this function should be used as the next movement position for the agent's parent Node. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Using NavigationAgents">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/navigation/navigation_using_navigationagents.html</link> @@ -14,13 +14,13 @@ <method name="distance_to_target" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <description> - Returns the distance to the target location, using the agent's global position. The user must set [member target_location] in order for this to be accurate. + Returns the distance to the target position, using the agent's global position. The user must set [member target_position] in order for this to be accurate. </description> </method> <method name="get_current_navigation_path" qualifiers="const"> <return type="PackedVector3Array" /> <description> - Returns this agent's current path from start to finish in global coordinates. The path only updates when the target location is changed or the agent requires a repath. The path array is not intended to be used in direct path movement as the agent has its own internal path logic that would get corrupted by changing the path array manually. Use the intended [method get_next_location] once every physics frame to receive the next path point for the agents movement as this function also updates the internal path logic. + Returns this agent's current path from start to finish in global coordinates. The path only updates when the target position is changed or the agent requires a repath. The path array is not intended to be used in direct path movement as the agent has its own internal path logic that would get corrupted by changing the path array manually. Use the intended [method get_next_path_position] once every physics frame to receive the next path point for the agents movement as this function also updates the internal path logic. </description> </method> <method name="get_current_navigation_path_index" qualifiers="const"> @@ -35,10 +35,10 @@ Returns the path query result for the path the agent is currently following. </description> </method> - <method name="get_final_location"> + <method name="get_final_position"> <return type="Vector3" /> <description> - Returns the reachable final location in global coordinates. This can change if the navigation path is altered in any way. Because of this, it would be best to check this each frame. + Returns the reachable final position in global coordinates. This can change if the navigation path is altered in any way. Because of this, it would be best to check this each frame. </description> </method> <method name="get_navigation_layer_value" qualifiers="const"> @@ -54,10 +54,10 @@ Returns the [RID] of the navigation map for this NavigationAgent node. This function returns always the map set on the NavigationAgent node and not the map of the abstract agent on the NavigationServer. If the agent map is changed directly with the NavigationServer API the NavigationAgent node will not be aware of the map change. Use [method set_navigation_map] to change the navigation map for the NavigationAgent and also update the agent on the NavigationServer. </description> </method> - <method name="get_next_location"> + <method name="get_next_path_position"> <return type="Vector3" /> <description> - Returns the next location in global coordinates that can be moved to, making sure that there are no static objects in the way. If the agent does not have a navigation path, it will return the position of the agent's parent. The use of this function once every physics frame is required to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. + Returns the next position in global coordinates that can be moved to, making sure that there are no static objects in the way. If the agent does not have a navigation path, it will return the position of the agent's parent. The use of this function once every physics frame is required to update the internal path logic of the NavigationAgent. </description> </method> <method name="get_rid" qualifiers="const"> @@ -69,19 +69,19 @@ <method name="is_navigation_finished"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns true if the navigation path's final location has been reached. + Returns true if the navigation path's final position has been reached. </description> </method> <method name="is_target_reachable"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns true if [member target_location] is reachable. + Returns true if [member target_position] is reachable. </description> </method> <method name="is_target_reached" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <description> - Returns true if [member target_location] is reached. It may not always be possible to reach the target location. It should always be possible to reach the final location though. See [method get_final_location]. + Returns true if [member target_position] is reached. It may not always be possible to reach the target position. It should always be possible to reach the final position though. See [method get_final_position]. </description> </method> <method name="set_navigation_layer_value"> @@ -114,6 +114,18 @@ <member name="avoidance_enabled" type="bool" setter="set_avoidance_enabled" getter="get_avoidance_enabled" default="false"> If [code]true[/code] the agent is registered for an RVO avoidance callback on the [NavigationServer3D]. When [method NavigationAgent3D.set_velocity] is used and the processing is completed a [code]safe_velocity[/code] Vector3 is received with a signal connection to [signal velocity_computed]. Avoidance processing with many registered agents has a significant performance cost and should only be enabled on agents that currently require it. </member> + <member name="debug_enabled" type="bool" setter="set_debug_enabled" getter="get_debug_enabled" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code] shows debug visuals for this agent. + </member> + <member name="debug_path_custom_color" type="Color" setter="set_debug_path_custom_color" getter="get_debug_path_custom_color" default="Color(1, 1, 1, 1)"> + If [member debug_use_custom] is [code]true[/code] uses this color for this agent instead of global color. + </member> + <member name="debug_path_custom_point_size" type="float" setter="set_debug_path_custom_point_size" getter="get_debug_path_custom_point_size" default="4.0"> + If [member debug_use_custom] is [code]true[/code] uses this rasterized point size for rendering path points for this agent instead of global point size. + </member> + <member name="debug_use_custom" type="bool" setter="set_debug_use_custom" getter="get_debug_use_custom" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code] uses the defined [member debug_path_custom_color] for this agent instead of global color. + </member> <member name="ignore_y" type="bool" setter="set_ignore_y" getter="get_ignore_y" default="true"> Ignores collisions on the Y axis. Must be true to move on a horizontal plane. </member> @@ -133,7 +145,7 @@ The distance threshold before a path point is considered to be reached. This will allow an agent to not have to hit a path point on the path exactly, but in the area. If this value is set to high the NavigationAgent will skip points on the path which can lead to leaving the navigation mesh. If this value is set to low the NavigationAgent will be stuck in a repath loop cause it will constantly overshoot or undershoot the distance to the next point on each physics frame update. </member> <member name="path_max_distance" type="float" setter="set_path_max_distance" getter="get_path_max_distance" default="3.0"> - The maximum distance the agent is allowed away from the ideal path to the final location. This can happen due to trying to avoid collisions. When the maximum distance is exceeded, it recalculates the ideal path. + The maximum distance the agent is allowed away from the ideal path to the final position. This can happen due to trying to avoid collisions. When the maximum distance is exceeded, it recalculates the ideal path. </member> <member name="path_metadata_flags" type="int" setter="set_path_metadata_flags" getter="get_path_metadata_flags" enum="NavigationPathQueryParameters3D.PathMetadataFlags" default="7"> Additional information to return with the navigation path. @@ -145,8 +157,8 @@ <member name="target_desired_distance" type="float" setter="set_target_desired_distance" getter="get_target_desired_distance" default="1.0"> The distance threshold before the final target point is considered to be reached. This will allow an agent to not have to hit the point of the final target exactly, but only the area. If this value is set to low the NavigationAgent will be stuck in a repath loop cause it will constantly overshoot or undershoot the distance to the final target point on each physics frame update. </member> - <member name="target_location" type="Vector3" setter="set_target_location" getter="get_target_location" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> - The user-defined target location. Setting this property will clear the current navigation path. + <member name="target_position" type="Vector3" setter="set_target_position" getter="get_target_position" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> + The user-defined target position. Setting this property will clear the current navigation path. </member> <member name="time_horizon" type="float" setter="set_time_horizon" getter="get_time_horizon" default="5.0"> The minimal amount of time for which this agent's velocities, that are computed with the collision avoidance algorithm, are safe with respect to other agents. The larger the number, the sooner the agent will respond to other agents, but less freedom in choosing its velocities. Must be positive. @@ -158,7 +170,7 @@ <description> Notifies when a navigation link has been reached. The details dictionary may contain the following keys depending on the value of [member path_metadata_flags]: - - [code]location[/code]: The start location of the link that was reached. + - [code]position[/code]: The start position of the link that was reached. - [code]type[/code]: Always [constant NavigationPathQueryResult3D.PATH_SEGMENT_TYPE_LINK]. - [code]rid[/code]: The [RID] of the link. - [code]owner[/code]: The object which manages the link (usually [NavigationLink3D]). @@ -166,7 +178,7 @@ </signal> <signal name="navigation_finished"> <description> - Notifies when the final location is reached. + Notifies when the final position is reached. </description> </signal> <signal name="path_changed"> @@ -176,7 +188,7 @@ </signal> <signal name="target_reached"> <description> - Notifies when the player-defined [member target_location] is reached. + Notifies when the player-defined [member target_position] is reached. </description> </signal> <signal name="velocity_computed"> @@ -190,7 +202,7 @@ <description> Notifies when a waypoint along the path has been reached. The details dictionary may contain the following keys depending on the value of [member path_metadata_flags]: - - [code]location[/code]: The location of the waypoint that was reached. + - [code]position[/code]: The position of the waypoint that was reached. - [code]type[/code]: The type of navigation primitive (region or link) that contains this waypoint. - [code]rid[/code]: The [RID] of the containing navigation primitive (region or link). - [code]owner[/code]: The object which manages the containing navigation primitive (region or link). diff --git a/doc/classes/NavigationLink2D.xml b/doc/classes/NavigationLink2D.xml index 44d2110a7c..b3f4367675 100644 --- a/doc/classes/NavigationLink2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/NavigationLink2D.xml @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="NavigationLink2D" inherits="Node2D" is_experimental="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> - Creates a link between two locations that [NavigationServer2D] can route agents through. + Creates a link between two positions that [NavigationServer2D] can route agents through. </brief_description> <description> - Creates a link between two locations that [NavigationServer2D] can route agents through. Links can be used to express navigation methods that aren't just traveling along the surface of the navigation mesh, like zip-lines, teleporters, or jumping across gaps. + Creates a link between two positions that [NavigationServer2D] can route agents through. Links can be used to express navigation methods that aren't just traveling along the surface of the navigation mesh, like zip-lines, teleporters, or jumping across gaps. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Using NavigationLinks">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/navigation/navigation_using_navigationlinks.html</link> @@ -28,12 +28,12 @@ </methods> <members> <member name="bidirectional" type="bool" setter="set_bidirectional" getter="is_bidirectional" default="true"> - Whether this link can be traveled in both directions or only from [member start_location] to [member end_location]. + Whether this link can be traveled in both directions or only from [member start_position] to [member end_position]. </member> <member name="enabled" type="bool" setter="set_enabled" getter="is_enabled" default="true"> Whether this link is currently active. If [code]false[/code], [method NavigationServer2D.map_get_path] will ignore this link. </member> - <member name="end_location" type="Vector2" setter="set_end_location" getter="get_end_location" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> + <member name="end_position" type="Vector2" setter="set_end_position" getter="get_end_position" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> Ending position of the link. This position will search out the nearest polygon in the navigation mesh to attach to. The distance the link will search is controlled by [method NavigationServer2D.map_set_link_connection_radius]. @@ -44,7 +44,7 @@ <member name="navigation_layers" type="int" setter="set_navigation_layers" getter="get_navigation_layers" default="1"> A bitfield determining all navigation layers the link belongs to. These navigation layers will be checked when requesting a path with [method NavigationServer2D.map_get_path]. </member> - <member name="start_location" type="Vector2" setter="set_start_location" getter="get_start_location" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> + <member name="start_position" type="Vector2" setter="set_start_position" getter="get_start_position" default="Vector2(0, 0)"> Starting position of the link. This position will search out the nearest polygon in the navigation mesh to attach to. The distance the link will search is controlled by [method NavigationServer2D.map_set_link_connection_radius]. diff --git a/doc/classes/NavigationLink3D.xml b/doc/classes/NavigationLink3D.xml index 4aa5801afb..4dff226042 100644 --- a/doc/classes/NavigationLink3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/NavigationLink3D.xml @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="NavigationLink3D" inherits="Node3D" is_experimental="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> - Creates a link between two locations that [NavigationServer3D] can route agents through. + Creates a link between two positions that [NavigationServer3D] can route agents through. </brief_description> <description> - Creates a link between two locations that [NavigationServer3D] can route agents through. Links can be used to express navigation methods that aren't just traveling along the surface of the navigation mesh, like zip-lines, teleporters, or jumping across gaps. + Creates a link between two positions that [NavigationServer3D] can route agents through. Links can be used to express navigation methods that aren't just traveling along the surface of the navigation mesh, like zip-lines, teleporters, or jumping across gaps. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Using NavigationLinks">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/navigation/navigation_using_navigationlinks.html</link> @@ -28,12 +28,12 @@ </methods> <members> <member name="bidirectional" type="bool" setter="set_bidirectional" getter="is_bidirectional" default="true"> - Whether this link can be traveled in both directions or only from [member start_location] to [member end_location]. + Whether this link can be traveled in both directions or only from [member start_position] to [member end_position]. </member> <member name="enabled" type="bool" setter="set_enabled" getter="is_enabled" default="true"> Whether this link is currently active. If [code]false[/code], [method NavigationServer3D.map_get_path] will ignore this link. </member> - <member name="end_location" type="Vector3" setter="set_end_location" getter="get_end_location" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> + <member name="end_position" type="Vector3" setter="set_end_position" getter="get_end_position" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> Ending position of the link. This position will search out the nearest polygon in the navigation mesh to attach to. The distance the link will search is controlled by [method NavigationServer3D.map_set_link_connection_radius]. @@ -44,7 +44,7 @@ <member name="navigation_layers" type="int" setter="set_navigation_layers" getter="get_navigation_layers" default="1"> A bitfield determining all navigation layers the link belongs to. These navigation layers will be checked when requesting a path with [method NavigationServer3D.map_get_path]. </member> - <member name="start_location" type="Vector3" setter="set_start_location" getter="get_start_location" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> + <member name="start_position" type="Vector3" setter="set_start_position" getter="get_start_position" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> Starting position of the link. This position will search out the nearest polygon in the navigation mesh to attach to. The distance the link will search is controlled by [method NavigationServer3D.map_set_link_connection_radius]. diff --git a/doc/classes/NavigationServer2D.xml b/doc/classes/NavigationServer2D.xml index 1ba949b294..7270a19b4d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/NavigationServer2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/NavigationServer2D.xml @@ -41,12 +41,10 @@ <method name="agent_set_callback"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="agent" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="object_id" type="int" /> - <param index="2" name="method" type="StringName" /> - <param index="3" name="userdata" type="Variant" default="null" /> + <param index="1" name="callback" type="Callable" /> <description> - Sets the callback [param object_id] and [param method] that gets called after each avoidance processing step for the [param agent]. The calculated [code]safe_velocity[/code] will be dispatched with a signal to the object just before the physics calculations. - [b]Note:[/b] Created callbacks are always processed independently of the SceneTree state as long as the agent is on a navigation map and not freed. To disable the dispatch of a callback from an agent use [method agent_set_callback] again with a [code]0[/code] ObjectID as the [param object_id]. + Sets the callback that gets called after each avoidance processing step for the [param agent]. The calculated [code]safe_velocity[/code] will be passed as the first parameter just before the physics calculations. + [b]Note:[/b] Created callbacks are always processed independently of the SceneTree state as long as the agent is on a navigation map and not freed. To disable the dispatch of a callback from an agent use [method agent_set_callback] again with an empty [Callable]. </description> </method> <method name="agent_set_map"> @@ -137,14 +135,14 @@ <method name="link_create"> <return type="RID" /> <description> - Create a new link between two locations on a map. + Create a new link between two positions on a map. </description> </method> - <method name="link_get_end_location" qualifiers="const"> + <method name="link_get_end_position" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Vector2" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> <description> - Returns the ending location of this [code]link[/code]. + Returns the ending position of this [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_get_enter_cost" qualifiers="const"> @@ -175,11 +173,11 @@ Returns the [code]ObjectID[/code] of the object which manages this link. </description> </method> - <method name="link_get_start_location" qualifiers="const"> + <method name="link_get_start_position" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Vector2" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> <description> - Returns the starting location of this [code]link[/code]. + Returns the starting position of this [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_get_travel_cost" qualifiers="const"> @@ -204,12 +202,12 @@ Sets whether this [code]link[/code] can be travelled in both directions. </description> </method> - <method name="link_set_end_location"> + <method name="link_set_end_position"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="location" type="Vector2" /> + <param index="1" name="position" type="Vector2" /> <description> - Sets the exit location for the [code]link[/code]. + Sets the exit position for the [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_set_enter_cost"> @@ -244,12 +242,12 @@ Set the [code]ObjectID[/code] of the object which manages this link. </description> </method> - <method name="link_set_start_location"> + <method name="link_set_start_position"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="location" type="Vector2" /> + <param index="1" name="position" type="Vector2" /> <description> - Sets the entry location for this [code]link[/code]. + Sets the entry position for this [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_set_travel_cost"> @@ -530,5 +528,10 @@ Emitted when a navigation map is updated, when a region moves or is modified. </description> </signal> + <signal name="navigation_debug_changed"> + <description> + Emitted when navigation debug settings are changed. Only available in debug builds. + </description> + </signal> </signals> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/NavigationServer3D.xml b/doc/classes/NavigationServer3D.xml index e007c71342..340821d41e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/NavigationServer3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/NavigationServer3D.xml @@ -41,12 +41,10 @@ <method name="agent_set_callback"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="agent" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="object_id" type="int" /> - <param index="2" name="method" type="StringName" /> - <param index="3" name="userdata" type="Variant" default="null" /> + <param index="1" name="callback" type="Callable" /> <description> - Sets the callback [param object_id] and [param method] that gets called after each avoidance processing step for the [param agent]. The calculated [code]safe_velocity[/code] will be dispatched with a signal to the object just before the physics calculations. - [b]Note:[/b] Created callbacks are always processed independently of the SceneTree state as long as the agent is on a navigation map and not freed. To disable the dispatch of a callback from an agent use [method agent_set_callback] again with a [code]0[/code] ObjectID as the [param object_id]. + Sets the callback that gets called after each avoidance processing step for the [param agent]. The calculated [code]safe_velocity[/code] will be passed as the first parameter just before the physics calculations. + [b]Note:[/b] Created callbacks are always processed independently of the SceneTree state as long as the agent is on a navigation map and not freed. To disable the dispatch of a callback from an agent use [method agent_set_callback] again with an empty [Callable]. </description> </method> <method name="agent_set_map"> @@ -144,14 +142,14 @@ <method name="link_create"> <return type="RID" /> <description> - Create a new link between two locations on a map. + Create a new link between two positions on a map. </description> </method> - <method name="link_get_end_location" qualifiers="const"> + <method name="link_get_end_position" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Vector3" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> <description> - Returns the ending location of this [code]link[/code]. + Returns the ending position of this [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_get_enter_cost" qualifiers="const"> @@ -182,11 +180,11 @@ Returns the [code]ObjectID[/code] of the object which manages this link. </description> </method> - <method name="link_get_start_location" qualifiers="const"> + <method name="link_get_start_position" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Vector3" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> <description> - Returns the starting location of this [code]link[/code]. + Returns the starting position of this [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_get_travel_cost" qualifiers="const"> @@ -211,12 +209,12 @@ Sets whether this [code]link[/code] can be travelled in both directions. </description> </method> - <method name="link_set_end_location"> + <method name="link_set_end_position"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="location" type="Vector3" /> + <param index="1" name="position" type="Vector3" /> <description> - Sets the exit location for the [code]link[/code]. + Sets the exit position for the [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_set_enter_cost"> @@ -251,12 +249,12 @@ Set the [code]ObjectID[/code] of the object which manages this link. </description> </method> - <method name="link_set_start_location"> + <method name="link_set_start_position"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="link" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="location" type="Vector3" /> + <param index="1" name="position" type="Vector3" /> <description> - Sets the entry location for this [code]link[/code]. + Sets the entry position for this [code]link[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="link_set_travel_cost"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Node.xml b/doc/classes/Node.xml index 02fd6dae30..7c40c189c0 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Node.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Node.xml @@ -666,7 +666,7 @@ channel = 0, } [/codeblock] - See [enum MultiplayerAPI.RPCMode] and [enum MultiplayerPeer.TransferMode]. An alternative is annotating methods and properties with the corresponding annotation ([code]@rpc(any)[/code], [code]@rpc(authority)[/code]). By default, methods are not exposed to networking (and RPCs). + See [enum MultiplayerAPI.RPCMode] and [enum MultiplayerPeer.TransferMode]. An alternative is annotating methods and properties with the corresponding annotation ([code]@rpc("any")[/code], [code]@rpc("authority")[/code]). By default, methods are not exposed to networking (and RPCs). </description> </method> <method name="rpc_id" qualifiers="vararg"> @@ -909,6 +909,9 @@ <constant name="NOTIFICATION_ENABLED" value="29"> Notification received when the node is enabled again after being disabled. See [constant PROCESS_MODE_DISABLED]. </constant> + <constant name="NOTIFICATION_NODE_RECACHE_REQUESTED" value="30"> + Notification received when other nodes in the tree may have been removed/replaced and node pointers may require re-caching. + </constant> <constant name="NOTIFICATION_EDITOR_PRE_SAVE" value="9001"> Notification received right before the scene with the node is saved in the editor. This notification is only sent in the Godot editor and will not occur in exported projects. </constant> diff --git a/doc/classes/OS.xml b/doc/classes/OS.xml index 6dab7b4ebe..04895c28a8 100644 --- a/doc/classes/OS.xml +++ b/doc/classes/OS.xml @@ -498,7 +498,7 @@ <description> Returns [code]true[/code] if the Godot binary used to run the project is a [i]debug[/i] export template, or when running in the editor. Returns [code]false[/code] if the Godot binary used to run the project is a [i]release[/i] export template. - To check whether the Godot binary used to run the project is an export template (debug or release), use [code]OS.has_feature("standalone")[/code] instead. + To check whether the Godot binary used to run the project is an export template (debug or release), use [code]OS.has_feature("template")[/code] instead. </description> </method> <method name="is_keycode_unicode" qualifiers="const"> @@ -566,7 +566,7 @@ <method name="open_midi_inputs"> <return type="void" /> <description> - Initialises the singleton for the system MIDI driver. + Initializes the singleton for the system MIDI driver. [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on Linux, macOS and Windows. </description> </method> @@ -592,12 +592,12 @@ </description> </method> <method name="set_environment" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> + <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="variable" type="String" /> <param index="1" name="value" type="String" /> <description> Sets the value of the environment variable [param variable] to [param value]. The environment variable will be set for the Godot process and any process executed with [method execute] after running [method set_environment]. The environment variable will [i]not[/i] persist to processes run after the Godot process was terminated. - [b]Note:[/b] Double-check the casing of [param variable]. Environment variable names are case-sensitive on all platforms except Windows. + [b]Note:[/b] Environment variable names are case-sensitive on all platforms except Windows. The [param variable] name cannot be empty or include the [code]=[/code] character. On Windows, there is a 32767 characters limit for the combined length of [param variable], [param value], and the [code]=[/code] and null terminator characters that will be registered in the environment block. </description> </method> <method name="set_restart_on_exit"> @@ -637,6 +637,14 @@ [b]Note:[/b] This method is implemented on Android, iOS, Web, Linux, macOS and Windows. </description> </method> + <method name="unset_environment" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="variable" type="String" /> + <description> + Removes the environment [param variable] from the current environment, if it exists. The environment variable will be removed for the Godot process and any process executed with [method execute] after running [method unset_environment]. The removal of the environment variable will [i]not[/i] persist to processes run after the Godot process was terminated. + [b]Note:[/b] Environment variable names are case-sensitive on all platforms except Windows. The [param variable] name cannot be empty or include the [code]=[/code] character. + </description> + </method> </methods> <members> <member name="low_processor_usage_mode" type="bool" setter="set_low_processor_usage_mode" getter="is_in_low_processor_usage_mode" default="false"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Object.xml b/doc/classes/Object.xml index e015bec134..e30ff6be19 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Object.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Object.xml @@ -24,6 +24,7 @@ [b]Note:[/b] The [code]script[/code] is not exposed like most properties. To set or get an object's [Script] in code, use [method set_script] and [method get_script], respectively. </description> <tutorials> + <link title="Object class introduction">$DOCS_URL/contributing/development/core_and_modules/object_class.html</link> <link title="When and how to avoid using nodes for everything">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/best_practices/node_alternatives.html</link> <link title="Object notifications">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/best_practices/godot_notifications.html</link> </tutorials> @@ -109,7 +110,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] [Tool] - public class MyNode2D : Node2D + public partial class MyNode2D : Node2D { private bool _holdingHammer; @@ -304,7 +305,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] var node = new Node3D(); - node.Call("rotate", new Vector3(1f, 0f, 0f), 1.571f); + node.Call(Node3D.MethodName.Rotate, new Vector3(1f, 0f, 0f), 1.571f); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param method] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot methods. Prefer using the names exposed in the [code]MethodName[/code] class to avoid allocating a new [StringName] on each call. @@ -322,7 +323,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] var node = new Node3D(); - node.CallDeferred("rotate", new Vector3(1f, 0f, 0f), 1.571f); + node.CallDeferred(Node3D.MethodName.Rotate, new Vector3(1f, 0f, 0f), 1.571f); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param method] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot methods. Prefer using the names exposed in the [code]MethodName[/code] class to avoid allocating a new [StringName] on each call. @@ -341,7 +342,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] var node = new Node3D(); - node.Callv("rotate", new Godot.Collections.Array { new Vector3(1f, 0f, 0f), 1.571f }); + node.Callv(Node3D.MethodName.Rotate, new Godot.Collections.Array { new Vector3(1f, 0f, 0f), 1.571f }); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param method] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot methods. Prefer using the names exposed in the [code]MethodName[/code] class to avoid allocating a new [StringName] on each call @@ -393,8 +394,8 @@ // This assumes that a `Player` class exists, which defines a `Hit` signal. var player = new Player(); - // Signals as events (`player.Hit += OnPlayerHit;`) do not support argument binding. You have to use: - player.Hit.Connect(OnPlayerHit, new Godot.Collections.Array {"sword", 100 }); + // We can use lambdas when we need to bind additional parameters. + player.Hit += () => OnPlayerHit("sword", 100); } private void OnButtonDown() @@ -404,7 +405,7 @@ private void OnPlayerHit(string weaponType, int damage) { - GD.Print(String.Format("Hit with weapon {0} for {1} damage.", weaponType, damage)); + GD.Print($"Hit with weapon {weaponType} for {damage} damage."); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -430,16 +431,12 @@ public override void _Ready() { var button = new Button(); - // Option 1: Object.Connect() with an implicit Callable for the defined function. - button.Connect("button_down", OnButtonDown); - // Option 2: Object.connect() with a constructed Callable using a target object and method name. - button.Connect("button_down", new Callable(self, nameof(OnButtonDown))); - // Option 3: Signal.connect() with an implicit Callable for the defined function. - button.ButtonDown.Connect(OnButtonDown); - // Option 3b: In C#, we can use signals as events and connect with this more idiomatic syntax: + // Option 1: In C#, we can use signals as events and connect with this idiomatic syntax: button.ButtonDown += OnButtonDown; - // Option 4: Signal.connect() with a constructed Callable using a target object and method name. - button.ButtonDown.Connect(new Callable(self, nameof(OnButtonDown))); + // Option 2: GodotObject.Connect() with a constructed Callable from a method group. + button.Connect(Button.SignalName.ButtonDown, Callable.From(OnButtonDown)); + // Option 3: GodotObject.Connect() with a constructed Callable using a target object and method name. + button.Connect(Button.SignalName.ButtonDown, new Callable(this, MethodName.OnButtonDown)); } private void OnButtonDown() @@ -457,6 +454,7 @@ func _ready(): # This assumes that a `Player` class exists, which defines a `hit` signal. var player = Player.new() + # Using Callable.bind(). player.hit.connect(_on_player_hit.bind("sword", 100)) # Parameters added when emitting the signal are passed first. @@ -472,20 +470,19 @@ { // This assumes that a `Player` class exists, which defines a `Hit` signal. var player = new Player(); - // Option 1: Using Callable.Bind(). This way we can still use signals as events. - player.Hit += OnPlayerHit.Bind("sword", 100); - // Option 2: Using a `binds` Array in Signal.Connect(). - player.Hit.Connect(OnPlayerHit, new Godot.Collections.Array{ "sword", 100 }); + // Using lambda expressions that create a closure that captures the additional parameters. + // The lambda only receives the parameters defined by the signal's delegate. + player.Hit += (hitBy, level) => OnPlayerHit(hitBy, level, "sword", 100); // Parameters added when emitting the signal are passed first. - player.EmitSignal("hit", "Dark lord", 5); + player.EmitSignal(SignalName.Hit, "Dark lord", 5); } // We pass two arguments when emitting (`hit_by`, `level`), // and bind two more arguments when connecting (`weapon_type`, `damage`). private void OnPlayerHit(string hitBy, int level, string weaponType, int damage) { - GD.Print(String.Format("Hit by {0} (level {1}) with weapon {2} for {3} damage.", hitBy, level, weaponType, damage)); + GD.Print($"Hit by {hitBy} (level {level}) with weapon {weaponType} for {damage} damage."); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -511,8 +508,8 @@ emit_signal("game_over") [/gdscript] [csharp] - EmitSignal("Hit", "sword", 100); - EmitSignal("GameOver"); + EmitSignal(SignalName.Hit, "sword", 100); + EmitSignal(SignalName.GameOver); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param signal] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot signals. Prefer using the names exposed in the [code]SignalName[/code] class to avoid allocating a new [StringName] on each call. @@ -580,7 +577,7 @@ var b = node.GetIndexed("position:y"); // b is -10 [/csharp] [/codeblocks] - [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param property_path] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot properties. + [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param property_path] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot properties. Prefer using the names exposed in the [code]PropertyName[/code] class to avoid allocating a new [StringName] on each call. [b]Note:[/b] This method does not support actual paths to nodes in the [SceneTree], only sub-property paths. In the context of nodes, use [method Node.get_node_and_resource] instead. </description> </method> @@ -703,10 +700,10 @@ sprite2d.is_class("Node3D") # Returns false [/gdscript] [csharp] - var sprite2d = new Sprite2D(); - sprite2d.IsClass("Sprite2D"); // Returns true - sprite2d.IsClass("Node"); // Returns true - sprite2d.IsClass("Node3D"); // Returns false + var sprite2D = new Sprite2D(); + sprite2D.IsClass("Sprite2D"); // Returns true + sprite2D.IsClass("Node"); // Returns true + sprite2D.IsClass("Node3D"); // Returns false [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] This method ignores [code]class_name[/code] declarations in the object's script. @@ -750,10 +747,10 @@ player.SetScript(GD.Load("res://player.gd")); player.Notification(NotificationEnterTree); - // The call order is Object -> Node -> Node2D -> player.gd. + // The call order is GodotObject -> Node -> Node2D -> player.gd. - player.notification(NotificationEnterTree, true); - // The call order is player.gd -> Node2D -> Node -> Object. + player.Notification(NotificationEnterTree, true); + // The call order is player.gd -> Node2D -> Node -> GodotObject. [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> @@ -867,7 +864,7 @@ GD.Print(node.Position); // Prints (42, -10) [/csharp] [/codeblocks] - [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param property_path] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot properties. + [b]Note:[/b] In C#, [param property_path] must be in snake_case when referring to built-in Godot properties. Prefer using the names exposed in the [code]PropertyName[/code] class to avoid allocating a new [StringName] on each call. </description> </method> <method name="set_message_translation"> @@ -882,7 +879,7 @@ <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> <param index="1" name="value" type="Variant" /> <description> - Adds or changes the entry [param name] inside the object's metadata. The metadata [param value] can be any [Variant], although some types cannot be serialised correctly. + Adds or changes the entry [param name] inside the object's metadata. The metadata [param value] can be any [Variant], although some types cannot be serialized correctly. If [param value] is [code]null[/code], the entry is removed. This is the equivalent of using [method remove_meta]. See also [method has_meta] and [method get_meta]. [b]Note:[/b] Metadata that has a [param name] starting with an underscore ([code]_[/code]) is considered editor-only. Editor-only metadata is not displayed in the Inspector dock and should not be edited. </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/PacketPeerDTLS.xml b/doc/classes/PacketPeerDTLS.xml index db8403a56b..19c5d0e287 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PacketPeerDTLS.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PacketPeerDTLS.xml @@ -14,11 +14,10 @@ <method name="connect_to_peer"> <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="packet_peer" type="PacketPeerUDP" /> - <param index="1" name="validate_certs" type="bool" default="true" /> - <param index="2" name="for_hostname" type="String" default="""" /> - <param index="3" name="valid_certificate" type="X509Certificate" default="null" /> + <param index="1" name="hostname" type="String" /> + <param index="2" name="client_options" type="TLSOptions" default="null" /> <description> - Connects a [param packet_peer] beginning the DTLS handshake using the underlying [PacketPeerUDP] which must be connected (see [method PacketPeerUDP.connect_to_host]). If [param validate_certs] is [code]true[/code], [PacketPeerDTLS] will validate that the certificate presented by the remote peer and match it with the [param for_hostname] argument. You can specify a custom [X509Certificate] to use for validation via the [param valid_certificate] argument. + Connects a [param packet_peer] beginning the DTLS handshake using the underlying [PacketPeerUDP] which must be connected (see [method PacketPeerUDP.connect_to_host]). You can optionally specify the [param client_options] to be used while verifying the TLS connections. See [method TLSOptions.client] and [method TLSOptions.client_unsafe]. </description> </method> <method name="disconnect_from_peer"> diff --git a/doc/classes/ParticleProcessMaterial.xml b/doc/classes/ParticleProcessMaterial.xml index d4050e3bd1..d046d52ed1 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ParticleProcessMaterial.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ParticleProcessMaterial.xml @@ -123,7 +123,8 @@ </member> <member name="collision_mode" type="int" setter="set_collision_mode" getter="get_collision_mode" enum="ParticleProcessMaterial.CollisionMode" default="0"> The particles' collision mode. - [b]Note:[/b] Particles can only collide with [GPUParticlesCollision3D] nodes, not [PhysicsBody3D] nodes. To make particles collide with various objects, you can add [GPUParticlesCollision3D] nodes as children of [PhysicsBody3D] nodes. + [b]Note:[/b] 3D Particles can only collide with [GPUParticlesCollision3D] nodes, not [PhysicsBody3D] nodes. To make particles collide with various objects, you can add [GPUParticlesCollision3D] nodes as children of [PhysicsBody3D] nodes. + [b]Note:[/b] 2D Particles can only collide with [LightOccluder2D] nodes, not [PhysicsBody2D] nodes. </member> <member name="collision_use_scale" type="bool" setter="set_collision_use_scale" getter="is_collision_using_scale" default="false"> Should collision take scale into account. diff --git a/doc/classes/Performance.xml b/doc/classes/Performance.xml index 6b7daa534e..493af8aff2 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Performance.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Performance.xml @@ -45,7 +45,7 @@ [csharp] public override void _Ready() { - var monitorValue = new Callable(this, nameof(GetMonitorValue)); + var monitorValue = new Callable(this, MethodName.GetMonitorValue); // Adds monitor with name "MyName" to category "MyCategory". Performance.AddCustomMonitor("MyCategory/MyMonitor", monitorValue); diff --git a/doc/classes/PhysicalBone3D.xml b/doc/classes/PhysicalBone3D.xml index 0768df31cc..f38130fe0c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PhysicalBone3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PhysicalBone3D.xml @@ -3,6 +3,7 @@ <brief_description> </brief_description> <description> + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> diff --git a/doc/classes/PhysicsBody3D.xml b/doc/classes/PhysicsBody3D.xml index 2ef54683f2..3e100e3280 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PhysicsBody3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PhysicsBody3D.xml @@ -4,7 +4,8 @@ Base class for all objects affected by physics in 3D space. </brief_description> <description> - PhysicsBody3D is an abstract base class for implementing a physics body. All *Body types inherit from it. + PhysicsBody3D is an abstract base class for implementing a physics body. All *Body3D types inherit from it. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Physics introduction">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/physics/physics_introduction.html</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/PhysicsPointQueryParameters2D.xml b/doc/classes/PhysicsPointQueryParameters2D.xml index 76dc816dab..15102830f8 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PhysicsPointQueryParameters2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PhysicsPointQueryParameters2D.xml @@ -11,6 +11,7 @@ <members> <member name="canvas_instance_id" type="int" setter="set_canvas_instance_id" getter="get_canvas_instance_id" default="0"> If different from [code]0[/code], restricts the query to a specific canvas layer specified by its instance ID. See [method Object.get_instance_id]. + If [code]0[/code], restricts the query to the Viewport's default canvas layer. </member> <member name="collide_with_areas" type="bool" setter="set_collide_with_areas" getter="is_collide_with_areas_enabled" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], the query will take [Area2D]s into account. diff --git a/doc/classes/PhysicsServer2D.xml b/doc/classes/PhysicsServer2D.xml index f1316fa991..93e88347d4 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PhysicsServer2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PhysicsServer2D.xml @@ -984,25 +984,23 @@ <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_IS_POINT" value="3" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get whether the gravity vector of an area is a direction, or a center point. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_DISTANCE_SCALE" value="4" enum="AreaParameter"> - Constant to set/get the falloff factor for point gravity of an area. The greater this value is, the faster the strength of gravity decreases with the square of distance. + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_POINT_UNIT_DISTANCE" value="4" enum="AreaParameter"> + Constant to set/get the distance at which the gravity strength is equal to the gravity controlled by [constant AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY]. For example, on a planet 100 pixels in radius with a surface gravity of 4.0 px/s², set the gravity to 4.0 and the unit distance to 100.0. The gravity will have falloff according to the inverse square law, so in the example, at 200 pixels from the center the gravity will be 1.0 px/s² (twice the distance, 1/4th the gravity), at 50 pixels it will be 16.0 px/s² (half the distance, 4x the gravity), and so on. + The above is true only when the unit distance is a positive number. When the unit distance is set to 0.0, the gravity will be constant regardless of distance. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_POINT_ATTENUATION" value="5" enum="AreaParameter"> - This constant was used to set/get the falloff factor for point gravity. It has been superseded by [constant AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_DISTANCE_SCALE]. - </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="6" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="5" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get linear damping override mode in an area. See [enum AreaSpaceOverrideMode] for possible values. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP" value="7" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP" value="6" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the linear damping factor of an area. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="8" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="7" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get angular damping override mode in an area. See [enum AreaSpaceOverrideMode] for possible values. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP" value="9" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP" value="8" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the angular damping factor of an area. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_PRIORITY" value="10" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_PRIORITY" value="9" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the priority (order of processing) of an area. </constant> <constant name="AREA_SPACE_OVERRIDE_DISABLED" value="0" enum="AreaSpaceOverrideMode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3D.xml b/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3D.xml index e62bda0dd3..5b261d8414 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3D.xml @@ -1315,37 +1315,35 @@ <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_IS_POINT" value="3" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get whether the gravity vector of an area is a direction, or a center point. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_DISTANCE_SCALE" value="4" enum="AreaParameter"> - Constant to set/get the falloff factor for point gravity of an area. The greater this value is, the faster the strength of gravity decreases with the square of distance. + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_POINT_UNIT_DISTANCE" value="4" enum="AreaParameter"> + Constant to set/get the distance at which the gravity strength is equal to the gravity controlled by [constant AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY]. For example, on a planet 100 meters in radius with a surface gravity of 4.0 m/s², set the gravity to 4.0 and the unit distance to 100.0. The gravity will have falloff according to the inverse square law, so in the example, at 200 meters from the center the gravity will be 1.0 m/s² (twice the distance, 1/4th the gravity), at 50 meters it will be 16.0 m/s² (half the distance, 4x the gravity), and so on. + The above is true only when the unit distance is a positive number. When this is set to 0.0, the gravity will be constant regardless of distance. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_POINT_ATTENUATION" value="5" enum="AreaParameter"> - This constant was used to set/get the falloff factor for point gravity. It has been superseded by [constant AREA_PARAM_GRAVITY_DISTANCE_SCALE]. - </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="6" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="5" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get linear damping override mode in an area. See [enum AreaSpaceOverrideMode] for possible values. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP" value="7" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_LINEAR_DAMP" value="6" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the linear damping factor of an area. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="8" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP_OVERRIDE_MODE" value="7" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get angular damping override mode in an area. See [enum AreaSpaceOverrideMode] for possible values. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP" value="9" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_ANGULAR_DAMP" value="8" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the angular damping factor of an area. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_PRIORITY" value="10" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_PRIORITY" value="9" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the priority (order of processing) of an area. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_FORCE_MAGNITUDE" value="11" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_FORCE_MAGNITUDE" value="10" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the magnitude of area-specific wind force. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_SOURCE" value="12" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_SOURCE" value="11" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the 3D vector that specifies the origin from which an area-specific wind blows. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_DIRECTION" value="13" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_DIRECTION" value="12" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the 3D vector that specifies the direction in which an area-specific wind blows. </constant> - <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_ATTENUATION_FACTOR" value="14" enum="AreaParameter"> + <constant name="AREA_PARAM_WIND_ATTENUATION_FACTOR" value="13" enum="AreaParameter"> Constant to set/get the exponential rate at which wind force decreases with distance from its origin. </constant> <constant name="AREA_SPACE_OVERRIDE_DISABLED" value="0" enum="AreaSpaceOverrideMode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3DManager.xml b/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3DManager.xml index 3ec03fede4..4d789ceb3f 100644 --- a/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3DManager.xml +++ b/doc/classes/PhysicsServer3DManager.xml @@ -15,7 +15,7 @@ <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> <param index="1" name="create_callback" type="Callable" /> <description> - Register a [PhysicsServer3D] implementation by passing a [param name] and a [Callable] that returns a [PhysicsServer2D] object. + Register a [PhysicsServer3D] implementation by passing a [param name] and a [Callable] that returns a [PhysicsServer3D] object. </description> </method> <method name="set_default_server"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Plane.xml b/doc/classes/Plane.xml index fbe8afa8d1..aa09081e3e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Plane.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Plane.xml @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ <param index="0" name="normal" type="Vector3" /> <description> Creates a plane from the normal vector. The plane will intersect the origin. + The [param normal] of the plane must be a unit vector. </description> </constructor> <constructor name="Plane"> @@ -46,6 +47,7 @@ <param index="1" name="d" type="float" /> <description> Creates a plane from the normal vector and the plane's distance from the origin. + The [param normal] of the plane must be a unit vector. </description> </constructor> <constructor name="Plane"> @@ -54,6 +56,7 @@ <param index="1" name="point" type="Vector3" /> <description> Creates a plane from the normal vector and a point on the plane. + The [param normal] of the plane must be a unit vector. </description> </constructor> <constructor name="Plane"> @@ -67,12 +70,6 @@ </constructor> </constructors> <methods> - <method name="center" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector3" /> - <description> - Returns the center of the plane. - </description> - </method> <method name="distance_to" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <param index="0" name="point" type="Vector3" /> @@ -80,6 +77,12 @@ Returns the shortest distance from the plane to the position [param point]. If the point is above the plane, the distance will be positive. If below, the distance will be negative. </description> </method> + <method name="get_center" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Vector3" /> + <description> + Returns the center of the plane. + </description> + </method> <method name="has_point" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="point" type="Vector3" /> @@ -152,7 +155,7 @@ In the scalar equation of the plane [code]ax + by + cz = d[/code], this is [code]d[/code], while the [code](a, b, c)[/code] coordinates are represented by the [member normal] property. </member> <member name="normal" type="Vector3" setter="" getter="" default="Vector3(0, 0, 0)"> - The normal of the plane, which must be normalized. + The normal of the plane, which must be a unit vector. In the scalar equation of the plane [code]ax + by + cz = d[/code], this is the vector [code](a, b, c)[/code], where [code]d[/code] is the [member d] property. </member> <member name="x" type="float" setter="" getter="" default="0.0"> diff --git a/doc/classes/ProjectSettings.xml b/doc/classes/ProjectSettings.xml index cfcfca9880..e429759e93 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ProjectSettings.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ProjectSettings.xml @@ -84,6 +84,25 @@ GD.Print(ProjectSettings.GetSetting("application/config/custom_description", "No description specified.")); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] + [b]Note:[/b] This method doesn't take potential feature overrides into account automatically. Use [method get_setting_with_override] to handle seamlessly. + </description> + </method> + <method name="get_setting_with_override" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Variant" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> + <description> + Similar to [method get_setting], but applies feature tag overrides if any exists and is valid. + [b]Example:[/b] + If the following setting override exists "application/config/name.windows", and the following code is executed: + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + print(ProjectSettings.get_setting_with_override("application/config/name")) + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + GD.Print(ProjectSettings.GetSettingWithOverride("application/config/name")); + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] + Then the overridden setting will be returned instead if the project is running on the [i]Windows[/i] operating system. </description> </method> <method name="globalize_path" qualifiers="const"> @@ -365,6 +384,9 @@ <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/assert_always_true" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when an [code]assert[/code] call always evaluates to true. </member> + <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/confusable_identifier" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> + When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when an identifier contains characters that can be confused with something else, like when mixing different alphabets. + </member> <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/constant_used_as_function" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when a constant is used as a function. </member> @@ -386,8 +408,11 @@ <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/incompatible_ternary" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when a ternary operator may emit values with incompatible types. </member> - <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/int_assigned_to_enum" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> - When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when trying to assign an integer to a variable that expects an enum value. + <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/int_as_enum_without_cast" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> + When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when trying to use an integer as an enum without an explicit cast. + </member> + <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/int_as_enum_without_match" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> + When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when trying to use an integer as an enum when there is no matching enum member for that numeric value. </member> <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/integer_division" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when dividing an integer by another integer (the decimal part will be discarded). @@ -401,6 +426,9 @@ <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/redundant_await" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when a function that is not a coroutine is called with await. </member> + <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/renamed_in_godot_4_hint" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="1"> + When enabled, using a property, enum, or function that was renamed since Godot 3 will produce a hint if an error occurs. + </member> <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/return_value_discarded" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when calling a function without using its return value (by assigning it to a variable or using it as a function argument). Such return values are sometimes used to denote possible errors using the [enum Error] enum. </member> @@ -449,6 +477,9 @@ <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/unsafe_property_access" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when accessing a property whose presence is not guaranteed at compile-time in the class. </member> + <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/unsafe_void_return" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> + When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when returning a call from a [code]void[/code] function when such call cannot be guaranteed to be also [code]void[/code]. + </member> <member name="debug/gdscript/warnings/unused_local_constant" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> When set to [code]warn[/code] or [code]error[/code], produces a warning or an error respectively when a local constant is never used. </member> @@ -497,9 +528,21 @@ <member name="debug/shapes/collision/shape_color" type="Color" setter="" getter="" default="Color(0, 0.6, 0.7, 0.42)"> Color of the collision shapes, visible when "Visible Collision Shapes" is enabled in the Debug menu. </member> + <member name="debug/shapes/navigation/agent_path_color" type="Color" setter="" getter="" default="Color(1, 0, 0, 1)"> + Color to display enabled navigation agent paths when an agent has debug enabled. + </member> + <member name="debug/shapes/navigation/agent_path_point_size" type="float" setter="" getter="" default="4.0"> + Rasterized size (pixel) used to render navigation agent path points when an agent has debug enabled. + </member> <member name="debug/shapes/navigation/edge_connection_color" type="Color" setter="" getter="" default="Color(1, 0, 1, 1)"> Color to display edge connections between navigation regions, visible when "Visible Navigation" is enabled in the Debug menu. </member> + <member name="debug/shapes/navigation/enable_agent_paths" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="true"> + If enabled, displays navigation agent paths when an agent has debug enabled. + </member> + <member name="debug/shapes/navigation/enable_agent_paths_xray" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="true"> + If enabled, displays navigation agent paths through geometry when an agent has debug enabled. + </member> <member name="debug/shapes/navigation/enable_edge_connections" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="true"> If enabled, displays edge connections between navigation regions when "Visible Navigation" is enabled in the Debug menu. </member> @@ -596,8 +639,17 @@ Main window content is expanded to the full size of the window. Unlike a borderless window, the frame is left intact and can be used to resize the window, and the title bar is transparent, but has minimize/maximize/close buttons. [b]Note:[/b] This setting is implemented only on macOS. </member> - <member name="display/window/size/initial_screen" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="-2"> - Main window initial screen. + <member name="display/window/size/initial_position" type="Vector2i" setter="" getter="" default="Vector2i(0, 0)"> + Main window initial position (in virtual desktop coordinates), this settings is used only if [member display/window/size/initial_position_type] is set to "Absolute" ([code]0[/code]). + </member> + <member name="display/window/size/initial_position_type" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> + Main window initial position. + [code]0[/code] - "Absolute", [member display/window/size/initial_position] is used to set window position. + [code]1[/code] - "Primary Screen Center". + [code]2[/code] - "Other Screen Center", [member display/window/size/initial_screen] is used to set window position. + </member> + <member name="display/window/size/initial_screen" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> + Main window initial screen, this settings is used only if [member display/window/size/initial_position_type] is set to "Other Screen Center" ([code]2[/code]). </member> <member name="display/window/size/mode" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> Main window mode. See [enum DisplayServer.WindowMode] for possible values and how each mode behaves. @@ -631,7 +683,15 @@ <member name="display/window/vsync/vsync_mode" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> Sets the V-Sync mode for the main game window. See [enum DisplayServer.VSyncMode] for possible values and how they affect the behavior of your application. - Depending on the platform and used renderer, the engine will fall back to [code]Enabled[/code], if the desired mode is not supported. + Depending on the platform and used renderer, the engine will fall back to [code]Enabled[/code] if the desired mode is not supported. + [b]Note:[/b] This property is only read when the project starts. To change the V-Sync mode at runtime, call [method DisplayServer.window_set_vsync_mode] instead. + </member> + <member name="dotnet/project/assembly_name" type="String" setter="" getter="" default=""""> + Name of the .NET assembly. This name is used as the name of the [code].csproj[/code] and [code].sln[/code] files. By default, it's set to the name of the project ([member application/config/name]) allowing to change it in the future without affecting the .NET assembly. + </member> + <member name="dotnet/project/solution_directory" type="String" setter="" getter="" default=""""> + Directory that contains the [code].sln[/code] file. By default, the [code].sln[/code] files is in the root of the project directory, next to the [code]project.godot[/code] and [code].csproj[/code] files. + Changing this value allows setting up a multi-project scenario where there are multiple [code].csproj[/code]. Keep in mind that the Godot project is considered one of the C# projects in the workspace and it's root directory should contain the [code]project.godot[/code] and [code].csproj[/code] next to each other. </member> <member name="editor/movie_writer/disable_vsync" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], requests V-Sync to be disabled when writing a movie (similar to setting [member display/window/vsync/vsync_mode] to [b]Disabled[/b]). This can speed up video writing if the hardware is fast enough to render, encode and save the video at a framerate higher than the monitor's refresh rate. @@ -659,10 +719,16 @@ <member name="editor/movie_writer/speaker_mode" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> The speaker mode to use in the recorded audio when writing a movie. See [enum AudioServer.SpeakerMode] for possible values. </member> - <member name="editor/node_naming/name_casing" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> + <member name="editor/naming/default_signal_callback_name" type="String" setter="" getter="" default=""_on_{node_name}_{signal_name}""> + The format of the default signal callback name (in the Signal Connection Dialog). The following substitutions are available: [code]{NodeName}[/code], [code]{nodeName}[/code], [code]{node_name}[/code], [code]{SignalName}[/code], [code]{signalName}[/code], and [code]{signal_name}[/code]. + </member> + <member name="editor/naming/default_signal_callback_to_self_name" type="String" setter="" getter="" default=""_on_{signal_name}""> + The format of the default signal callback name when a signal connects to the same node that emits it (in the Signal Connection Dialog). The following substitutions are available: [code]{NodeName}[/code], [code]{nodeName}[/code], [code]{node_name}[/code], [code]{SignalName}[/code], [code]{signalName}[/code], and [code]{signal_name}[/code]. + </member> + <member name="editor/naming/node_name_casing" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> When creating node names automatically, set the type of casing in this project. This is mostly an editor setting. </member> - <member name="editor/node_naming/name_num_separator" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> + <member name="editor/naming/node_name_num_separator" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="0"> What to use to separate node name from number. This is mostly an editor setting. </member> <member name="editor/run/main_run_args" type="String" setter="" getter="" default=""""> @@ -741,6 +807,9 @@ <member name="gui/theme/lcd_subpixel_layout" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="1"> LCD subpixel layout used for font anti-aliasing. See [enum TextServer.FontLCDSubpixelLayout]. </member> + <member name="gui/timers/button_shortcut_feedback_highlight_time" type="float" setter="" getter="" default="0.2"> + When [member BaseButton.shortcut_feedback] is enabled, this is the time the [BaseButton] will remain highlighted after a shortcut. + </member> <member name="gui/timers/incremental_search_max_interval_msec" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="2000"> Timer setting for incremental search in [Tree], [ItemList], etc. controls (in milliseconds). </member> @@ -1686,7 +1755,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // Set the default gravity strength to 980. - PhysicsServer2D.AreaSetParam(GetViewport().FindWorld2d().Space, PhysicsServer2D.AreaParameter.Gravity, 980); + PhysicsServer2D.AreaSetParam(GetViewport().FindWorld2D().Space, PhysicsServer2D.AreaParameter.Gravity, 980); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </member> @@ -1700,7 +1769,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // Set the default gravity direction to `Vector2(0, 1)`. - PhysicsServer2D.AreaSetParam(GetViewport().FindWorld2d().Space, PhysicsServer2D.AreaParameter.GravityVector, Vector2.Down) + PhysicsServer2D.AreaSetParam(GetViewport().FindWorld2D().Space, PhysicsServer2D.AreaParameter.GravityVector, Vector2.Down) [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </member> @@ -2234,20 +2303,12 @@ <member name="rendering/textures/lossless_compression/force_png" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import lossless textures using the PNG format. Otherwise, it will default to using WebP. </member> - <member name="rendering/textures/vram_compression/import_bptc" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="false"> - If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import VRAM-compressed textures using the BPTC algorithm. This texture compression algorithm is only supported on desktop platforms, and only when using the Vulkan renderer. - [b]Note:[/b] Changing this setting does [i]not[/i] impact textures that were already imported before. To make this setting apply to textures that were already imported, exit the editor, remove the [code].godot/imported/[/code] folder located inside the project folder then restart the editor (see [member application/config/use_hidden_project_data_directory]). - </member> - <member name="rendering/textures/vram_compression/import_etc" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="false"> - If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import VRAM-compressed textures using the Ericsson Texture Compression algorithm. This algorithm doesn't support alpha channels in textures. - [b]Note:[/b] Changing this setting does [i]not[/i] impact textures that were already imported before. To make this setting apply to textures that were already imported, exit the editor, remove the [code].godot/imported/[/code] folder located inside the project folder then restart the editor (see [member application/config/use_hidden_project_data_directory]). - </member> - <member name="rendering/textures/vram_compression/import_etc2" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="true"> - If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import VRAM-compressed textures using the Ericsson Texture Compression 2 algorithm. This texture compression algorithm is only supported when using the Vulkan renderer. + <member name="rendering/textures/vram_compression/import_etc2_astc" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import VRAM-compressed textures using the Ericsson Texture Compression 2 algorithm for lower quality textures and normalmaps and Adaptable Scalable Texture Compression algorithm for high quality textures (in 4x4 block size). [b]Note:[/b] Changing this setting does [i]not[/i] impact textures that were already imported before. To make this setting apply to textures that were already imported, exit the editor, remove the [code].godot/imported/[/code] folder located inside the project folder then restart the editor (see [member application/config/use_hidden_project_data_directory]). </member> - <member name="rendering/textures/vram_compression/import_s3tc" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="true"> - If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import VRAM-compressed textures using the S3 Texture Compression algorithm. This algorithm is only supported on desktop platforms and consoles. + <member name="rendering/textures/vram_compression/import_s3tc_bptc" type="bool" setter="" getter="" default="true"> + If [code]true[/code], the texture importer will import VRAM-compressed textures using the S3 Texture Compression algorithm (DXT1-5) for lower quality textures and the the BPTC algorithm (BC6H and BC7) for high quality textures. This algorithm is only supported on PC desktop platforms and consoles. [b]Note:[/b] Changing this setting does [i]not[/i] impact textures that were already imported before. To make this setting apply to textures that were already imported, exit the editor, remove the [code].godot/imported/[/code] folder located inside the project folder then restart the editor (see [member application/config/use_hidden_project_data_directory]). </member> <member name="rendering/textures/webp_compression/compression_method" type="int" setter="" getter="" default="2"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Projection.xml b/doc/classes/Projection.xml index 602833bca5..99e3f1725f 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Projection.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Projection.xml @@ -149,7 +149,7 @@ <param index="4" name="flip_fov" type="bool" /> <param index="5" name="eye" type="int" /> <param index="6" name="intraocular_dist" type="float" /> - <param index="7" name=" convergence_dist" type="float" /> + <param index="7" name="convergence_dist" type="float" /> <description> Creates a new [Projection] that projects positions using a perspective projection with the given Y-axis field of view (in degrees), X:Y aspect ratio, and clipping distances. The projection is adjusted for a head-mounted display with the given distance between eyes and distance to a point that can be focused on. [param eye] creates the projection for the left eye when set to 1, or the right eye when set to 2. diff --git a/doc/classes/Rect2i.xml b/doc/classes/Rect2i.xml index 325ead0cfa..80a9b40605 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Rect2i.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Rect2i.xml @@ -80,9 +80,9 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // position (-3, 2), size (1, 1) - var rect = new Rect2i(new Vector2i(-3, 2), new Vector2i(1, 1)); - // position (-3, -1), size (3, 4), so we fit both rect and Vector2i(0, -1) - var rect2 = rect.Expand(new Vector2i(0, -1)); + var rect = new Rect2I(new Vector2I(-3, 2), new Vector2I(1, 1)); + // position (-3, -1), size (3, 4), so we fit both rect and Vector2I(0, -1) + var rect2 = rect.Expand(new Vector2I(0, -1)); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/RemoteTransform2D.xml b/doc/classes/RemoteTransform2D.xml index 20fa41a3f0..6f100541be 100644 --- a/doc/classes/RemoteTransform2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/RemoteTransform2D.xml @@ -1,11 +1,11 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="RemoteTransform2D" inherits="Node2D" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> - RemoteTransform2D pushes its own [Transform2D] to another [CanvasItem] derived Node in the scene. + RemoteTransform2D pushes its own [Transform2D] to another [Node2D] derived node in the scene. </brief_description> <description> - RemoteTransform2D pushes its own [Transform2D] to another [CanvasItem] derived Node (called the remote node) in the scene. - It can be set to update another Node's position, rotation and/or scale. It can use either global or local coordinates. + RemoteTransform2D pushes its own [Transform2D] to another [Node2D] derived node (called the remote node) in the scene. + It can be set to update another node's position, rotation and/or scale. It can use either global or local coordinates. </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> diff --git a/doc/classes/RenderingServer.xml b/doc/classes/RenderingServer.xml index 7675a37cbd..8bb3073000 100644 --- a/doc/classes/RenderingServer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/RenderingServer.xml @@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ <param index="1" name="from" type="Vector2" /> <param index="2" name="to" type="Vector2" /> <param index="3" name="color" type="Color" /> - <param index="4" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="4" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="5" name="antialiased" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> </description> @@ -291,7 +291,7 @@ <param index="0" name="item" type="RID" /> <param index="1" name="points" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="2" name="colors" type="PackedColorArray" /> - <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> + <param index="3" name="width" type="float" default="-1.0" /> <param index="4" name="antialiased" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> </description> @@ -303,7 +303,6 @@ <param index="2" name="colors" type="PackedColorArray" /> <param index="3" name="uvs" type="PackedVector2Array" /> <param index="4" name="texture" type="RID" /> - <param index="5" name="width" type="float" default="1.0" /> <description> </description> </method> @@ -3246,12 +3245,12 @@ <description> </description> </method> - <method name="viewport_set_disable_environment"> + <method name="viewport_set_environment_mode"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="viewport" type="RID" /> - <param index="1" name="disabled" type="bool" /> + <param index="1" name="mode" type="int" enum="RenderingServer.ViewportEnvironmentMode" /> <description> - If [code]true[/code], rendering of a viewport's environment is disabled. + Sets the viewport's environment mode which allows enabling or disabling rendering of 3D environment over 2D canvas. When disabled, 2D will not be affected by the environment. When enabled, 2D will be affected by the environment if the environment background mode is [constant ENV_BG_CANVAS]. The default behaviour is to inherit the setting from the viewport's parent. If the topmost parent is also set to [constant VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_INHERIT], then the behavior will be the same as if it was set to [constant VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_ENABLED]. </description> </method> <method name="viewport_set_fsr_sharpness"> @@ -3337,7 +3336,7 @@ <param index="0" name="viewport" type="RID" /> <param index="1" name="enabled" type="bool" /> <description> - If [code]true[/code], render the contents of the viewport directly to screen. This allows a low-level optimization where you can skip drawing a viewport to the root viewport. While this optimization can result in a significant increase in speed (especially on older devices), it comes at a cost of usability. When this is enabled, you cannot read from the viewport or from the [code]SCREEN_TEXTURE[/code]. You also lose the benefit of certain window settings, such as the various stretch modes. Another consequence to be aware of is that in 2D the rendering happens in window coordinates, so if you have a viewport that is double the size of the window, and you set this, then only the portion that fits within the window will be drawn, no automatic scaling is possible, even if your game scene is significantly larger than the window size. + If [code]true[/code], render the contents of the viewport directly to screen. This allows a low-level optimization where you can skip drawing a viewport to the root viewport. While this optimization can result in a significant increase in speed (especially on older devices), it comes at a cost of usability. When this is enabled, you cannot read from the viewport or from the screen_texture. You also lose the benefit of certain window settings, such as the various stretch modes. Another consequence to be aware of is that in 2D the rendering happens in window coordinates, so if you have a viewport that is double the size of the window, and you set this, then only the portion that fits within the window will be drawn, no automatic scaling is possible, even if your game scene is significantly larger than the window size. </description> </method> <method name="viewport_set_scaling_3d_mode"> @@ -3811,6 +3810,8 @@ </constant> <constant name="ARRAY_FLAG_USE_8_BONE_WEIGHTS" value="134217728" enum="ArrayFormat" is_bitfield="true"> </constant> + <constant name="ARRAY_FLAG_USES_EMPTY_VERTEX_ARRAY" value="268435456" enum="ArrayFormat" is_bitfield="true"> + </constant> <constant name="PRIMITIVE_POINTS" value="0" enum="PrimitiveType"> Primitive to draw consists of points. </constant> @@ -4134,6 +4135,18 @@ <constant name="VIEWPORT_CLEAR_ONLY_NEXT_FRAME" value="2" enum="ViewportClearMode"> The viewport is cleared once, then the clear mode is set to [constant VIEWPORT_CLEAR_NEVER]. </constant> + <constant name="VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_DISABLED" value="0" enum="ViewportEnvironmentMode"> + Disable rendering of 3D environment over 2D canvas. + </constant> + <constant name="VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_ENABLED" value="1" enum="ViewportEnvironmentMode"> + Enable rendering of 3D environment over 2D canvas. + </constant> + <constant name="VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_INHERIT" value="2" enum="ViewportEnvironmentMode"> + Inherit enable/disable value from parent. If topmost parent is also set to inherit, then this has the same behavior as [constant VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_ENABLED]. + </constant> + <constant name="VIEWPORT_ENVIRONMENT_MAX" value="3" enum="ViewportEnvironmentMode"> + Max value of [enum ViewportEnvironmentMode] enum. + </constant> <constant name="VIEWPORT_SDF_OVERSIZE_100_PERCENT" value="0" enum="ViewportSDFOversize"> </constant> <constant name="VIEWPORT_SDF_OVERSIZE_120_PERCENT" value="1" enum="ViewportSDFOversize"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Resource.xml b/doc/classes/Resource.xml index e533fc1e32..67f466ad4c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Resource.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Resource.xml @@ -24,7 +24,8 @@ <param index="0" name="subresources" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> Duplicates this resource, returning a new resource with its [code]export[/code]ed or [constant PROPERTY_USAGE_STORAGE] properties copied from the original. - If [param subresources] is [code]false[/code], a shallow copy is returned. Nested resources within subresources are not duplicated and are shared from the original resource. This behavior can be overridden by the [constant PROPERTY_USAGE_DO_NOT_SHARE_ON_DUPLICATE] flag. + If [param subresources] is [code]false[/code], a shallow copy is returned; nested resources within subresources are not duplicated and are shared from the original resource. If [param subresources] is [code]true[/code], a deep copy is returned; nested subresources will be duplicated and are not shared. + Subresource properties with the [constant PROPERTY_USAGE_ALWAYS_DUPLICATE] flag are always duplicated even with [param subresources] set to [code]false[/code], and properties with the [constant PROPERTY_USAGE_NEVER_DUPLICATE] flag are never duplicated even with [param subresources] set to [code]true[/code]. [b]Note:[/b] For custom resources, this method will fail if [method Object._init] has been defined with required parameters. </description> </method> diff --git a/doc/classes/ResourceFormatLoader.xml b/doc/classes/ResourceFormatLoader.xml index 2b6376f2cd..bb55123b37 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ResourceFormatLoader.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ResourceFormatLoader.xml @@ -38,6 +38,13 @@ Gets the list of extensions for files this loader is able to read. </description> </method> + <method name="_get_resource_script_class" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="String" /> + <param index="0" name="path" type="String" /> + <description> + Returns the script class name associated with the [Resource] under the given [param path]. If the resource has no script or the script isn't a named class, it should return [code]""[/code]. + </description> + </method> <method name="_get_resource_type" qualifiers="virtual const"> <return type="String" /> <param index="0" name="path" type="String" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/ResourcePreloader.xml b/doc/classes/ResourcePreloader.xml index 17904697e6..5c0079f408 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ResourcePreloader.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ResourcePreloader.xml @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="ResourcePreloader" inherits="Node" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> - Resource Preloader Node. + Preloads a list of resources inside a scene. </brief_description> <description> - This node is used to preload sub-resources inside a scene, so when the scene is loaded, all the resources are ready to use and can be retrieved from the preloader. + This node is used to preload sub-resources inside a scene, so when the scene is loaded, all the resources are ready to use and can be retrieved from the preloader. You can add the resources using the ResourcePreloader tab when the node is selected. GDScript has a simplified [method @GDScript.preload] built-in method which can be used in most situations, leaving the use of [ResourcePreloader] for more advanced scenarios. </description> <tutorials> diff --git a/doc/classes/RichTextEffect.xml b/doc/classes/RichTextEffect.xml index c01546524d..333d34d1b7 100644 --- a/doc/classes/RichTextEffect.xml +++ b/doc/classes/RichTextEffect.xml @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] // The RichTextEffect will be usable like this: `[example]Some text[/example]` - public string bbcode = "example"; + string bbcode = "example"; [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Note:[/b] As soon as a [RichTextLabel] contains at least one [RichTextEffect], it will continuously process the effect unless the project is paused. This may impact battery life negatively. diff --git a/doc/classes/RichTextLabel.xml b/doc/classes/RichTextLabel.xml index dd291a425d..1ecc8a1d4e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/RichTextLabel.xml +++ b/doc/classes/RichTextLabel.xml @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ [b]Note:[/b] Assignments to [member text] clear the tag stack and reconstruct it from the property's contents. Any edits made to [member text] will erase previous edits made from other manual sources such as [method append_text] and the [code]push_*[/code] / [method pop] methods. [b]Note:[/b] RichTextLabel doesn't support entangled BBCode tags. For example, instead of using [code][b]bold[i]bold italic[/b]italic[/i][/code], use [code][b]bold[i]bold italic[/i][/b][i]italic[/i][/code]. [b]Note:[/b] [code]push_*/pop[/code] functions won't affect BBCode. - [b]Note:[/b] Unlike [Label], RichTextLabel doesn't have a [i]property[/i] to horizontally align text to the center. Instead, enable [member bbcode_enabled] and surround the text in a [code][center][/code] tag as follows: [code][center]Example[/center][/code]. There is currently no built-in way to vertically align text either, but this can be emulated by relying on anchors/containers and the [member fit_content_height] property. + [b]Note:[/b] Unlike [Label], RichTextLabel doesn't have a [i]property[/i] to horizontally align text to the center. Instead, enable [member bbcode_enabled] and surround the text in a [code][center][/code] tag as follows: [code][center]Example[/center][/code]. There is currently no built-in way to vertically align text either, but this can be emulated by relying on anchors/containers and the [member fit_content] property. </description> <tutorials> <link title="BBCode in RichTextLabel">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/ui/bbcode_in_richtextlabel.html</link> @@ -251,6 +251,14 @@ Adds a [code][color][/code] tag to the tag stack. </description> </method> + <method name="push_customfx"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="effect" type="RichTextEffect" /> + <param index="1" name="env" type="Dictionary" /> + <description> + Adds a custom effect tag to the tag stack. The effect does not need to be in [member custom_effects]. The environment is directly passed to the effect. + </description> + </method> <method name="push_dropcap"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="string" type="String" /> @@ -283,6 +291,7 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="font_size" type="int" /> <description> + Adds a [code][font_size][/code] tag to the tag stack. Overrides default font size for its duration. </description> </method> <method name="push_hint"> @@ -473,9 +482,8 @@ <member name="deselect_on_focus_loss_enabled" type="bool" setter="set_deselect_on_focus_loss_enabled" getter="is_deselect_on_focus_loss_enabled" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], the selected text will be deselected when focus is lost. </member> - <member name="fit_content_height" type="bool" setter="set_fit_content_height" getter="is_fit_content_height_enabled" default="false"> - If [code]true[/code], the label's height will be automatically updated to fit its content. - [b]Note:[/b] This property is used as a workaround to fix issues with [RichTextLabel] in [Container]s, but it's unreliable in some cases and will be removed in future versions. + <member name="fit_content" type="bool" setter="set_fit_content" getter="is_fit_content_enabled" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code], the label's minimum size will be automatically updated to fit its content, matching the behavior of [Label]. </member> <member name="hint_underlined" type="bool" setter="set_hint_underline" getter="is_hint_underlined" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], the label underlines hint tags such as [code][hint=description]{text}[/hint][/code]. diff --git a/doc/classes/RigidBody3D.xml b/doc/classes/RigidBody3D.xml index 8380d56de3..148cdf96ee 100644 --- a/doc/classes/RigidBody3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/RigidBody3D.xml @@ -8,6 +8,7 @@ You can switch the body's behavior using [member lock_rotation], [member freeze], and [member freeze_mode]. [b]Note:[/b] Don't change a RigidBody3D's position every frame or very often. Sporadic changes work fine, but physics runs at a different granularity (fixed Hz) than usual rendering (process callback) and maybe even in a separate thread, so changing this from a process loop may result in strange behavior. If you need to directly affect the body's state, use [method _integrate_forces], which allows you to directly access the physics state. If you need to override the default physics behavior, you can write a custom force integration function. See [member custom_integrator]. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Physics introduction">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/physics/physics_introduction.html</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/SceneTree.xml b/doc/classes/SceneTree.xml index bf19ebc23a..6adb37a3f7 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SceneTree.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SceneTree.xml @@ -74,10 +74,10 @@ print("end") [/gdscript] [csharp] - public async void SomeFunction() + public async Task SomeFunction() { GD.Print("start"); - await ToSignal(GetTree().CreateTimer(1.0f), "timeout"); + await ToSignal(GetTree().CreateTimer(1.0f), SceneTreeTimer.SignalName.Timeout); GD.Print("end"); } [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/SceneTreeTimer.xml b/doc/classes/SceneTreeTimer.xml index f28e65c5bf..42b070d7d9 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SceneTreeTimer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SceneTreeTimer.xml @@ -14,10 +14,10 @@ print("Timer ended.") [/gdscript] [csharp] - public async void SomeFunction() + public async Task SomeFunction() { GD.Print("Timer started."); - await ToSignal(GetTree().CreateTimer(1.0f), "timeout"); + await ToSignal(GetTree().CreateTimer(1.0f), SceneTreeTimer.SignalName.Timeout); GD.Print("Timer ended."); } [/csharp] diff --git a/doc/classes/Semaphore.xml b/doc/classes/Semaphore.xml index 6b2007363e..d1d126c5cb 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Semaphore.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Semaphore.xml @@ -17,9 +17,9 @@ </description> </method> <method name="try_wait"> - <return type="int" enum="Error" /> + <return type="bool" /> <description> - Like [method wait], but won't block, so if the value is zero, fails immediately and returns [constant ERR_BUSY]. If non-zero, it returns [constant OK] to report success. + Like [method wait], but won't block, so if the value is zero, fails immediately and returns [code]false[/code]. If non-zero, it returns [code]true[/code] to report success. </description> </method> <method name="wait"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Shader.xml b/doc/classes/Shader.xml index 75f835260a..c472ab647e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Shader.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Shader.xml @@ -26,12 +26,12 @@ Returns the shader mode for the shader, either [constant MODE_CANVAS_ITEM], [constant MODE_SPATIAL] or [constant MODE_PARTICLES]. </description> </method> - <method name="has_parameter" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> + <method name="get_shader_uniform_list"> + <return type="Array" /> + <param index="0" name="get_groups" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Returns [code]true[/code] if the shader has this param defined as a uniform in its code. - [b]Note:[/b] [param name] must match the name of the uniform in the code exactly. + Get the list of shader uniforms that can be assigned to a [ShaderMaterial], for use with [method ShaderMaterial.set_shader_parameter] and [method ShaderMaterial.get_shader_parameter]. The parameters returned are contained in dictionaries in a similar format to the ones returned by [method Object.get_property_list]. + If argument [param get_groups] is true, parameter grouping hints will be provided. </description> </method> <method name="set_default_texture_parameter"> diff --git a/doc/classes/ShaderMaterial.xml b/doc/classes/ShaderMaterial.xml index 1af7ac4fc5..a2346822e5 100644 --- a/doc/classes/ShaderMaterial.xml +++ b/doc/classes/ShaderMaterial.xml @@ -23,7 +23,8 @@ <param index="1" name="value" type="Variant" /> <description> Changes the value set for this material of a uniform in the shader. - [b]Note:[/b] [param param] must match the name of the uniform in the code exactly. + [b]Note:[/b] [param param] is case-sensitive and must match the name of the uniform in the code exactly (not the capitalized name in the inspector). + [b]Note:[/b] Changes to the shader uniform will be effective on all instances using this [ShaderMaterial]. To prevent this, use per-instance uniforms with [method GeometryInstance3D.set_instance_shader_parameter] or duplicate the [ShaderMaterial] resource using [method Resource.duplicate]. Per-instance uniforms allow for better shader reuse and are therefore faster, so they should be preferred over duplicating the [ShaderMaterial] when possible. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/Signal.xml b/doc/classes/Signal.xml index 3412cd2140..71905e8b2e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Signal.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Signal.xml @@ -16,12 +16,12 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] [Signal] - delegate void Attacked(); + delegate void AttackedEventHandler(); // Additional arguments may be declared. // These arguments must be passed when the signal is emitted. [Signal] - delegate void ItemDropped(itemName: string, amount: int); + delegate void ItemDroppedEventHandler(string itemName, int amount); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/Skeleton2D.xml b/doc/classes/Skeleton2D.xml index 808f93b491..39bdc5c796 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Skeleton2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Skeleton2D.xml @@ -16,7 +16,7 @@ <param index="0" name="delta" type="float" /> <param index="1" name="execution_mode" type="int" /> <description> - Executes all the modifications on the [SkeletonModificationStack2D], if the Skeleton3D has one assigned. + Executes all the modifications on the [SkeletonModificationStack2D], if the Skeleton2D has one assigned. </description> </method> <method name="get_bone"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Skeleton3D.xml b/doc/classes/Skeleton3D.xml index 3bd0e04b92..70986ba06a 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Skeleton3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Skeleton3D.xml @@ -7,6 +7,7 @@ Skeleton3D provides a hierarchical interface for managing bones, including pose, rest and animation (see [Animation]). It can also use ragdoll physics. The overall transform of a bone with respect to the skeleton is determined by the following hierarchical order: rest pose, custom pose and pose. Note that "global pose" below refers to the overall transform of the bone with respect to skeleton, so it not the actual global/world transform of the bone. + To setup different types of inverse kinematics, consider using [SkeletonIK3D], or add a custom IK implementation in [method Node._process] as a child node. </description> <tutorials> <link title="3D Inverse Kinematics Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/523</link> @@ -32,26 +33,11 @@ Removes the global pose override on all bones in the skeleton. </description> </method> - <method name="clear_bones_local_pose_override" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="void" /> - <description> - Deprecated. Local pose overrides will be removed. - Removes the local pose override on all bones in the skeleton. - </description> - </method> <method name="create_skin_from_rest_transforms"> <return type="Skin" /> <description> </description> </method> - <method name="execute_modifications" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="delta" type="float" /> - <param index="1" name="execution_mode" type="int" /> - <description> - Executes all the modifications on the [SkeletonModificationStack3D], if the Skeleton3D has one assigned. - </description> - </method> <method name="find_bone" qualifiers="const"> <return type="int" /> <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> @@ -113,13 +99,6 @@ Returns the global rest transform for [param bone_idx]. </description> </method> - <method name="get_bone_local_pose_override" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Transform3D" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the local pose override transform for [param bone_idx]. - </description> - </method> <method name="get_bone_name" qualifiers="const"> <return type="String" /> <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> @@ -167,43 +146,18 @@ Returns the rest transform for a bone [param bone_idx]. </description> </method> - <method name="get_modification_stack" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="SkeletonModificationStack3D" /> - <description> - Returns the modification stack attached to this skeleton, if one exists. - </description> - </method> <method name="get_parentless_bones" qualifiers="const"> <return type="PackedInt32Array" /> <description> Returns an array with all of the bones that are parentless. Another way to look at this is that it returns the indexes of all the bones that are not dependent or modified by other bones in the Skeleton. </description> </method> - <method name="global_pose_to_local_pose" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="Transform3D" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="global_pose" type="Transform3D" /> - <description> - Takes the passed-in global pose and converts it to local pose transform. - This can be used to easily convert a global pose from [method get_bone_global_pose] to a global transform in [method set_bone_local_pose_override]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="global_pose_to_world_transform" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="Transform3D" /> - <param index="0" name="global_pose" type="Transform3D" /> - <description> - Deprecated. Use [Node3D] apis instead. - Takes the passed-in global pose and converts it to a world transform. - This can be used to easily convert a global pose from [method get_bone_global_pose] to a global transform usable with a node's transform, like [member Node3D.global_transform] for example. - </description> - </method> - <method name="global_pose_z_forward_to_bone_forward" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="Basis" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="basis" type="Basis" /> + <method name="get_version" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="int" /> <description> - Rotates the given [Basis] so that the forward axis of the Basis is facing in the forward direction of the bone at [param bone_idx]. - This is helper function to make using [method Transform3D.looking_at] easier with bone poses. + Returns the number of times the bone hierarchy has changed within this skeleton, including renames. + The Skeleton version is not serialized: only use within a single instance of Skeleton3D. + Use for invalidating caches in IK solvers and other nodes which process bones. </description> </method> <method name="is_bone_enabled" qualifiers="const"> @@ -213,15 +167,6 @@ Returns whether the bone pose for the bone at [param bone_idx] is enabled. </description> </method> - <method name="local_pose_to_global_pose" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="Transform3D" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="local_pose" type="Transform3D" /> - <description> - Converts the passed-in local pose to a global pose relative to the inputted bone, [param bone_idx]. - This could be used to convert [method get_bone_pose] for use with the [method set_bone_global_pose_override] function. - </description> - </method> <method name="localize_rests"> <return type="void" /> <description> @@ -298,19 +243,6 @@ [b]Note:[/b] The pose transform needs to be a global pose! To convert a world transform from a [Node3D] to a global bone pose, multiply the [method Transform3D.affine_inverse] of the node's [member Node3D.global_transform] by the desired world transform </description> </method> - <method name="set_bone_local_pose_override" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="pose" type="Transform3D" /> - <param index="2" name="amount" type="float" /> - <param index="3" name="persistent" type="bool" default="false" /> - <description> - Deprecated. Local pose overrides will be removed. - Sets the local pose transform, [param pose], for the bone at [param bone_idx]. - [param amount] is the interpolation strength that will be used when applying the pose, and [param persistent] determines if the applied pose will remain. - [b]Note:[/b] The pose transform needs to be a local pose! Use [method global_pose_to_local_pose] to convert a global pose to a local pose. - </description> - </method> <method name="set_bone_name"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> @@ -356,13 +288,6 @@ Sets the rest transform for bone [param bone_idx]. </description> </method> - <method name="set_modification_stack" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="modification_stack" type="SkeletonModificationStack3D" /> - <description> - Sets the modification stack for this skeleton to the passed-in modification stack, [param modification_stack]. - </description> - </method> <method name="unparent_bone_and_rest"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> @@ -370,15 +295,6 @@ Unparents the bone at [param bone_idx] and sets its rest position to that of its parent prior to being reset. </description> </method> - <method name="world_transform_to_global_pose" is_deprecated="true"> - <return type="Transform3D" /> - <param index="0" name="world_transform" type="Transform3D" /> - <description> - Deprecated. Use [Node3D] apis instead. - Takes the passed-in global transform and converts it to a global pose. - This can be used to easily convert a global transform from [member Node3D.global_transform] to a global pose usable with [method set_bone_global_pose_override], for example. - </description> - </method> </methods> <members> <member name="animate_physical_bones" type="bool" setter="set_animate_physical_bones" getter="get_animate_physical_bones" default="true"> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification2D.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification2D.xml index 77aaf0213b..3a78f13bff 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification2D.xml @@ -56,7 +56,7 @@ <method name="get_modification_stack"> <return type="SkeletonModificationStack2D" /> <description> - Returns the [SkeletonModificationStack2D] that this modification is bound to. Through the modification stack, you can access the Skeleton3D the modification is operating on. + Returns the [SkeletonModificationStack2D] that this modification is bound to. Through the modification stack, you can access the Skeleton2D the modification is operating on. </description> </method> <method name="set_editor_draw_gizmo"> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3D.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3D.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 25431ea96f..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3D.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,66 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3D" inherits="Resource" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A resource that operates on bones in a [Skeleton3D]. - </brief_description> - <description> - This resource provides an interface that can be expanded so code that operates on bones in a [Skeleton3D] can be mixed and matched together to create complex interactions. - This is used to provide Godot with a flexible and powerful Inverse Kinematics solution that can be adapted for many different uses. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="_execute" qualifiers="virtual"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="delta" type="float" /> - <description> - Executes the given modification. This is where the modification performs whatever function it is designed to do. - </description> - </method> - <method name="_setup_modification" qualifiers="virtual"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="modification_stack" type="SkeletonModificationStack3D" /> - <description> - Sets up the modification so it can be executed. This function should be called automatically by the [SkeletonModificationStack3D] containing this modification. - If you need to initialize a modification before use, this is the place to do it! - </description> - </method> - <method name="clamp_angle"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="angle" type="float" /> - <param index="1" name="min" type="float" /> - <param index="2" name="max" type="float" /> - <param index="3" name="invert" type="bool" /> - <description> - Takes a angle and clamps it so it is within the passed-in [param min] and [param max] range. [param invert] will inversely clamp the angle, clamping it to the range outside of the given bounds. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_is_setup" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether this modification has been successfully setup or not. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_modification_stack"> - <return type="SkeletonModificationStack3D" /> - <description> - Returns the [SkeletonModificationStack3D] that this modification is bound to. Through the modification stack, you can access the Skeleton3D the modification is operating on. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_is_setup"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="is_setup" type="bool" /> - <description> - Manually allows you to set the setup state of the modification. This function should only rarely be used, as the [SkeletonModificationStack3D] the modification is bound to should handle setting the modification up. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="enabled" type="bool" setter="set_enabled" getter="get_enabled" default="true"> - When true, the modification's [method _execute] function will be called by the [SkeletonModificationStack3D]. - </member> - <member name="execution_mode" type="int" setter="set_execution_mode" getter="get_execution_mode" default="0"> - The execution mode for the modification. This tells the modification stack when to execute the modification. Some modifications have settings that are only available in certain execution modes. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DCCDIK.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DCCDIK.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 90b2e78449..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DCCDIK.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,136 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3DCCDIK" inherits="SkeletonModification3D" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A modification that uses CCDIK to manipulate a series of bones to reach a target. - </brief_description> - <description> - This [SkeletonModification3D] uses an algorithm called Cyclic Coordinate Descent Inverse Kinematics, or CCDIK, to manipulate a chain of bones in a Skeleton so it reaches a defined target. - CCDIK works by rotating a set of bones, typically called a "bone chain", on a single axis. Each bone is rotated to face the target from the tip (by default), which over a chain of bones allow it to rotate properly to reach the target. Because the bones only rotate on a single axis, CCDIK [i]can[/i] look more robotic than other IK solvers. - [b]Note:[/b] The CCDIK modifier has [code]ccdik_joints[/code], which are the data objects that hold the data for each joint in the CCDIK chain. This is different from a bone! CCDIK joints hold the data needed for each bone in the bone chain used by CCDIK. - CCDIK also fully supports angle constraints, allowing for more control over how a solution is met. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_bone_index" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the bone index of the bone assigned to the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_bone_name" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="String" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the name of the bone that is assigned to the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_ccdik_axis" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the integer representing the joint axis of the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_constraint_angle_max" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the maximum angle constraint for the joint at [param joint_idx]. [b]Note:[/b] This angle is in degrees! - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_constraint_angle_min" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the minimum angle constraint for the joint at [param joint_idx]. [b]Note:[/b] This angle is in degrees! - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_constraint_invert" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns whether the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx] uses an inverted joint constraint. See [method set_ccdik_joint_constraint_invert] for details. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_ccdik_joint_enable_joint_constraint" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Enables angle constraints to the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_bone_index"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="bone_index" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the bone index, [param bone_index], of the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_name[/code] of the CCDIK joint based on data provided by the linked skeleton. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_bone_name"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="bone_name" type="String" /> - <description> - Sets the bone name, [param bone_name], of the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_index[/code] of the CCDIK joint based on data provided by the linked skeleton. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_ccdik_axis"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="axis" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the joint axis of the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx] to the passed-in joint axis, [param axis]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_constraint_angle_max"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="max_angle" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the maximum angle constraint for the joint at [param joint_idx]. [b]Note:[/b] This angle must be in radians! - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_constraint_angle_min"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="min_angle" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the minimum angle constraint for the joint at [param joint_idx]. [b]Note:[/b] This angle must be in radians! - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_constraint_invert"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="invert" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx] uses an inverted joint constraint. - An inverted joint constraint only constraints the CCDIK joint to the angles [i]outside of[/i] the inputted minimum and maximum angles. For this reason, it is referred to as an inverted joint constraint, as it constraints the joint to the outside of the inputted values. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_ccdik_joint_enable_joint_constraint"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="enable" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether joint constraints are enabled for the CCDIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="ccdik_data_chain_length" type="int" setter="set_ccdik_data_chain_length" getter="get_ccdik_data_chain_length" default="0"> - The number of CCDIK joints in the CCDIK modification. - </member> - <member name="high_quality_solve" type="bool" setter="set_use_high_quality_solve" getter="get_use_high_quality_solve" default="true"> - When true, the CCDIK algorithm will perform a higher quality solve that returns more natural results. A high quality solve requires more computation power to solve though, and therefore can be disabled to save performance. - </member> - <member name="target_nodepath" type="NodePath" setter="set_target_node" getter="get_target_node" default="NodePath("")"> - The NodePath to the node that is the target for the CCDIK modification. This node is what the CCDIK chain will attempt to rotate the bone chain to. - </member> - <member name="tip_nodepath" type="NodePath" setter="set_tip_node" getter="get_tip_node" default="NodePath("")"> - The end position of the CCDIK chain. Typically, this should be a child of a [BoneAttachment3D] node attached to the final bone in the CCDIK chain, where the child node is offset so it is at the end of the final bone. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DFABRIK.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DFABRIK.xml deleted file mode 100644 index a2bec2b559..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DFABRIK.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,161 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3DFABRIK" inherits="SkeletonModification3D" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A modification that uses FABRIK to manipulate a series of bones to reach a target. - </brief_description> - <description> - This [SkeletonModification3D] uses an algorithm called Forward And Backward Reaching Inverse Kinematics, or FABRIK, to rotate a bone chain so that it reaches a target. - FABRIK works by knowing the positions and lengths of a series of bones, typically called a "bone chain". It first starts by running a forward pass, which places the final bone at the target's position. Then all other bones are moved towards the tip bone, so they stay at the defined bone length away. Then a backwards pass is performed, where the root/first bone in the FABRIK chain is placed back at the origin. then all other bones are moved so they stay at the defined bone length away. This positions the bone chain so that it reaches the target when possible, but all of the bones stay the correct length away from each other. - Because of how FABRIK works, it often gives more natural results than those seen in [SkeletonModification3DCCDIK], though FABRIK currently does not support joint constraints. - [b]Note:[/b] The FABRIK modifier has [code]fabrik_joints[/code], which are the data objects that hold the data for each joint in the FABRIK chain. This is different from a bone! FABRIK joints hold the data needed for each bone in the bone chain used by FABRIK. - To help control how the FABRIK joints move, a magnet vector can be passed, which can nudge the bones in a certain direction prior to solving, giving a level of control over the final result. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="fabrik_joint_auto_calculate_length"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Will attempt to automatically calculate the length of the bone assigned to the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_auto_calculate_length" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns a boolean that indicates whether this modification will attempt to autocalculate the length of the bone assigned to the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_bone_index" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the bone index of the bone assigned to the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_bone_name" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="String" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the name of the bone that is assigned to the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_length" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the length of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_magnet" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector3" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the magnet vector of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_tip_node" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="NodePath" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the [Node3D]-based node placed at the tip of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx], if one has been set. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_use_target_basis" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns a boolean indicating whether the FABRIK joint uses the target's [Basis] for its rotation. - [b]Note:[/b] This option is only available for the final bone in the FABRIK chain, with this setting being ignored for all other bones. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_fabrik_joint_use_tip_node" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the [Node3D]-based node that will be used as the tip of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_auto_calculate_length"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="auto_calculate_length" type="bool" /> - <description> - When [code]true[/code], this modification will attempt to automatically calculate the length of the bone for the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. It does this by either using the tip node assigned, if there is one assigned, or the distance the of the bone's children, if the bone has any. If the bone has no children and no tip node is assigned, then the modification [b]cannot[/b] autocalculate the joint's length. In this case, the joint length should be entered manually or a tip node assigned. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_bone_index"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="bone_index" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the bone index, [param bone_index], of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_name[/code] of the FABRIK joint based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_bone_name"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="bone_name" type="String" /> - <description> - Sets the bone name, [param bone_name], of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_index[/code] of the FABRIK joint based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_length"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="length" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the joint length, [param length], of the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_magnet"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="magnet_position" type="Vector3" /> - <description> - Sets the magenet position to [param magnet_position] for the joint at [param joint_idx]. The magnet position is used to nudge the joint in that direction when solving, which gives some control over how that joint will bend when being solved. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_tip_node"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="tip_node" type="NodePath" /> - <description> - Sets the nodepath of the FARIK joint at [param joint_idx] to [param tip_node]. The tip node is used to calculate the length of the FABRIK joint when set to automatically calculate joint length. - [b]Note:[/b] The tip node should generally be a child node of a [BoneAttachment3D] node attached to the bone that this FABRIK joint operates on, with the child node being offset so it is at the end of the bone. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_use_target_basis"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="use_target_basis" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx] uses the target's [Basis] for its rotation. - [b]Note:[/b] This option is only available for the final bone in the FABRIK chain, with this setting being ignored for all other bones. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_fabrik_joint_use_tip_node"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="use_tip_node" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether the tip node should be used when autocalculating the joint length for the FABRIK joint at [param joint_idx]. This will only work if there is a node assigned to the tip nodepath for this joint. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="chain_max_iterations" type="int" setter="set_chain_max_iterations" getter="get_chain_max_iterations" default="10"> - The number of times FABRIK will try to solve each time the [code]execute[/code] function is called. Setting this value to a lower number will be result in better performance, but this can also result in harsher movements and slower solves. - </member> - <member name="chain_tolerance" type="float" setter="set_chain_tolerance" getter="get_chain_tolerance" default="0.01"> - The minimum distance the target has to be from the tip of the final bone in the bone chain. Setting this value to a higher number allows for greater performance, but less accurate solves. - </member> - <member name="fabrik_data_chain_length" type="int" setter="set_fabrik_data_chain_length" getter="get_fabrik_data_chain_length" default="0"> - The amount of FABRIK joints in the FABRIK modification. - </member> - <member name="target_nodepath" type="NodePath" setter="set_target_node" getter="get_target_node" default="NodePath("")"> - The NodePath to the node that is the target for the FABRIK modification. This node is what the FABRIK chain will attempt to rotate the bone chain to. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DJiggle.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DJiggle.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 304f08bb20..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DJiggle.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,199 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3DJiggle" inherits="SkeletonModification3D" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A modification that jiggles bones as they move towards a target. - </brief_description> - <description> - This modification moves a series of bones, typically called a bone chain, towards a target. What makes this modification special is that it calculates the velocity and acceleration for each bone in the bone chain, and runs a very light physics-like calculation using the inputted values. This allows the bones to overshoot the target and "jiggle" around. It can be configured to act more like a spring, or sway around like cloth might. - This modification is useful for adding additional motion to things like hair, the edges of clothing, and more. It has several settings to that allow control over how the joint moves when the target moves. - [b]Note:[/b] The Jiggle modifier has [code]jiggle_joints[/code], which are the data objects that hold the data for each joint in the Jiggle chain. This is different from a bone! Jiggle joints hold the data needed for each bone in the bone chain used by the Jiggle modification. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="get_collision_mask" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the collision mask that the Jiggle modifier will take into account when performing physics calculations. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_bone_index" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the bone index of the bone assigned to the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_bone_name" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="String" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the name of the bone that is assigned to the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_damping" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the amount of dampening of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_gravity" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector3" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns a [Vector3] representign the amount of gravity the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx] is influenced by. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_mass" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the amount of mass of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_override" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns a boolean that indicates whether the joint at [param joint_idx] is overriding the default jiggle joint data defined in the modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_roll" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the amount of roll/twist applied to the bone that the Jiggle joint is applied to. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_stiffness" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the stiffness of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_jiggle_joint_use_gravity" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns a boolean that indicates whether the joint at [param joint_idx] is using gravity or not. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_use_colliders" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether the Jiggle modifier is taking physics colliders into account when solving. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_collision_mask"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="mask" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the collision mask that the Jiggle modifier takes into account when performing physics calculations. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_bone_index"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the bone index, [param bone_idx], of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_name[/code] of the Jiggle joint based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_bone_name"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="name" type="String" /> - <description> - Sets the bone name, [param name], of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_index[/code] of the Jiggle joint based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_damping"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="damping" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the amount of dampening of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_gravity"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="gravity" type="Vector3" /> - <description> - Sets the gravity vector of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_mass"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="mass" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the of mass of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_override"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="override" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx] should override the default Jiggle joint settings. Setting this to true will make the joint use its own settings rather than the default ones attached to the modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_roll"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="roll" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the amount of roll/twist on the bone the Jiggle joint is attached to. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_stiffness"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="stiffness" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the of stiffness of the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_jiggle_joint_use_gravity"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="joint_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="use_gravity" type="bool" /> - <description> - Sets whether the Jiggle joint at [param joint_idx] should use gravity. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_use_colliders"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="use_colliders" type="bool" /> - <description> - When [code]true[/code], the Jiggle modifier will use raycasting to prevent the Jiggle joints from rotating themselves into collision objects when solving. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="damping" type="float" setter="set_damping" getter="get_damping" default="0.75"> - The default amount of dampening applied to the Jiggle joints, if they are not overridden. Higher values lead to more of the calculated velocity being applied. - </member> - <member name="gravity" type="Vector3" setter="set_gravity" getter="get_gravity" default="Vector3(0, -6, 0)"> - The default amount of gravity applied to the Jiggle joints, if they are not overridden. - </member> - <member name="jiggle_data_chain_length" type="int" setter="set_jiggle_data_chain_length" getter="get_jiggle_data_chain_length" default="0"> - The amount of Jiggle joints in the Jiggle modification. - </member> - <member name="mass" type="float" setter="set_mass" getter="get_mass" default="0.75"> - The default amount of mass assigned to the Jiggle joints, if they are not overridden. Higher values lead to faster movements and more overshooting. - </member> - <member name="stiffness" type="float" setter="set_stiffness" getter="get_stiffness" default="3.0"> - The default amount of stiffness assigned to the Jiggle joints, if they are not overridden. Higher values act more like springs, quickly moving into the correct position. - </member> - <member name="target_nodepath" type="NodePath" setter="set_target_node" getter="get_target_node" default="NodePath("")"> - The NodePath to the node that is the target for the Jiggle modification. This node is what the Jiggle chain will attempt to rotate the bone chain to. - </member> - <member name="use_gravity" type="bool" setter="set_use_gravity" getter="get_use_gravity" default="false"> - Whether the gravity vector, [member gravity], should be applied to the Jiggle joints, assuming they are not overriding the default settings. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DLookAt.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DLookAt.xml deleted file mode 100644 index aeed953ca9..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DLookAt.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,64 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3DLookAt" inherits="SkeletonModification3D" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A modification that rotates a bone to look at a target. - </brief_description> - <description> - This [SkeletonModification3D] rotates a bone to look a target. This is extremely helpful for moving character's heads to look at the player, rotating a turret to look at a target, or any other case where you want to make a bone rotate towards something quickly and easily. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="get_additional_rotation" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector3" /> - <description> - Returns the amount of extra rotation that is applied to the bone after the LookAt modification executes. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_lock_rotation_plane" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the plane that the LookAt modification is limiting rotation to. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_lock_rotation_to_plane" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether the LookAt modification is limiting rotation to a single plane in 3D space. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_additional_rotation"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="additional_rotation" type="Vector3" /> - <description> - Sets the amount of extra rotation to be applied after the LookAt modification executes. This allows you to adjust the finished result. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_lock_rotation_plane"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="plane" type="int" /> - <description> - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_lock_rotation_to_plane"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="lock_to_plane" type="bool" /> - <description> - When [code]true[/code], the LookAt modification will limit its rotation to a single plane in 3D space. The plane used can be configured using the [code]set_lock_rotation_plane[/code] function. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="bone_index" type="int" setter="set_bone_index" getter="get_bone_index" default="-2"> - The bone index of the bone that should be operated on by this modification. - When possible, this will also update the [member bone_name] based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </member> - <member name="bone_name" type="String" setter="set_bone_name" getter="get_bone_name" default=""""> - The name of the bone that should be operated on by this modification. - When possible, this will also update the [member bone_index] based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </member> - <member name="target_nodepath" type="NodePath" setter="set_target_node" getter="get_target_node" default="NodePath("")"> - The NodePath to the node that is the target for the modification. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DStackHolder.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DStackHolder.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 9448e2c783..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DStackHolder.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,27 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3DStackHolder" inherits="SkeletonModification3D" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A modification that holds and executes a [SkeletonModificationStack3D]. - </brief_description> - <description> - This [SkeletonModification3D] holds a reference to a [SkeletonModificationStack3D], allowing you to use multiple modification stacks on a single [Skeleton3D]. - [b]Note:[/b] The modifications in the held [SkeletonModificationStack3D] will only be executed if their execution mode matches the execution mode of the SkeletonModification3DStackHolder. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="get_held_modification_stack" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="SkeletonModificationStack3D" /> - <description> - Returns the [SkeletonModificationStack3D] that this modification is holding. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_held_modification_stack"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="held_modification_stack" type="SkeletonModificationStack3D" /> - <description> - Sets the [SkeletonModificationStack3D] that this modification is holding. This modification stack will then be executed when this modification is executed. - </description> - </method> - </methods> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DTwoBoneIK.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DTwoBoneIK.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 0e7ffd5c80..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModification3DTwoBoneIK.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,191 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModification3DTwoBoneIK" inherits="SkeletonModification3D" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A modification that moves two bones to reach the target. - </brief_description> - <description> - This [SkeletonModification3D] uses an algorithm typically called TwoBoneIK. This algorithm works by leveraging the law of cosigns and the lengths of the bones to figure out what rotation the bones currently have, and what rotation they need to make a complete triangle, where the first bone, the second bone, and the target form the three vertices of the triangle. Because the algorithm works by making a triangle, it can only operate on two bones. - TwoBoneIK is great for arms, legs, and really any joints that can be represented by just two bones that bend to reach a target. This solver is more lightweight than [SkeletonModification3DFABRIK], but gives similar, natural looking results. - A [Node3D]-based node can be used to define the pole, or bend direction, allowing control over which direction the joint takes when bending to reach the target when the target is within reach. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="get_auto_calculate_joint_length" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether the TwoBoneIK modification will attempt to autocalculate the lengths of the two bones. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_one_bone_idx" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the bone index of the first bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_one_bone_name" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="String" /> - <description> - Returns the name of the first bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_one_length" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <description> - Returns the length of the first bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_one_roll" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <description> - Returns the amount of roll/twist applied to the first bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_two_bone_idx" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the bone index of the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_two_bone_name" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="String" /> - <description> - Returns the name of the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_two_length" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <description> - Returns the length of the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_joint_two_roll" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <description> - Returns the amount of roll/twist applied to the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_pole_node" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="NodePath" /> - <description> - Returns the node that is being used as the pole node for the TwoBoneIK modification, if a pole node has been set. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_tip_node" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="NodePath" /> - <description> - Returns the node that is being used to calculate the tip position of the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification, if a tip node has been set. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_use_pole_node" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether the TwoBoneIK modification will attempt to use the pole node to figure out which direction to bend, if a pole node has been set. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_use_tip_node" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns whether the TwoBoneIK modification will attempt to use the tip node to figure out the length and position of the tip of the second bone. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_auto_calculate_joint_length"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="auto_calculate_joint_length" type="bool" /> - <description> - If true, the TwoBoneIK modification will attempt to autocalculate the lengths of the bones being used. The first bone will be calculated by using the distance from the origin of the first bone to the origin of the second bone. - The second bone will be calculated either using the tip node if that setting is enabled, or by using the distances of the second bone's children. If the tip node is not enabled and the bone has no children, then the length cannot be autocalculated. In this case, the length will either have to be manually inputted or a tip node used to calculate the length. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_one_bone_idx"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the bone index, [param bone_idx], of the first bone. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_name[/code] of the first bone based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_one_bone_name"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_name" type="String" /> - <description> - Sets the bone name, [param bone_name], of the first bone. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_index[/code] of the first bone based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_one_length"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_length" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the length of the first bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_one_roll"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="roll" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the amount of roll/twist applied to the first bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_two_bone_idx"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Sets the bone index, [param bone_idx], of the second bone. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_name[/code] of the second bone based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_two_bone_name"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_name" type="String" /> - <description> - Sets the bone name, [param bone_name], of the second bone. When possible, this will also update the [code]bone_index[/code] of the second bone based on data provided by the [Skeleton3D]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_two_length"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="bone_length" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the length of the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_joint_two_roll"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="roll" type="float" /> - <description> - Sets the amount of roll/twist applied to the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_pole_node"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="pole_nodepath" type="NodePath" /> - <description> - Sets the node to be used as the for the pole of the TwoBoneIK. When a node is set and the modification is set to use the pole node, the TwoBoneIK modification will bend the nodes in the direction towards this node when the bones need to bend. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_tip_node"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="tip_nodepath" type="NodePath" /> - <description> - Sets the node to be used as the tip for the second bone. This is used to calculate the length and position of the end of the second bone in the TwoBoneIK modification. - [b]Note:[/b] The tip node should generally be a child node of a [BoneAttachment3D] node attached to the second bone, with the child node being offset so it is at the end of the bone. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_use_pole_node"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="use_pole_node" type="bool" /> - <description> - When [code]true[/code], the TwoBoneIK modification will bend the bones towards the pole node, if one has been set. This gives control over the direction the TwoBoneIK solver will bend, which is helpful for joints like elbows that only bend in certain directions. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_use_tip_node"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="use_tip_node" type="bool" /> - <description> - When [code]true[/code], the TwoBoneIK modification will use the tip node to calculate the distance and position of the end/tip of the second bone. This is the most stable solution for knowing the tip position and length of the second bone. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="target_nodepath" type="NodePath" setter="set_target_node" getter="get_target_node" default="NodePath("")"> - The NodePath to the node that is the target for the TwoBoneIK modification. This node is what the modification will attempt to rotate the bones to reach. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonModificationStack3D.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonModificationStack3D.xml deleted file mode 100644 index 9eaeeefd8e..0000000000 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonModificationStack3D.xml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,88 +0,0 @@ -<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> -<class name="SkeletonModificationStack3D" inherits="Resource" is_deprecated="true" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> - <brief_description> - A resource that holds a stack of [SkeletonModification3D]s. - </brief_description> - <description> - This resource is used by the Skeleton and holds a stack of [SkeletonModification3D]s. The SkeletonModificationStack3D controls the order of the modifications, which controls how they are applied. Modification order is especially important for full-body IK setups, as you need to execute the modifications in the correct order to get the desired results. For example, you want to execute a modification on the spine [i]before[/i] the arms on a humanoid skeleton. - Additionally, the SkeletonModificationStack3D also controls how strongly the modifications are applied to the [Skeleton3D] node. - </description> - <tutorials> - </tutorials> - <methods> - <method name="add_modification"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="modification" type="SkeletonModification3D" /> - <description> - Adds the passed-in [SkeletonModification3D] to the stack. - </description> - </method> - <method name="delete_modification"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="mod_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Deletes the [SkeletonModification3D] at the index position [param mod_idx], if it exists. - </description> - </method> - <method name="enable_all_modifications"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="enabled" type="bool" /> - <description> - Enables all [SkeletonModification3D]s in the stack. - </description> - </method> - <method name="execute"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="delta" type="float" /> - <param index="1" name="execution_mode" type="int" /> - <description> - Executes all of the [SkeletonModification3D]s in the stack that use the same execution mode as the passed-in [param execution_mode], starting from index [code]0[/code] to [member modification_count]. - [b]Note:[/b] The order of the modifications can matter depending on the modifications. For example, modifications on a spine should operate before modifications on the arms in order to get proper results. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_is_setup" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="bool" /> - <description> - Returns a boolean that indicates whether the modification stack is setup and can execute. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_modification" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="SkeletonModification3D" /> - <param index="0" name="mod_idx" type="int" /> - <description> - Returns the [SkeletonModification3D] at the passed-in index, [param mod_idx]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="get_skeleton" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Skeleton3D" /> - <description> - Returns the [Skeleton3D] node that the SkeletonModificationStack3D is bound to. - </description> - </method> - <method name="set_modification"> - <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="mod_idx" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="modification" type="SkeletonModification3D" /> - <description> - Sets the modification at [param mod_idx] to the passed-in modification, [param modification]. - </description> - </method> - <method name="setup"> - <return type="void" /> - <description> - Sets up the modification stack so it can execute. This function should be called by [Skeleton3D] and shouldn't be called unless you know what you are doing. - </description> - </method> - </methods> - <members> - <member name="enabled" type="bool" setter="set_enabled" getter="get_enabled" default="false"> - When true, the modification's in the stack will be called. This is handled automatically through the [Skeleton3D] node. - </member> - <member name="modification_count" type="int" setter="set_modification_count" getter="get_modification_count" default="0"> - The number of modifications in the stack. - </member> - <member name="strength" type="float" setter="set_strength" getter="get_strength" default="1.0"> - The interpolation strength of the modifications in stack. A value of [code]0[/code] will make it where the modifications are not applied, a strength of [code]0.5[/code] will be half applied, and a strength of [code]1[/code] will allow the modifications to be fully applied and override the skeleton bone poses. - </member> - </members> -</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonProfile.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonProfile.xml index 57bdd52d9e..6fb311bcee 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonProfile.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SkeletonProfile.xml @@ -5,6 +5,7 @@ </brief_description> <description> This resource is used in [EditorScenePostImport]. Some parameters are referring to bones in [Skeleton3D], [Skin], [Animation], and some other nodes are rewritten based on the parameters of [SkeletonProfile]. + [b]Note:[/b] These parameters need to be set only when creating a custom profile. In [SkeletonProfileHumanoid], they are defined internally as read-only values. </description> <tutorials> <link title="Retargeting 3D Skeletons">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/assets_pipeline/retargeting_3d_skeletons.html</link> @@ -160,16 +161,18 @@ </methods> <members> <member name="bone_size" type="int" setter="set_bone_size" getter="get_bone_size" default="0"> + The amount of bones in retargeting section's [BoneMap] editor. For example, [SkeletonProfileHumanoid] has 56 bones. + The size of elements in [BoneMap] updates when changing this property in it's assigned [SkeletonProfile]. </member> <member name="group_size" type="int" setter="set_group_size" getter="get_group_size" default="0"> + The amount of groups of bones in retargeting section's [BoneMap] editor. For example, [SkeletonProfileHumanoid] has 4 groups. + This property exists to separate the bone list into several sections in the editor. </member> <member name="root_bone" type="StringName" setter="set_root_bone" getter="get_root_bone" default="&"""> - A name of bone that will be used as the root bone in [AnimationTree]. - [b]Note:[/b] In most cases, it is the bone of the parent of the hips that exists at the world origin in the humanoid model. + A bone name that will be used as the root bone in [AnimationTree]. This should be the bone of the parent of hips that exists at the world origin. </member> <member name="scale_base_bone" type="StringName" setter="set_scale_base_bone" getter="get_scale_base_bone" default="&"""> - A name of bone which height will be used as the coefficient for normalization. - [b]Note:[/b] In most cases, it is hips in the humanoid model. + A bone name which will use model's height as the coefficient for normalization. For example, [SkeletonProfileHumanoid] defines it as [code]Hips[/code]. </member> </members> <signals> diff --git a/doc/classes/SkeletonProfileHumanoid.xml b/doc/classes/SkeletonProfileHumanoid.xml index 0dbd66d8d6..7445272ccc 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SkeletonProfileHumanoid.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SkeletonProfileHumanoid.xml @@ -1,6 +1,7 @@ <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> <class name="SkeletonProfileHumanoid" inherits="SkeletonProfile" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> <brief_description> + A humanoid [SkeletonProfile] preset. </brief_description> <description> A [SkeletonProfile] as a preset that is optimized for the human form. This exists for standardization, so all parameters are read-only. diff --git a/doc/classes/Sprite2D.xml b/doc/classes/Sprite2D.xml index 235fef0bdd..033dbf51f3 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Sprite2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Sprite2D.xml @@ -23,11 +23,11 @@ print("A click!") [/gdscript] [csharp] - public override void _Input(InputEvent inputEvent) + public override void _Input(InputEvent @event) { - if (inputEvent is InputEventMouseButton inputEventMouse) + if (@event is InputEventMouseButton inputEventMouse) { - if (inputEventMouse.Pressed && inputEventMouse.ButtonIndex == (int)ButtonList.Left) + if (inputEventMouse.Pressed && inputEventMouse.ButtonIndex == MouseButton.Left) { if (GetRect().HasPoint(ToLocal(inputEventMouse.Position))) { diff --git a/doc/classes/SpriteBase3D.xml b/doc/classes/SpriteBase3D.xml index 5fa984e7a0..e1f3a52a1d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SpriteBase3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SpriteBase3D.xml @@ -38,9 +38,21 @@ </method> </methods> <members> + <member name="alpha_antialiasing_edge" type="float" setter="set_alpha_antialiasing_edge" getter="get_alpha_antialiasing_edge" default="0.0"> + Threshold at which antialiasing will be applied on the alpha channel. + </member> + <member name="alpha_antialiasing_mode" type="int" setter="set_alpha_antialiasing" getter="get_alpha_antialiasing" enum="BaseMaterial3D.AlphaAntiAliasing" default="0"> + The type of alpha antialiasing to apply. See [enum BaseMaterial3D.AlphaAntiAliasing]. + </member> <member name="alpha_cut" type="int" setter="set_alpha_cut_mode" getter="get_alpha_cut_mode" enum="SpriteBase3D.AlphaCutMode" default="0"> The alpha cutting mode to use for the sprite. See [enum AlphaCutMode] for possible values. </member> + <member name="alpha_hash_scale" type="float" setter="set_alpha_hash_scale" getter="get_alpha_hash_scale" default="1.0"> + The hashing scale for Alpha Hash. Recommended values between [code]0[/code] and [code]2[/code]. + </member> + <member name="alpha_scissor_threshold" type="float" setter="set_alpha_scissor_threshold" getter="get_alpha_scissor_threshold" default="0.5"> + Threshold at which the alpha scissor will discard values. + </member> <member name="axis" type="int" setter="set_axis" getter="get_axis" enum="Vector3.Axis" default="2"> The direction in which the front of the texture faces. </member> @@ -118,5 +130,8 @@ <constant name="ALPHA_CUT_OPAQUE_PREPASS" value="2" enum="AlphaCutMode"> This mode draws fully opaque pixels in the depth prepass. This is slower than [constant ALPHA_CUT_DISABLED] or [constant ALPHA_CUT_DISCARD], but it allows displaying translucent areas and smooth edges while using proper sorting. </constant> + <constant name="ALPHA_CUT_HASH" value="3" enum="AlphaCutMode"> + This mode draws cuts off all values below a spatially-deterministic threshold, the rest will remain opaque. + </constant> </constants> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/SpriteFrames.xml b/doc/classes/SpriteFrames.xml index 87b823bd2a..195f3598d5 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SpriteFrames.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SpriteFrames.xml @@ -5,7 +5,6 @@ </brief_description> <description> Sprite frame library for an [AnimatedSprite2D] or [AnimatedSprite3D] node. Contains frames and animation data for playback. - [b]Note:[/b] You can associate a set of normal or specular maps by creating additional [SpriteFrames] resources with a [code]_normal[/code] or [code]_specular[/code] suffix. For example, having 3 [SpriteFrames] resources [code]run[/code], [code]run_normal[/code], and [code]run_specular[/code] will make it so the [code]run[/code] animation uses normal and specular maps. </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> @@ -14,7 +13,7 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <description> - Adds a new animation to the library. + Adds a new [param anim] animation to the library. </description> </method> <method name="add_frame"> @@ -24,20 +23,20 @@ <param index="2" name="duration" type="float" default="1.0" /> <param index="3" name="at_position" type="int" default="-1" /> <description> - Adds a frame to the given animation. + Adds a frame to the [param anim] animation. If [param at_position] is [code]-1[/code], the frame will be added to the end of the animation. </description> </method> <method name="clear"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <description> - Removes all frames from the given animation. + Removes all frames from the [param anim] animation. </description> </method> <method name="clear_all"> <return type="void" /> <description> - Removes all animations. A "default" animation will be created. + Removes all animations. An empty [code]default[/code] animation will be created. </description> </method> <method name="get_animation_loop" qualifiers="const"> @@ -91,14 +90,14 @@ <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <description> - If [code]true[/code], the named animation exists. + Returns [code]true[/code] if the [param anim] animation exists. </description> </method> <method name="remove_animation"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <description> - Removes the given animation. + Removes the [param anim] animation. </description> </method> <method name="remove_frame"> @@ -106,7 +105,7 @@ <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <param index="1" name="idx" type="int" /> <description> - Removes the animation's selected frame. + Removes the [param anim] animation's frame [param idx]. </description> </method> <method name="rename_animation"> @@ -114,7 +113,7 @@ <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <param index="1" name="newname" type="StringName" /> <description> - Changes the animation's name to [param newname]. + Changes the [param anim] animation's name to [param newname]. </description> </method> <method name="set_animation_loop"> @@ -122,7 +121,7 @@ <param index="0" name="anim" type="StringName" /> <param index="1" name="loop" type="bool" /> <description> - If [code]true[/code], the animation will loop. + If [param loop] is [code]true[/code], the [param anim] animation will loop when it reaches the end, or the start if it is played in reverse. </description> </method> <method name="set_animation_speed"> @@ -140,7 +139,7 @@ <param index="2" name="texture" type="Texture2D" /> <param index="3" name="duration" type="float" default="1.0" /> <description> - Sets the texture and the duration of the frame [param idx] in the [param anim] animation. + Sets the [param texture] and the [param duration] of the frame [param idx] in the [param anim] animation. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/StaticBody3D.xml b/doc/classes/StaticBody3D.xml index 0beaa6bb52..7bebd46004 100644 --- a/doc/classes/StaticBody3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/StaticBody3D.xml @@ -7,8 +7,9 @@ Static body for 3D physics. A static body is a simple body that doesn't move under physics simulation, i.e. it can't be moved by external forces or contacts but its transformation can still be updated manually by the user. It is ideal for implementing objects in the environment, such as walls or platforms. In contrast to [RigidBody3D], it doesn't consume any CPU resources as long as they don't move. They have extra functionalities to move and affect other bodies: - [b]Static transform change:[/b] Static bodies can be moved by animation or script. In this case, they are just teleported and don't affect other bodies on their path. - [b]Constant velocity:[/b] When [member constant_linear_velocity] or [member constant_angular_velocity] is set, static bodies don't move themselves but affect touching bodies as if they were moving. This is useful for simulating conveyor belts or conveyor wheels. + [i]Static transform change:[/i] Static bodies can be moved by animation or script. In this case, they are just teleported and don't affect other bodies on their path. + [i]Constant velocity:[/i] When [member constant_linear_velocity] or [member constant_angular_velocity] is set, static bodies don't move themselves but affect touching bodies as if they were moving. This is useful for simulating conveyor belts or conveyor wheels. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="3D Physics Tests Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/675</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/StreamPeer.xml b/doc/classes/StreamPeer.xml index f05b5f7dbf..969cbac57d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/StreamPeer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/StreamPeer.xml @@ -223,7 +223,7 @@ put_data("Hello world".to_utf8()) [/gdscript] [csharp] - PutData("Hello World".ToUTF8()); + PutData("Hello World".ToUtf8()); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> diff --git a/doc/classes/StreamPeerTLS.xml b/doc/classes/StreamPeerTLS.xml index d1ddb3d441..9e16dc8914 100644 --- a/doc/classes/StreamPeerTLS.xml +++ b/doc/classes/StreamPeerTLS.xml @@ -14,22 +14,18 @@ <method name="accept_stream"> <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="stream" type="StreamPeer" /> - <param index="1" name="private_key" type="CryptoKey" /> - <param index="2" name="certificate" type="X509Certificate" /> - <param index="3" name="chain" type="X509Certificate" default="null" /> + <param index="1" name="server_options" type="TLSOptions" /> <description> - Accepts a peer connection as a server using the given [param private_key] and providing the given [param certificate] to the client. You can pass the optional [param chain] parameter to provide additional CA chain information along with the certificate. + Accepts a peer connection as a server using the given [param server_options]. See [method TLSOptions.server]. </description> </method> <method name="connect_to_stream"> <return type="int" enum="Error" /> <param index="0" name="stream" type="StreamPeer" /> - <param index="1" name="validate_certs" type="bool" default="false" /> - <param index="2" name="for_hostname" type="String" default="""" /> - <param index="3" name="valid_certificate" type="X509Certificate" default="null" /> + <param index="1" name="common_name" type="String" /> + <param index="2" name="client_options" type="TLSOptions" default="null" /> <description> - Connects to a peer using an underlying [StreamPeer] [param stream]. If [param validate_certs] is [code]true[/code], [StreamPeerTLS] will validate that the certificate presented by the peer matches the [param for_hostname]. - [b]Note:[/b] Specifying a custom [param valid_certificate] is not supported in Web exports due to browsers restrictions. + Connects to a peer using an underlying [StreamPeer] [param stream] and verifying the remote certificate is correctly signed for the given [param common_name]. You can pass the optional [param client_options] parameter to customize the trusted certification authorities, or disable the common name verification. See [method TLSOptions.client] and [method TLSOptions.client_unsafe]. </description> </method> <method name="disconnect_from_stream"> @@ -57,10 +53,6 @@ </description> </method> </methods> - <members> - <member name="blocking_handshake" type="bool" setter="set_blocking_handshake_enabled" getter="is_blocking_handshake_enabled" default="true"> - </member> - </members> <constants> <constant name="STATUS_DISCONNECTED" value="0" enum="Status"> A status representing a [StreamPeerTLS] that is disconnected. diff --git a/doc/classes/String.xml b/doc/classes/String.xml index 97466e7860..143e1f23e9 100644 --- a/doc/classes/String.xml +++ b/doc/classes/String.xml @@ -1002,10 +1002,16 @@ [/codeblocks] </description> </method> + <method name="validate_filename" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="String" /> + <description> + Returns a copy of the string with all characters that are not allowed in [method is_valid_filename] replaced with underscores. + </description> + </method> <method name="validate_node_name" qualifiers="const"> <return type="String" /> <description> - Removes all characters that are not allowed in [member Node.name] from the string ([code].[/code] [code]:[/code] [code]@[/code] [code]/[/code] [code]"[/code] [code]%[/code]). + Returns a copy of the string with all characters that are not allowed in [member Node.name] removed ([code].[/code] [code]:[/code] [code]@[/code] [code]/[/code] [code]"[/code] [code]%[/code]). </description> </method> <method name="xml_escape" qualifiers="const"> diff --git a/doc/classes/StringName.xml b/doc/classes/StringName.xml index b46e39b8d7..c103fb2287 100644 --- a/doc/classes/StringName.xml +++ b/doc/classes/StringName.xml @@ -909,10 +909,16 @@ [/codeblocks] </description> </method> + <method name="validate_filename" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="String" /> + <description> + Returns a copy of the string with all characters that are not allowed in [method is_valid_filename] replaced with underscores. + </description> + </method> <method name="validate_node_name" qualifiers="const"> <return type="String" /> <description> - Removes all characters that are not allowed in [member Node.name] from the string ([code].[/code] [code]:[/code] [code]@[/code] [code]/[/code] [code]"[/code] [code]%[/code]). + Returns a copy of the string with all characters that are not allowed in [member Node.name] removed ([code].[/code] [code]:[/code] [code]@[/code] [code]/[/code] [code]"[/code] [code]%[/code]). </description> </method> <method name="xml_escape" qualifiers="const"> diff --git a/doc/classes/StyleBox.xml b/doc/classes/StyleBox.xml index ff6d4d8821..4a63f4488c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/StyleBox.xml +++ b/doc/classes/StyleBox.xml @@ -17,21 +17,16 @@ <description> </description> </method> - <method name="_get_center_size" qualifiers="virtual const"> - <return type="Vector2" /> - <description> - </description> - </method> <method name="_get_draw_rect" qualifiers="virtual const"> <return type="Rect2" /> <param index="0" name="rect" type="Rect2" /> <description> </description> </method> - <method name="_get_style_margin" qualifiers="virtual const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="side" type="int" enum="Side" /> + <method name="_get_minimum_size" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="Vector2" /> <description> + Virtual method to be implemented by the user. Returns a custom minimum size that the stylebox must respect when drawing. By default [method get_minimum_size] only takes content margins into account. This method can be overridden to add another size restriction. A combination of the default behavior and the output of this method will be used, to account for both sizes. </description> </method> <method name="_test_mask" qualifiers="virtual const"> @@ -50,10 +45,11 @@ The [RID] value can either be the result of [method CanvasItem.get_canvas_item] called on an existing [CanvasItem]-derived node, or directly from creating a canvas item in the [RenderingServer] with [method RenderingServer.canvas_item_create]. </description> </method> - <method name="get_center_size" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector2" /> + <method name="get_content_margin" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="float" /> + <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> <description> - Returns the size of this [StyleBox] without the margins. + Returns the default margin of the specified [enum Side]. </description> </method> <method name="get_current_item_drawn" qualifiers="const"> @@ -62,13 +58,6 @@ Returns the [CanvasItem] that handles its [constant CanvasItem.NOTIFICATION_DRAW] or [method CanvasItem._draw] callback at this moment. </description> </method> - <method name="get_default_margin" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> - <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> - <description> - Returns the default margin of the specified [enum Side]. - </description> - </method> <method name="get_margin" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> @@ -89,7 +78,7 @@ Returns the "offset" of a stylebox. This helper function returns a value equivalent to [code]Vector2(style.get_margin(MARGIN_LEFT), style.get_margin(MARGIN_TOP))[/code]. </description> </method> - <method name="set_default_margin"> + <method name="set_content_margin"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> <param index="1" name="offset" type="float" /> @@ -97,7 +86,7 @@ Sets the default value of the specified [enum Side] to [param offset] pixels. </description> </method> - <method name="set_default_margin_all"> + <method name="set_content_margin_all"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="offset" type="float" /> <description> @@ -114,21 +103,21 @@ </method> </methods> <members> - <member name="content_margin_bottom" type="float" setter="set_default_margin" getter="get_default_margin" default="-1.0"> + <member name="content_margin_bottom" type="float" setter="set_content_margin" getter="get_content_margin" default="-1.0"> The bottom margin for the contents of this style box. Increasing this value reduces the space available to the contents from the bottom. If this value is negative, it is ignored and a child-specific margin is used instead. For example for [StyleBoxFlat] the border thickness (if any) is used instead. It is up to the code using this style box to decide what these contents are: for example, a [Button] respects this content margin for the textual contents of the button. [method get_margin] should be used to fetch this value as consumer instead of reading these properties directly. This is because it correctly respects negative values and the fallback mentioned above. </member> - <member name="content_margin_left" type="float" setter="set_default_margin" getter="get_default_margin" default="-1.0"> + <member name="content_margin_left" type="float" setter="set_content_margin" getter="get_content_margin" default="-1.0"> The left margin for the contents of this style box. Increasing this value reduces the space available to the contents from the left. Refer to [member content_margin_bottom] for extra considerations. </member> - <member name="content_margin_right" type="float" setter="set_default_margin" getter="get_default_margin" default="-1.0"> + <member name="content_margin_right" type="float" setter="set_content_margin" getter="get_content_margin" default="-1.0"> The right margin for the contents of this style box. Increasing this value reduces the space available to the contents from the right. Refer to [member content_margin_bottom] for extra considerations. </member> - <member name="content_margin_top" type="float" setter="set_default_margin" getter="get_default_margin" default="-1.0"> + <member name="content_margin_top" type="float" setter="set_content_margin" getter="get_content_margin" default="-1.0"> The top margin for the contents of this style box. Increasing this value reduces the space available to the contents from the top. Refer to [member content_margin_bottom] for extra considerations. </member> diff --git a/doc/classes/StyleBoxTexture.xml b/doc/classes/StyleBoxTexture.xml index aeba777b43..f2f6e59a9e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/StyleBoxTexture.xml +++ b/doc/classes/StyleBoxTexture.xml @@ -9,36 +9,36 @@ <tutorials> </tutorials> <methods> - <method name="get_expand_margin_size" qualifiers="const"> + <method name="get_expand_margin" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> <description> Returns the expand margin size of the specified [enum Side]. </description> </method> - <method name="get_margin_size" qualifiers="const"> + <method name="get_texture_margin" qualifiers="const"> <return type="float" /> <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> <description> Returns the margin size of the specified [enum Side]. </description> </method> - <method name="set_expand_margin_all"> + <method name="set_expand_margin"> <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="size" type="float" /> + <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> + <param index="1" name="size" type="float" /> <description> - Sets the expand margin to [param size] pixels for all margins. + Sets the expand margin to [param size] pixels for the specified [enum Side]. </description> </method> - <method name="set_expand_margin_size"> + <method name="set_expand_margin_all"> <return type="void" /> - <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> - <param index="1" name="size" type="float" /> + <param index="0" name="size" type="float" /> <description> - Sets the expand margin to [param size] pixels for the specified [enum Side]. + Sets the expand margin to [param size] pixels for all margins. </description> </method> - <method name="set_margin_size"> + <method name="set_texture_margin"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="margin" type="int" enum="Side" /> <param index="1" name="size" type="float" /> @@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ Sets the margin to [param size] pixels for the specified [enum Side]. </description> </method> - <method name="set_margin_size_all"> + <method name="set_texture_margin_all"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="size" type="float" /> <description> @@ -64,48 +64,49 @@ <member name="draw_center" type="bool" setter="set_draw_center" getter="is_draw_center_enabled" default="true"> If [code]true[/code], the nine-patch texture's center tile will be drawn. </member> - <member name="expand_margin_bottom" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin_size" getter="get_expand_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="expand_margin_bottom" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin" getter="get_expand_margin" default="0.0"> Expands the bottom margin of this style box when drawing, causing it to be drawn larger than requested. </member> - <member name="expand_margin_left" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin_size" getter="get_expand_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="expand_margin_left" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin" getter="get_expand_margin" default="0.0"> Expands the left margin of this style box when drawing, causing it to be drawn larger than requested. </member> - <member name="expand_margin_right" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin_size" getter="get_expand_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="expand_margin_right" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin" getter="get_expand_margin" default="0.0"> Expands the right margin of this style box when drawing, causing it to be drawn larger than requested. </member> - <member name="expand_margin_top" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin_size" getter="get_expand_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="expand_margin_top" type="float" setter="set_expand_margin" getter="get_expand_margin" default="0.0"> Expands the top margin of this style box when drawing, causing it to be drawn larger than requested. </member> - <member name="margin_bottom" type="float" setter="set_margin_size" getter="get_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="modulate_color" type="Color" setter="set_modulate" getter="get_modulate" default="Color(1, 1, 1, 1)"> + Modulates the color of the texture when this style box is drawn. + </member> + <member name="region_rect" type="Rect2" setter="set_region_rect" getter="get_region_rect" default="Rect2(0, 0, 0, 0)"> + Species a sub-region of the texture to use. + This is equivalent to first wrapping the texture in an [AtlasTexture] with the same region. + If empty ([code]Rect2(0, 0, 0, 0)[/code]), the whole texture will be used. + </member> + <member name="texture" type="Texture2D" setter="set_texture" getter="get_texture"> + The texture to use when drawing this style box. + </member> + <member name="texture_margin_bottom" type="float" setter="set_texture_margin" getter="get_texture_margin" default="0.0"> Increases the bottom margin of the 3×3 texture box. A higher value means more of the source texture is considered to be part of the bottom border of the 3×3 box. This is also the value used as fallback for [member StyleBox.content_margin_bottom] if it is negative. </member> - <member name="margin_left" type="float" setter="set_margin_size" getter="get_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="texture_margin_left" type="float" setter="set_texture_margin" getter="get_texture_margin" default="0.0"> Increases the left margin of the 3×3 texture box. A higher value means more of the source texture is considered to be part of the left border of the 3×3 box. This is also the value used as fallback for [member StyleBox.content_margin_left] if it is negative. </member> - <member name="margin_right" type="float" setter="set_margin_size" getter="get_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="texture_margin_right" type="float" setter="set_texture_margin" getter="get_texture_margin" default="0.0"> Increases the right margin of the 3×3 texture box. A higher value means more of the source texture is considered to be part of the right border of the 3×3 box. This is also the value used as fallback for [member StyleBox.content_margin_right] if it is negative. </member> - <member name="margin_top" type="float" setter="set_margin_size" getter="get_margin_size" default="0.0"> + <member name="texture_margin_top" type="float" setter="set_texture_margin" getter="get_texture_margin" default="0.0"> Increases the top margin of the 3×3 texture box. A higher value means more of the source texture is considered to be part of the top border of the 3×3 box. This is also the value used as fallback for [member StyleBox.content_margin_top] if it is negative. </member> - <member name="modulate_color" type="Color" setter="set_modulate" getter="get_modulate" default="Color(1, 1, 1, 1)"> - Modulates the color of the texture when this style box is drawn. - </member> - <member name="region_rect" type="Rect2" setter="set_region_rect" getter="get_region_rect" default="Rect2(0, 0, 0, 0)"> - Species a sub-region of the texture to use. - This is equivalent to first wrapping the texture in an [AtlasTexture] with the same region. - </member> - <member name="texture" type="Texture2D" setter="set_texture" getter="get_texture"> - The texture to use when drawing this style box. - </member> </members> <constants> <constant name="AXIS_STRETCH_MODE_STRETCH" value="0" enum="AxisStretchMode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/SubViewport.xml b/doc/classes/SubViewport.xml index 7020cae1de..bb76a82ef3 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SubViewport.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SubViewport.xml @@ -26,6 +26,7 @@ </member> <member name="size" type="Vector2i" setter="set_size" getter="get_size" default="Vector2i(512, 512)"> The width and height of the sub-viewport. Must be set to a value greater than or equal to 2 pixels on both dimensions. Otherwise, nothing will be displayed. + [b]Note:[/b] If the parent node is a [SubViewportContainer] and its [member SubViewportContainer.stretch] is [code]true[/code], the viewport size cannot be changed manually. </member> <member name="size_2d_override" type="Vector2i" setter="set_size_2d_override" getter="get_size_2d_override" default="Vector2i(0, 0)"> The 2D size override of the sub-viewport. If either the width or height is [code]0[/code], the override is disabled. diff --git a/doc/classes/SubViewportContainer.xml b/doc/classes/SubViewportContainer.xml index 77aa7e3ff4..11137222a9 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SubViewportContainer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SubViewportContainer.xml @@ -13,6 +13,7 @@ <members> <member name="stretch" type="bool" setter="set_stretch" getter="is_stretch_enabled" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], the sub-viewport will be automatically resized to the control's size. + [b]Note:[/b] If [code]true[/code], this will prohibit changing [member SubViewport.size] of its children manually. </member> <member name="stretch_shrink" type="int" setter="set_stretch_shrink" getter="get_stretch_shrink" default="1"> Divides the sub-viewport's effective resolution by this value while preserving its scale. This can be used to speed up rendering. diff --git a/doc/classes/SurfaceTool.xml b/doc/classes/SurfaceTool.xml index 9d73e9fb39..5b567dbc28 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SurfaceTool.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SurfaceTool.xml @@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ <description> Generates normals from vertices so you do not have to do it manually. If [param flip] is [code]true[/code], the resulting normals will be inverted. [method generate_normals] should be called [i]after[/i] generating geometry and [i]before[/i] committing the mesh using [method commit] or [method commit_to_arrays]. For correct display of normal-mapped surfaces, you will also have to generate tangents using [method generate_tangents]. [b]Note:[/b] [method generate_normals] only works if the primitive type to be set to [constant Mesh.PRIMITIVE_TRIANGLES]. - [b]Note:[/b] [method generate_normals] takes smooth groups into account. If you don't specify any smooth group for each vertex, [method generate_normals] will smooth normals for you. + [b]Note:[/b] [method generate_normals] takes smooth groups into account. To generate smooth normals, set the smooth group to a value greater than or equal to [code]0[/code] using [method set_smooth_group] or leave the smooth group at the default of [code]0[/code]. To generate flat normals, set the smooth group to [code]-1[/code] using [method set_smooth_group] prior to adding vertices. </description> </method> <method name="generate_tangents"> @@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="index" type="int" /> <description> - Specifies whether the current vertex (if using only vertex arrays) or current index (if also using index arrays) should use smooth normals for normal calculation. + Specifies the smooth group to use for the [i]next[/i] vertex. If this is never called, all vertices will have the default smooth group of [code]0[/code] and will be smoothed with adjacent vertices of the same group. To produce a mesh with flat normals, set the smooth group to [code]-1[/code]. </description> </method> <method name="set_tangent"> diff --git a/doc/classes/SystemFont.xml b/doc/classes/SystemFont.xml index 20bfd0d8ae..5e7b79ae97 100644 --- a/doc/classes/SystemFont.xml +++ b/doc/classes/SystemFont.xml @@ -43,6 +43,12 @@ <member name="hinting" type="int" setter="set_hinting" getter="get_hinting" enum="TextServer.Hinting" default="1"> Font hinting mode. </member> + <member name="msdf_pixel_range" type="int" setter="set_msdf_pixel_range" getter="get_msdf_pixel_range" default="16"> + The width of the range around the shape between the minimum and maximum representable signed distance. If using font outlines, [member msdf_pixel_range] must be set to at least [i]twice[/i] the size of the largest font outline. The default [member msdf_pixel_range] value of [code]16[/code] allows outline sizes up to [code]8[/code] to look correct. + </member> + <member name="msdf_size" type="int" setter="set_msdf_size" getter="get_msdf_size" default="48"> + Source font size used to generate MSDF textures. Higher values allow for more precision, but are slower to render and require more memory. Only increase this value if you notice a visible lack of precision in glyph rendering. + </member> <member name="multichannel_signed_distance_field" type="bool" setter="set_multichannel_signed_distance_field" getter="is_multichannel_signed_distance_field" default="false"> If set to [code]true[/code], glyphs of all sizes are rendered using single multichannel signed distance field generated from the dynamic font vector data. </member> diff --git a/doc/classes/TLSOptions.xml b/doc/classes/TLSOptions.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0917bd9bce --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/classes/TLSOptions.xml @@ -0,0 +1,53 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> +<class name="TLSOptions" inherits="RefCounted" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> + <brief_description> + TLS configuration for clients and servers. + </brief_description> + <description> + TLSOptions abstracts the configuration options for the [StreamPeerTLS] and [PacketPeerDTLS] classes. + Objects of this class cannot be instantiated directly, and one of the static methods [method client], [method client_unsafe], or [method server] should be used instead. + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + # Create a TLS client configuration which uses our custom trusted CA chain. + var client_trusted_cas = load("res://my_trusted_cas.crt") + var client_tls_options = TLSOptions.client(client_trusted_cas) + + # Create a TLS server configuration. + var server_certs = load("res://my_server_cas.crt") + var server_key = load("res://my_server_key.key") + var server_tls_options = TLSOptions.server(server_certs, server_key) + [/gdscript] + [/codeblocks] + </description> + <tutorials> + </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="client" qualifiers="static"> + <return type="TLSOptions" /> + <param index="0" name="trusted_chain" type="X509Certificate" default="null" /> + <param index="1" name="common_name_override" type="String" default="""" /> + <description> + Creates a TLS client configuration which validates certificates and their common names (fully qualified domain names). + You can specify a custom [param trusted_chain] of certification authorities (the default CA list will be used if [code]null[/code]), and optionally provide a [param common_name_override] if you expect the certificate to have a common name other then the server FQDN. + Note: On the Web plafrom, TLS verification is always enforced against the CA list of the web browser. This is considered a security feature. + </description> + </method> + <method name="client_unsafe" qualifiers="static"> + <return type="TLSOptions" /> + <param index="0" name="trusted_chain" type="X509Certificate" default="null" /> + <description> + Creates an [b]unsafe[/b] TLS client configuration where certificate validation is optional. You can optionally provide a valid [param trusted_chain], but the common name of the certififcates will never be checked. Using this configuration for purposes other than testing [b]is not recommended[/b]. + Note: On the Web plafrom, TLS verification is always enforced against the CA list of the web browser. This is considered a security feature. + </description> + </method> + <method name="server" qualifiers="static"> + <return type="TLSOptions" /> + <param index="0" name="key" type="CryptoKey" /> + <param index="1" name="certificate" type="X509Certificate" /> + <description> + Creates a TLS server configuration using the provided [param key] and [param certificate]. + Note: The [param certificate] should include the full certificate chain up to the signing CA (certificates file can be concatenated using a general purpose text editor). + </description> + </method> + </methods> +</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/TextEdit.xml b/doc/classes/TextEdit.xml index 1efd0f9326..c309026aaa 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TextEdit.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TextEdit.xml @@ -390,6 +390,45 @@ <return type="PopupMenu" /> <description> Returns the [PopupMenu] of this [TextEdit]. By default, this menu is displayed when right-clicking on the [TextEdit]. + You can add custom menu items or remove standard ones. Make sure your IDs don't conflict with the standard ones (see [enum MenuItems]). For example: + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + func _ready(): + var menu = get_menu() + # Remove all items after "Redo". + menu.item_count = menu.get_item_index(MENU_REDO) + 1 + # Add custom items. + menu.add_separator() + menu.add_item("Insert Date", MENU_MAX + 1) + # Connect callback. + menu.id_pressed.connect(_on_item_pressed) + + func _on_item_pressed(id): + if id == MENU_MAX + 1: + insert_text_at_caret(Time.get_date_string_from_system()) + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + public override void _Ready() + { + var menu = GetMenu(); + // Remove all items after "Redo". + menu.ItemCount = menu.GetItemIndex(TextEdit.MenuItems.Redo) + 1; + // Add custom items. + menu.AddSeparator(); + menu.AddItem("Insert Date", TextEdit.MenuItems.Max + 1); + // Add event handler. + menu.IdPressed += OnItemPressed; + } + + public void OnItemPressed(int id) + { + if (id == TextEdit.MenuItems.Max + 1) + { + InsertTextAtCaret(Time.GetDateStringFromSystem()); + } + } + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] [b]Warning:[/b] This is a required internal node, removing and freeing it may cause a crash. If you wish to hide it or any of its children, use their [member Window.visible] property. </description> </method> @@ -682,7 +721,7 @@ <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="option" type="int" /> <description> - Triggers a right-click menu action by the specified index. See [enum MenuItems] for a list of available indexes. + Executes a given action as defined in the [enum MenuItems] enum. </description> </method> <method name="merge_gutters"> @@ -696,7 +735,7 @@ <method name="merge_overlapping_carets"> <return type="void" /> <description> - Merges any overlapping carets. Will favour the newest caret, or the caret with a selection. + Merges any overlapping carets. Will favor the newest caret, or the caret with a selection. [b]Note:[/b] This is not called when a caret changes position but after certain actions, so it is possible to get into a state where carets overlap. </description> </method> @@ -764,18 +803,18 @@ [codeblocks] [gdscript] var result = search("print", SEARCH_WHOLE_WORDS, 0, 0) - if result.x != -1: + if result.x != -1: # Result found. var line_number = result.y var column_number = result.x [/gdscript] [csharp] - Vector2i result = Search("print", (uint)TextEdit.SearchFlags.WholeWords, 0, 0); - if (result.Length > 0) + Vector2I result = Search("print", (uint)TextEdit.SearchFlags.WholeWords, 0, 0); + if (result.X != -1) { // Result found. - int lineNumber = result.y; - int columnNumber = result.x; + int lineNumber = result.Y; + int columnNumber = result.X; } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -1224,70 +1263,76 @@ <constant name="MENU_REDO" value="6" enum="MenuItems"> Redoes the previous action. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_INHERITED" value="7" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_SUBMENU_TEXT_DIR" value="7" enum="MenuItems"> + ID of "Text Writing Direction" submenu. + </constant> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_INHERITED" value="8" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to inherited. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_AUTO" value="8" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_AUTO" value="9" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to automatic. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_LTR" value="9" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_LTR" value="10" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to left-to-right. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DIR_RTL" value="10" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DIR_RTL" value="11" enum="MenuItems"> Sets text direction to right-to-left. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_DISPLAY_UCC" value="11" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_DISPLAY_UCC" value="12" enum="MenuItems"> Toggles control character display. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRM" value="12" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_SUBMENU_INSERT_UCC" value="13" enum="MenuItems"> + ID of "Insert Control Character" submenu. + </constant> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRM" value="14" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts left-to-right mark (LRM) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLM" value="13" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLM" value="15" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts right-to-left mark (RLM) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRE" value="14" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRE" value="16" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of left-to-right embedding (LRE) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLE" value="15" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLE" value="17" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of right-to-left embedding (RLE) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRO" value="16" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRO" value="18" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of left-to-right override (LRO) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLO" value="17" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLO" value="19" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts start of right-to-left override (RLO) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDF" value="18" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDF" value="20" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts pop direction formatting (PDF) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ALM" value="19" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ALM" value="21" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts Arabic letter mark (ALM) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRI" value="20" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_LRI" value="22" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts left-to-right isolate (LRI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLI" value="21" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_RLI" value="23" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts right-to-left isolate (RLI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_FSI" value="22" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_FSI" value="24" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts first strong isolate (FSI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDI" value="23" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_PDI" value="25" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts pop direction isolate (PDI) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWJ" value="24" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWJ" value="26" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts zero width joiner (ZWJ) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWNJ" value="25" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_ZWNJ" value="27" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts zero width non-joiner (ZWNJ) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_WJ" value="26" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_WJ" value="28" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts word joiner (WJ) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_INSERT_SHY" value="27" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_INSERT_SHY" value="29" enum="MenuItems"> Inserts soft hyphen (SHY) character. </constant> - <constant name="MENU_MAX" value="28" enum="MenuItems"> + <constant name="MENU_MAX" value="30" enum="MenuItems"> Represents the size of the [enum MenuItems] enum. </constant> <constant name="ACTION_NONE" value="0" enum="EditAction"> diff --git a/doc/classes/TextServer.xml b/doc/classes/TextServer.xml index d2c6dee373..711fb89217 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TextServer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TextServer.xml @@ -1042,7 +1042,7 @@ </description> </method> <method name="parse_structured_text" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector2i[]" /> + <return type="Vector3i[]" /> <param index="0" name="parser_type" type="int" enum="TextServer.StructuredTextParser" /> <param index="1" name="args" type="Array" /> <param index="2" name="text" type="String" /> @@ -1634,6 +1634,9 @@ <constant name="DIRECTION_RTL" value="2" enum="Direction"> Text is written from right to left. </constant> + <constant name="DIRECTION_INHERITED" value="3" enum="Direction"> + Text writing direction is the same as base string writing direction. Used for BiDi override only. + </constant> <constant name="ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL" value="0" enum="Orientation"> Text is written horizontally. </constant> @@ -1881,7 +1884,7 @@ Font have fixed-width characters. </constant> <constant name="STRUCTURED_TEXT_DEFAULT" value="0" enum="StructuredTextParser"> - Use default behavior. Same as [constant STRUCTURED_TEXT_NONE] unless specified otherwise in the control description. + Use default Unicode BiDi algorithm. </constant> <constant name="STRUCTURED_TEXT_URI" value="1" enum="StructuredTextParser"> BiDi override for URI. @@ -1896,8 +1899,8 @@ BiDi override for lists. Structured text options: list separator [code]String[/code]. </constant> - <constant name="STRUCTURED_TEXT_NONE" value="5" enum="StructuredTextParser"> - Use default Unicode BiDi algorithm. + <constant name="STRUCTURED_TEXT_GDSCRIPT" value="5" enum="StructuredTextParser"> + BiDi override for GDScript. </constant> <constant name="STRUCTURED_TEXT_CUSTOM" value="6" enum="StructuredTextParser"> User defined structured text BiDi override function. diff --git a/doc/classes/TextServerExtension.xml b/doc/classes/TextServerExtension.xml index e144b09eb6..f4b306cf96 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TextServerExtension.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TextServerExtension.xml @@ -896,7 +896,7 @@ </description> </method> <method name="_parse_structured_text" qualifiers="virtual const"> - <return type="Vector2i[]" /> + <return type="Vector3i[]" /> <param index="0" name="parser_type" type="int" enum="TextServer.StructuredTextParser" /> <param index="1" name="args" type="Array" /> <param index="2" name="text" type="String" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/Texture2D.xml b/doc/classes/Texture2D.xml index aac197090a..7329ebb868 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Texture2D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Texture2D.xml @@ -74,6 +74,12 @@ Called when a pixel's opaque state in the [Texture2D] is queried at the specified [code](x, y)[/code] position. </description> </method> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderTexture2D]). + </description> + </method> <method name="draw" qualifiers="const"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="canvas_item" type="RID" /> diff --git a/doc/classes/Texture2DArray.xml b/doc/classes/Texture2DArray.xml index ec00198db1..6c9fb55bef 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Texture2DArray.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Texture2DArray.xml @@ -10,4 +10,12 @@ </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderTexture2DArray]). + </description> + </method> + </methods> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Texture3D.xml b/doc/classes/Texture3D.xml index 1a66932d62..d2df82a74d 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Texture3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Texture3D.xml @@ -47,6 +47,12 @@ Called when the presence of mipmaps in the [Texture3D] is queried. </description> </method> + <method name="create_placeholder" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Resource" /> + <description> + Creates a placeholder version of this resource ([PlaceholderTexture3D]). + </description> + </method> <method name="get_data" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Image[]" /> <description> diff --git a/doc/classes/TileData.xml b/doc/classes/TileData.xml index f815b8d0c3..bedc52abd1 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TileData.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TileData.xml @@ -218,7 +218,7 @@ <member name="terrain_set" type="int" setter="set_terrain_set" getter="get_terrain_set" default="-1"> ID of the terrain set that the tile uses. </member> - <member name="texture_offset" type="Vector2i" setter="set_texture_offset" getter="get_texture_offset" default="Vector2i(0, 0)"> + <member name="texture_origin" type="Vector2i" setter="set_texture_origin" getter="get_texture_origin" default="Vector2i(0, 0)"> Offsets the position of where the tile is drawn. </member> <member name="transpose" type="bool" setter="set_transpose" getter="get_transpose" default="false"> diff --git a/doc/classes/TileMap.xml b/doc/classes/TileMap.xml index 8176901ff7..c387bd435b 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TileMap.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TileMap.xml @@ -104,7 +104,8 @@ <param index="1" name="coords" type="Vector2i" /> <param index="2" name="use_proxies" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Returns the tile source ID of the cell on layer [param layer] at coordinates [param coords]. If [param use_proxies] is [code]false[/code], ignores the [TileSet]'s tile proxies, returning the raw alternative identifier. See [method TileSet.map_tile_proxy]. + Returns the tile source ID of the cell on layer [param layer] at coordinates [param coords]. Returns [code]-1[/code] if the cell does not exist. + If [param use_proxies] is [code]false[/code], ignores the [TileSet]'s tile proxies, returning the raw alternative identifier. See [method TileSet.map_tile_proxy]. </description> </method> <method name="get_cell_tile_data" qualifiers="const"> @@ -113,8 +114,17 @@ <param index="1" name="coords" type="Vector2i" /> <param index="2" name="use_proxies" type="bool" default="false" /> <description> - Returns the [TileData] object associated with the given cell, or [code]null[/code] if the cell is not a [TileSetAtlasSource]. + Returns the [TileData] object associated with the given cell, or [code]null[/code] if the cell does not exist or is not a [TileSetAtlasSource]. If [param use_proxies] is [code]false[/code], ignores the [TileSet]'s tile proxies, returning the raw alternative identifier. See [method TileSet.map_tile_proxy]. + [codeblock] + func get_clicked_tile_power(): + var clicked_cell = tile_map.local_to_map(tile_map.get_local_mouse_position()) + var data = tile_map.get_cell_tile_data(0, clicked_cell) + if data: + return data.get_custom_data("power") + else: + return 0 + [/codeblock] </description> </method> <method name="get_coords_for_body_rid"> @@ -185,7 +195,19 @@ <return type="Vector2i[]" /> <param index="0" name="layer" type="int" /> <description> - Returns a [Vector2] array with the positions of all cells containing a tile in the given layer. A cell is considered empty if its source identifier equals -1, its atlas coordinates identifiers is [code]Vector2(-1, -1)[/code] and its alternative identifier is -1. + Returns a [Vector2i] array with the positions of all cells containing a tile in the given layer. A cell is considered empty if its source identifier equals -1, its atlas coordinates identifiers is [code]Vector2(-1, -1)[/code] and its alternative identifier is -1. + </description> + </method> + <method name="get_used_cells_by_id" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Vector2i[]" /> + <param index="0" name="layer" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="source_id" type="int" default="-1" /> + <param index="2" name="atlas_coords" type="Vector2i" default="Vector2i(-1, -1)" /> + <param index="3" name="alternative_tile" type="int" default="-1" /> + <description> + Returns a [Vector2i] array with the positions of all cells containing a tile in the given layer. Tiles may be filtered according to their source ([param source_id]), their atlas coordinates ([param atlas_coords]) or alternative id ([param source_id]). + If a parameter has it's value set to the default one, this parameter is not used to filter a cell. Thus, if all parameters have their respective default value, this method returns the same result as [method get_used_cells]. + A cell is considered empty if its source identifier equals -1, its atlas coordinates identifiers is [code]Vector2(-1, -1)[/code] and its alternative identifier is -1. </description> </method> <method name="get_used_rect"> @@ -229,7 +251,7 @@ <param index="0" name="map_position" type="Vector2i" /> <description> Returns the centered position of a cell in the TileMap's local coordinate space. To convert the returned value into global coordinates, use [method Node2D.to_global]. See also [method local_to_map]. - [b]Note:[/b] This may not correspond to the visual position of the tile, i.e. it ignores the [member TileData.texture_offset] property of individual tiles. + [b]Note:[/b] This may not correspond to the visual position of the tile, i.e. it ignores the [member TileData.texture_origin] property of individual tiles. </description> </method> <method name="move_layer"> diff --git a/doc/classes/TileSet.xml b/doc/classes/TileSet.xml index 7fc6ba8161..a39a43be4c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TileSet.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TileSet.xml @@ -143,6 +143,14 @@ Returns the custom data layers count. </description> </method> + <method name="get_navigation_layer_layer_value" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <param index="0" name="layer_index" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="layer_number" type="int" /> + <description> + Returns whether or not the specified navigation layer of the TileSet navigation data layer identified by the given [param layer_index] is enabled, given a navigation_layers [param layer_number] between 1 and 32. + </description> + </method> <method name="get_navigation_layer_layers" qualifiers="const"> <return type="int" /> <param index="0" name="layer_index" type="int" /> @@ -500,6 +508,15 @@ Sets the type of the custom data layer identified by the given index. </description> </method> + <method name="set_navigation_layer_layer_value"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="layer_index" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="layer_number" type="int" /> + <param index="2" name="value" type="bool" /> + <description> + Based on [param value], enables or disables the specified navigation layer of the TileSet navigation data layer identified by the given [param layer_index], given a navigation_layers [param layer_number] between 1 and 32. + </description> + </method> <method name="set_navigation_layer_layers"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="layer_index" type="int" /> @@ -589,7 +606,7 @@ <param index="0" name="terrain_set" type="int" /> <param index="1" name="mode" type="int" enum="TileSet.TerrainMode" /> <description> - Sets a terrain mode. Each mode determines which bits of a tile shape is used to match the neighbouring tiles' terrains. + Sets a terrain mode. Each mode determines which bits of a tile shape is used to match the neighboring tiles' terrains. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/Transform3D.xml b/doc/classes/Transform3D.xml index b3145ea022..90c10e3664 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Transform3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Transform3D.xml @@ -41,6 +41,7 @@ <return type="Transform3D" /> <param index="0" name="from" type="Projection" /> <description> + Constructs a Transform3D from a [Projection] by trimming the last row of the projection matrix ([code]from.x.w[/code], [code]from.y.w[/code], [code]from.z.w[/code], and [code]from.w.w[/code] are not copied over). </description> </constructor> <constructor name="Transform3D"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Tree.xml b/doc/classes/Tree.xml index bfabd2d97d..cf28dafcc9 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Tree.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Tree.xml @@ -45,11 +45,11 @@ <method name="create_item"> <return type="TreeItem" /> <param index="0" name="parent" type="TreeItem" default="null" /> - <param index="1" name="idx" type="int" default="-1" /> + <param index="1" name="index" type="int" default="-1" /> <description> Creates an item in the tree and adds it as a child of [param parent], which can be either a valid [TreeItem] or [code]null[/code]. If [param parent] is [code]null[/code], the root item will be the parent, or the new item will be the root itself if the tree is empty. - The new item will be the [param idx]th child of parent, or it will be the last child if there are not enough siblings. + The new item will be the [param index]-th child of parent, or it will be the last child if there are not enough siblings. </description> </method> <method name="deselect_all"> @@ -401,7 +401,7 @@ </signal> <signal name="item_activated"> <description> - Emitted when an item's label is double-clicked. + Emitted when an item is double-clicked, or selected with a [code]ui_accept[/code] input event (e.g. using [kbd]Enter[/kbd] or [kbd]Space[/kbd] on the keyboard). </description> </signal> <signal name="item_collapsed"> @@ -415,14 +415,14 @@ Emitted when a custom button is pressed (i.e. in a [constant TreeItem.CELL_MODE_CUSTOM] mode cell). </description> </signal> - <signal name="item_double_clicked"> + <signal name="item_edited"> <description> - Emitted when an item's icon is double-clicked. + Emitted when an item is edited. </description> </signal> - <signal name="item_edited"> + <signal name="item_icon_double_clicked"> <description> - Emitted when an item is edited. + Emitted when an item's icon is double-clicked. For a signal that emits when any part of the item is double-clicked, see [signal item_activated]. </description> </signal> <signal name="item_mouse_selected"> diff --git a/doc/classes/TreeItem.xml b/doc/classes/TreeItem.xml index ec6b166e57..91248092d9 100644 --- a/doc/classes/TreeItem.xml +++ b/doc/classes/TreeItem.xml @@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ <param index="3" name="disabled" type="bool" default="false" /> <param index="4" name="tooltip_text" type="String" default="""" /> <description> - Adds a button with [Texture2D] [param button] at column [param column]. The [param id] is used to identify the button. If not specified, the next available index is used, which may be retrieved by calling [method get_button_count] immediately before this method. Optionally, the button can be [param disabled] and have a [param tooltip_text]. + Adds a button with [Texture2D] [param button] at column [param column]. The [param id] is used to identify the button in the according [signal Tree.button_clicked] signal and can be different from the buttons index. If not specified, the next available index is used, which may be retrieved by calling [method get_button_count] immediately before this method. Optionally, the button can be [param disabled] and have a [param tooltip_text]. </description> </method> <method name="call_recursive" qualifiers="vararg"> @@ -44,10 +44,10 @@ </method> <method name="create_child"> <return type="TreeItem" /> - <param index="0" name="idx" type="int" default="-1" /> + <param index="0" name="index" type="int" default="-1" /> <description> Creates an item and adds it as a child. - The new item will be inserted as position [param idx] (the default value [code]-1[/code] means the last position), or it will be the last child if [param idx] is higher than the child count. + The new item will be inserted as position [param index] (the default value [code]-1[/code] means the last position), or it will be the last child if [param index] is higher than the child count. </description> </method> <method name="deselect"> @@ -60,17 +60,17 @@ <method name="erase_button"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <description> - Removes the button at index [param button_idx] in column [param column]. + Removes the button at index [param button_index] in column [param column]. </description> </method> <method name="get_button" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Texture2D" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <description> - Returns the [Texture2D] of the button at index [param button_idx] in column [param column]. + Returns the [Texture2D] of the button at index [param button_index] in column [param column]. </description> </method> <method name="get_button_by_id" qualifiers="const"> @@ -91,17 +91,17 @@ <method name="get_button_id" qualifiers="const"> <return type="int" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <description> - Returns the ID for the button at index [param button_idx] in column [param column]. + Returns the ID for the button at index [param button_index] in column [param column]. </description> </method> <method name="get_button_tooltip_text" qualifiers="const"> <return type="String" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <description> - Returns the tooltip text for the button at index [param button_idx] in column [param column]. + Returns the tooltip text for the button at index [param button_index] in column [param column]. </description> </method> <method name="get_cell_mode" qualifiers="const"> @@ -113,9 +113,9 @@ </method> <method name="get_child"> <return type="TreeItem" /> - <param index="0" name="idx" type="int" /> + <param index="0" name="index" type="int" /> <description> - Returns a child item by its index (see [method get_child_count]). This method is often used for iterating all children of an item. + Returns a child item by its [param index] (see [method get_child_count]). This method is often used for iterating all children of an item. Negative indices access the children from the last one. </description> </method> @@ -332,9 +332,9 @@ <method name="is_button_disabled" qualifiers="const"> <return type="bool" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <description> - Returns [code]true[/code] if the button at index [param button_idx] for the given [param column] is disabled. + Returns [code]true[/code] if the button at index [param button_index] for the given [param column] is disabled. </description> </method> <method name="is_checked" qualifiers="const"> @@ -419,28 +419,28 @@ <method name="set_button"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <param index="2" name="button" type="Texture2D" /> <description> - Sets the given column's button [Texture2D] at index [param button_idx] to [param button]. + Sets the given column's button [Texture2D] at index [param button_index] to [param button]. </description> </method> <method name="set_button_color"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <param index="2" name="color" type="Color" /> <description> - Sets the given column's button color at index [param button_idx] to [param color]. + Sets the given column's button color at index [param button_index] to [param color]. </description> </method> <method name="set_button_disabled"> <return type="void" /> <param index="0" name="column" type="int" /> - <param index="1" name="button_idx" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="button_index" type="int" /> <param index="2" name="disabled" type="bool" /> <description> - If [code]true[/code], disables the button at index [param button_idx] in the given [param column]. + If [code]true[/code], disables the button at index [param button_index] in the given [param column]. </description> </method> <method name="set_cell_mode"> diff --git a/doc/classes/Tween.xml b/doc/classes/Tween.xml index eef35049e5..16e4ce3714 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Tween.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Tween.xml @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ [codeblocks] [gdscript] var tween = get_tree().create_tween() - tween.tween_property($Sprite, "modulate", Color.red, 1) + tween.tween_property($Sprite, "modulate", Color.RED, 1) tween.tween_property($Sprite, "scale", Vector2(), 1) tween.tween_callback($Sprite.queue_free) [/gdscript] @@ -19,7 +19,7 @@ Tween tween = GetTree().CreateTween(); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "modulate", Colors.Red, 1.0f); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "scale", Vector2.Zero, 1.0f); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(GetNode("Sprite").QueueFree)); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(GetNode("Sprite").QueueFree)); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] This sequence will make the [code]$Sprite[/code] node turn red, then shrink, before finally calling [method Node.queue_free] to free the sprite. [Tweener]s are executed one after another by default. This behavior can be changed using [method parallel] and [method set_parallel]. @@ -27,7 +27,7 @@ [codeblocks] [gdscript] var tween = get_tree().create_tween() - tween.tween_property($Sprite, "modulate", Color.red, 1).set_trans(Tween.TRANS_SINE) + tween.tween_property($Sprite, "modulate", Color.RED, 1).set_trans(Tween.TRANS_SINE) tween.tween_property($Sprite, "scale", Vector2(), 1).set_trans(Tween.TRANS_BOUNCE) tween.tween_callback($Sprite.queue_free) [/gdscript] @@ -35,14 +35,14 @@ Tween tween = GetTree().CreateTween(); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "modulate", Colors.Red, 1.0f).SetTrans(Tween.TransitionType.Sine); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "scale", Vector2.Zero, 1.0f).SetTrans(Tween.TransitionType.Bounce); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(GetNode("Sprite").QueueFree)); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(GetNode("Sprite").QueueFree)); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] Most of the [Tween] methods can be chained this way too. In the following example the [Tween] is bound to the running script's node and a default transition is set for its [Tweener]s: [codeblocks] [gdscript] var tween = get_tree().create_tween().bind_node(self).set_trans(Tween.TRANS_ELASTIC) - tween.tween_property($Sprite, "modulate", Color.red, 1) + tween.tween_property($Sprite, "modulate", Color.RED, 1) tween.tween_property($Sprite, "scale", Vector2(), 1) tween.tween_callback($Sprite.queue_free) [/gdscript] @@ -50,7 +50,7 @@ var tween = GetTree().CreateTween().BindNode(this).SetTrans(Tween.TransitionType.Elastic); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "modulate", Colors.Red, 1.0f); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "scale", Vector2.Zero, 1.0f); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(GetNode("Sprite").QueueFree)); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(GetNode("Sprite").QueueFree)); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] Another interesting use for [Tween]s is animating arbitrary sets of objects: @@ -77,13 +77,13 @@ tween = create_tween() [/gdscript] [csharp] - private Tween tween; + private Tween _tween; public void Animate() { - if (tween != null) - tween.Kill(); // Abort the previous animation - tween = CreateTween(); + if (_tween != null) + _tween.Kill(); // Abort the previous animation + _tween = CreateTween(); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -281,21 +281,21 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] Tween tween = GetTree().CreateTween().SetLoops(); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(Shoot)).SetDelay(1.0f); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(Shoot)).SetDelay(1.0f); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Example:[/b] Turning a sprite red and then blue, with 2 second delay: [codeblocks] [gdscript] var tween = get_tree().create_tween() - tween.tween_callback($Sprite.set_modulate.bind(Color.red)).set_delay(2) - tween.tween_callback($Sprite.set_modulate.bind(Color.blue)).set_delay(2) + tween.tween_callback($Sprite.set_modulate.bind(Color.RED)).set_delay(2) + tween.tween_callback($Sprite.set_modulate.bind(Color.BLUE)).set_delay(2) [/gdscript] [csharp] Tween tween = GetTree().CreateTween(); Sprite2D sprite = GetNode<Sprite2D>("Sprite"); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(() => sprite.Modulate = Colors.Red)).SetDelay(2.0f); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(() => sprite.Modulate = Colors.Blue)).SetDelay(2.0f); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(() => sprite.Modulate = Colors.Red)).SetDelay(2.0f); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(() => sprite.Modulate = Colors.Blue)).SetDelay(2.0f); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] </description> @@ -332,10 +332,10 @@ [csharp] Tween tween = CreateTween().SetLoops(); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "position:x", 200.0f, 1.0f).AsRelative(); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(Jump)); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(Jump)); tween.TweenInterval(2.0f); tween.TweenProperty(GetNode("Sprite"), "position:x", -200.0f, 1.0f).AsRelative(); - tween.TweenCallback(new Callable(Jump)); + tween.TweenCallback(Callable.From(Jump)); tween.TweenInterval(2.0f); [/csharp] [/codeblocks] @@ -357,7 +357,7 @@ [/gdscript] [csharp] Tween tween = CreateTween(); - tween.TweenMethod(new Callable(() => LookAt(Vector3.Up)), new Vector3(-1.0f, 0.0f, -1.0f), new Vector3(1.0f, 0.0f, -1.0f), 1.0f); // The LookAt() method takes up vector as second argument. + tween.TweenMethod(Callable.From(() => LookAt(Vector3.Up)), new Vector3(-1.0f, 0.0f, -1.0f), new Vector3(1.0f, 0.0f, -1.0f), 1.0f); // The LookAt() method takes up vector as second argument. [/csharp] [/codeblocks] [b]Example:[/b] Setting the text of a [Label], using an intermediate method and after a delay: @@ -376,7 +376,7 @@ base._Ready(); Tween tween = CreateTween(); - tween.TweenMethod(new Callable(SetLabelText), 0.0f, 10.0f, 1.0f).SetDelay(1.0f); + tween.TweenMethod(Callable.From<int>(SetLabelText), 0.0f, 10.0f, 1.0f).SetDelay(1.0f); } private void SetLabelText(int value) diff --git a/doc/classes/UDPServer.xml b/doc/classes/UDPServer.xml index c3a3a49a80..8151ecb625 100644 --- a/doc/classes/UDPServer.xml +++ b/doc/classes/UDPServer.xml @@ -9,7 +9,8 @@ Below a small example of how it can be used: [codeblocks] [gdscript] - class_name Server + # server_node.gd + class_name ServerNode extends Node var server := UDPServer.new() @@ -34,35 +35,35 @@ pass # Do something with the connected peers. [/gdscript] [csharp] + // ServerNode.cs using Godot; - using System; using System.Collections.Generic; - public class Server : Node + public partial class ServerNode : Node { - public UDPServer Server = new UDPServer(); - public List<PacketPeerUDP> Peers = new List<PacketPeerUDP>(); + private UdpServer _server = new UdpServer(); + private List<PacketPeerUdp> _peers = new List<PacketPeerUdp>(); public override void _Ready() { - Server.Listen(4242); + _server.Listen(4242); } - public override void _Process(float delta) + public override void _Process(double delta) { - Server.Poll(); // Important! - if (Server.IsConnectionAvailable()) + _server.Poll(); // Important! + if (_server.IsConnectionAvailable()) { - PacketPeerUDP peer = Server.TakeConnection(); + PacketPeerUdp peer = _server.TakeConnection(); byte[] packet = peer.GetPacket(); - GD.Print($"Accepted Peer: {peer.GetPacketIp()}:{peer.GetPacketPort()}"); - GD.Print($"Received Data: {packet.GetStringFromUTF8()}"); + GD.Print($"Accepted Peer: {peer.GetPacketIP()}:{peer.GetPacketPort()}"); + GD.Print($"Received Data: {packet.GetStringFromUtf8()}"); // Reply so it knows we received the message. peer.PutPacket(packet); // Keep a reference so we can keep contacting the remote peer. - Peers.Add(peer); + _peers.Add(peer); } - foreach (var peer in Peers) + foreach (var peer in _peers) { // Do something with the peers. } @@ -72,7 +73,8 @@ [/codeblocks] [codeblocks] [gdscript] - class_name Client + # client_node.gd + class_name ClientNode extends Node var udp := PacketPeerUDP.new() @@ -90,30 +92,30 @@ connected = true [/gdscript] [csharp] + // ClientNode.cs using Godot; - using System; - public class Client : Node + public partial class ClientNode : Node { - public PacketPeerUDP Udp = new PacketPeerUDP(); - public bool Connected = false; + private PacketPeerUdp _udp = new PacketPeerUdp(); + private bool _connected = false; public override void _Ready() { - Udp.ConnectToHost("127.0.0.1", 4242); + _udp.ConnectToHost("127.0.0.1", 4242); } - public override void _Process(float delta) + public override void _Process(double delta) { - if (!Connected) + if (!_connected) { // Try to contact server - Udp.PutPacket("The Answer Is..42!".ToUTF8()); + _udp.PutPacket("The Answer Is..42!".ToUtf8()); } - if (Udp.GetAvailablePacketCount() > 0) + if (_udp.GetAvailablePacketCount() > 0) { - GD.Print($"Connected: {Udp.GetPacket().GetStringFromUTF8()}"); - Connected = true; + GD.Print($"Connected: {_udp.GetPacket().GetStringFromUtf8()}"); + _connected = true; } } } diff --git a/doc/classes/UndoRedo.xml b/doc/classes/UndoRedo.xml index 7258efbdda..e43bceb941 100644 --- a/doc/classes/UndoRedo.xml +++ b/doc/classes/UndoRedo.xml @@ -17,7 +17,7 @@ func undo_something(): pass # Put here the code that reverts what's done by "do_something()". - func _on_MyButton_pressed(): + func _on_my_button_pressed(): var node = get_node("MyNode2D") undo_redo.create_action("Move the node") undo_redo.add_do_method(self, "do_something") @@ -27,11 +27,11 @@ undo_redo.commit_action() [/gdscript] [csharp] - public UndoRedo UndoRedo; + private UndoRedo _undoRedo; public override void _Ready() { - UndoRedo = GetUndoRedo(); // Method of EditorPlugin. + _undoRedo = GetUndoRedo(); // Method of EditorPlugin. } public void DoSomething() @@ -47,12 +47,12 @@ private void OnMyButtonPressed() { var node = GetNode<Node2D>("MyNode2D"); - UndoRedo.CreateAction("Move the node"); - UndoRedo.AddDoMethod(this, nameof(DoSomething)); - UndoRedo.AddUndoMethod(this, nameof(UndoSomething)); - UndoRedo.AddDoProperty(node, "position", new Vector2(100, 100)); - UndoRedo.AddUndoProperty(node, "position", node.Position); - UndoRedo.CommitAction(); + _undoRedo.CreateAction("Move the node"); + _undoRedo.AddDoMethod(new Callable(this, MethodName.DoSomething)); + _undoRedo.AddUndoMethod(new Callable(this, MethodName.UndoSomething)); + _undoRedo.AddDoProperty(node, "position", new Vector2(100, 100)); + _undoRedo.AddUndoProperty(node, "position", node.Position); + _undoRedo.CommitAction(); } [/csharp] [/codeblocks] diff --git a/doc/classes/Variant.xml b/doc/classes/Variant.xml index 6b384d6a77..5416468ab6 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Variant.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Variant.xml @@ -38,7 +38,7 @@ # To get the name of the underlying Object type, you need the `get_class()` method. print("foo is a(n) %s" % foo.get_class()) # inject the class name into a formatted string. # Note also that there is not yet any way to get a script's `class_name` string easily. - # To fetch that value, you need to dig deeply into a hidden ProjectSettings setting: an Array of Dictionaries called "_global_script_classes". + # To fetch that value, you can parse the [code]res://.godot/global_script_class_cache.cfg[/code] file with the [ConfigFile] API. # Open your project.godot file to see it up close. [/gdscript] [csharp] @@ -70,6 +70,6 @@ Modifications to a container will modify all references to it. A [Mutex] should be created to lock it if multi-threaded access is desired. </description> <tutorials> - <link title="Variant class">$DOCS_URL/development/cpp/variant_class.html</link> + <link title="Variant class introduction">$DOCS_URL/contributing/development/core_and_modules/variant_class.html</link> </tutorials> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/VehicleBody3D.xml b/doc/classes/VehicleBody3D.xml index e1689133de..9f905c0ec5 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VehicleBody3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VehicleBody3D.xml @@ -7,6 +7,7 @@ This node implements all the physics logic needed to simulate a car. It is based on the raycast vehicle system commonly found in physics engines. You will need to add a [CollisionShape3D] for the main body of your vehicle and add [VehicleWheel3D] nodes for the wheels. You should also add a [MeshInstance3D] to this node for the 3D model of your car but this model should not include meshes for the wheels. You should control the vehicle by using the [member brake], [member engine_force], and [member steering] properties and not change the position or orientation of this node directly. [b]Note:[/b] The origin point of your VehicleBody3D will determine the center of gravity of your vehicle so it is better to keep this low and move the [CollisionShape3D] and [MeshInstance3D] upwards. [b]Note:[/b] This class has known issues and isn't designed to provide realistic 3D vehicle physics. If you want advanced vehicle physics, you will probably have to write your own physics integration using another [PhysicsBody3D] class. + [b]Warning:[/b] With a non-uniform scale this node will probably not function as expected. Please make sure to keep its scale uniform (i.e. the same on all axes), and change the size(s) of its collision shape(s) instead. </description> <tutorials> <link title="3D Truck Town Demo">https://godotengine.org/asset-library/asset/524</link> diff --git a/doc/classes/VideoStream.xml b/doc/classes/VideoStream.xml index 2797ad3513..648c3edd73 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VideoStream.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VideoStream.xml @@ -8,4 +8,18 @@ </description> <tutorials> </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="_instantiate_playback" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="VideoStreamPlayback" /> + <description> + Called when the video starts playing, to initialize and return a subclass of [VideoStreamPlayback]. + </description> + </method> + </methods> + <members> + <member name="file" type="String" setter="set_file" getter="get_file" default=""""> + The video file path or URI that this [VideoStream] resource handles. + For [VideoStreamTheora], this filename should be an Ogg Theora video file with the [code].ogv[/code] extension. + </member> + </members> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/VideoStreamPlayback.xml b/doc/classes/VideoStreamPlayback.xml new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8d8b4fe5b1 --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/classes/VideoStreamPlayback.xml @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8" ?> +<class name="VideoStreamPlayback" inherits="Resource" version="4.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance" xsi:noNamespaceSchemaLocation="../class.xsd"> + <brief_description> + Internal class used by [VideoStream] to manage playback state when played from a [VideoStreamPlayer]. + </brief_description> + <description> + This class is intended to be overridden by video decoder extensions with custom implementations of [VideoStream]. + </description> + <tutorials> + </tutorials> + <methods> + <method name="_get_channels" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="int" /> + <description> + Returns the number of audio channels. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_get_length" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="float" /> + <description> + Returns the video duration in seconds, if known, or 0 if unknown. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_get_mix_rate" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="int" /> + <description> + Returns the audio sample rate used for mixing. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_get_playback_position" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="float" /> + <description> + Return the current playback timestamp. Called in response to the [member VideoStreamPlayer.stream_position] getter. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_get_texture" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="Texture2D" /> + <description> + Allocates a [Texture2D] in which decoded video frames will be drawn. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_is_paused" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns the paused status, as set by [method _set_paused]. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_is_playing" qualifiers="virtual const"> + <return type="bool" /> + <description> + Returns the playback state, as determined by calls to [method _play] and [method _stop]. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_play" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Called in response to [member VideoStreamPlayer.autoplay] or [method VideoStreamPlayer.play]. Note that manual playback may also invoke [method _stop] multiple times before this method is called. [method _is_playing] should return true once playing. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_seek" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="time" type="float" /> + <description> + Seeks to [code]time[/code] seconds. Called in response to the [member VideoStreamPlayer.stream_position] setter. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_set_audio_track" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="idx" type="int" /> + <description> + Select the audio track [code]idx[/code]. Called when playback starts, and in response to the [member VideoStreamPlayer.audio_track] setter. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_set_paused" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="paused" type="bool" /> + <description> + Set the paused status of video playback. [method _is_paused] must return [code]paused[/code]. Called in response to the [member VideoStreamPlayer.paused] setter. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_stop" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="void" /> + <description> + Stops playback. May be called multiple times before [method _play], or in response to [method VideoStreamPlayer.stop]. [method _is_playing] should return false once stopped. + </description> + </method> + <method name="_update" qualifiers="virtual"> + <return type="void" /> + <param index="0" name="delta" type="float" /> + <description> + Ticks video playback for [code]delta[/code] seconds. Called every frame as long as [method _is_paused] and [method _is_playing] return true. + </description> + </method> + <method name="mix_audio"> + <return type="int" /> + <param index="0" name="num_frames" type="int" /> + <param index="1" name="buffer" type="PackedFloat32Array" default="PackedFloat32Array()" /> + <param index="2" name="offset" type="int" default="0" /> + <description> + Render [code]num_frames[/code] audio frames (of [method _get_channels] floats each) from [code]buffer[/code], starting from index [code]offset[/code] in the array. Returns the number of audio frames rendered, or -1 on error. + </description> + </method> + </methods> +</class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Viewport.xml b/doc/classes/Viewport.xml index 236d34383f..ab2de14638 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Viewport.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Viewport.xml @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ <method name="get_final_transform" qualifiers="const"> <return type="Transform2D" /> <description> - Returns the total transform of the viewport. + Returns the transform from the viewport's coordinate system to the embedder's coordinate system. </description> </method> <method name="get_mouse_position" qualifiers="const"> @@ -210,6 +210,7 @@ <param index="0" name="position" type="Vector2" /> <description> Moves the mouse pointer to the specified position in this [Viewport] using the coordinate system of this [Viewport]. + [b]Note:[/b] [method warp_mouse] is only supported on Windows, macOS and Linux. It has no effect on Android, iOS and Web. </description> </method> </methods> diff --git a/doc/classes/VisualInstance3D.xml b/doc/classes/VisualInstance3D.xml index e069642e50..3781045c02 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VisualInstance3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VisualInstance3D.xml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ <member name="sorting_offset" type="float" setter="set_sorting_offset" getter="get_sorting_offset" default="0.0"> The sorting offset used by this [VisualInstance3D]. Adjusting it to a higher value will make the [VisualInstance3D] reliably draw on top of other [VisualInstance3D]s that are otherwise positioned at the same spot. </member> - <member name="sorting_use_aabb_center" type="bool" setter="set_sorting_use_aabb_center" getter="is_sorting_use_aabb_center" default="true"> + <member name="sorting_use_aabb_center" type="bool" setter="set_sorting_use_aabb_center" getter="is_sorting_use_aabb_center"> If [code]true[/code], the object is sorted based on the [AABB] center. The object will be sorted based on the global position otherwise. The [AABB] center based sorting is generally more accurate for 3D models. The position based sorting instead allows to better control the drawing order when working with [GPUParticles3D] and [CPUParticles3D]. </member> diff --git a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNode.xml b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNode.xml index f95f871e52..685f5d5eef 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNode.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNode.xml @@ -58,13 +58,6 @@ Sets the output port index which will be showed for preview. If set to [code]-1[/code] no port will be open for preview. </member> </members> - <signals> - <signal name="editor_refresh_request"> - <description> - Emitted when the node requests an editor refresh. Currently called only in setter of [member VisualShaderNodeTexture.source], [VisualShaderNodeTexture], and [VisualShaderNodeCubemap] (and their derivatives). - </description> - </signal> - </signals> <constants> <constant name="PORT_TYPE_SCALAR" value="0" enum="PortType"> Floating-point scalar. Translated to [code]float[/code] type in shader code. diff --git a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeDerivativeFunc.xml b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeDerivativeFunc.xml index 9a1ad53394..4a31969171 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeDerivativeFunc.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeDerivativeFunc.xml @@ -15,6 +15,9 @@ <member name="op_type" type="int" setter="set_op_type" getter="get_op_type" enum="VisualShaderNodeDerivativeFunc.OpType" default="0"> A type of operands and returned value. See [enum OpType] for options. </member> + <member name="precision" type="int" setter="set_precision" getter="get_precision" enum="VisualShaderNodeDerivativeFunc.Precision" default="0"> + Sets the level of precision to use for the derivative function. See [enum Precision] for options. When using the GL_Compatibility renderer, this setting has no effect. + </member> </members> <constants> <constant name="OP_TYPE_SCALAR" value="0" enum="OpType"> @@ -44,5 +47,17 @@ <constant name="FUNC_MAX" value="3" enum="Function"> Represents the size of the [enum Function] enum. </constant> + <constant name="PRECISION_NONE" value="0" enum="Precision"> + No precision is specified, the GPU driver is allowed to use whatever level of precision it chooses. This is the default option and is equivalent to using [code]dFdx()[/code] or [code]dFdy()[/code] in text shaders. + </constant> + <constant name="PRECISION_COARSE" value="1" enum="Precision"> + The derivative will be calculated using the current fragment's neighbors (which may not include the current fragment). This tends to be faster than using [constant PRECISION_FINE], but may not be suitable when more precision is needed. This is equivalent to using [code]dFdxCoarse()[/code] or [code]dFdyCoarse()[/code] in text shaders. + </constant> + <constant name="PRECISION_FINE" value="2" enum="Precision"> + The derivative will be calculated using the current fragment and its immediate neighbors. This tends to be slower than using [constant PRECISION_COARSE], but may be necessary when more precision is needed. This is equivalent to using [code]dFdxFine()[/code] or [code]dFdyFine()[/code] in text shaders. + </constant> + <constant name="PRECISION_MAX" value="3" enum="Precision"> + Represents the size of the [enum Precision] enum. + </constant> </constants> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTexture.xml b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTexture.xml index 72a7fadf1a..38fa98b21e 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTexture.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTexture.xml @@ -33,12 +33,18 @@ Use the texture from this shader's normal map built-in. </constant> <constant name="SOURCE_DEPTH" value="4" enum="Source"> - Use the depth texture available for this shader. + Use the depth texture captured during the depth prepass. Only available when the depth prepass is used (i.e. in spatial shaders and in the forward_plus or gl_compatibility renderers). </constant> <constant name="SOURCE_PORT" value="5" enum="Source"> Use the texture provided in the input port for this function. </constant> - <constant name="SOURCE_MAX" value="6" enum="Source"> + <constant name="SOURCE_3D_NORMAL" value="6" enum="Source"> + Use the normal buffer captured during the depth prepass. Only available when the normal-roughness buffer is available (i.e. in spatial shaders and in the forward_plus renderer). + </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_ROUGHNESS" value="7" enum="Source"> + Use the roughness buffer captured during the depth prepass. Only available when the normal-roughness buffer is available (i.e. in spatial shaders and in the forward_plus renderer). + </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_MAX" value="8" enum="Source"> Represents the size of the [enum Source] enum. </constant> <constant name="TYPE_DATA" value="0" enum="TextureType"> diff --git a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.xml b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.xml index 333226dc58..8a08bea659 100644 --- a/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.xml +++ b/doc/classes/VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.xml @@ -18,6 +18,9 @@ <member name="texture_repeat" type="int" setter="set_texture_repeat" getter="get_texture_repeat" enum="VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.TextureRepeat" default="0"> Sets the texture repeating mode. See [enum TextureRepeat] for options. </member> + <member name="texture_source" type="int" setter="set_texture_source" getter="get_texture_source" enum="VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.TextureSource" default="0"> + Sets the texture source mode. Used for reading from the screen, depth, or normal_roughness texture. see [enum TextureSource] for options. + </member> <member name="texture_type" type="int" setter="set_texture_type" getter="get_texture_type" enum="VisualShaderNodeTextureParameter.TextureType" default="0"> Defines the type of data provided by the source texture. See [enum TextureType] for options. </member> @@ -88,5 +91,20 @@ <constant name="REPEAT_MAX" value="3" enum="TextureRepeat"> Represents the size of the [enum TextureRepeat] enum. </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_NONE" value="0" enum="TextureSource"> + The texture source is not specified in the shader. + </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_SCREEN" value="1" enum="TextureSource"> + The texture source is the screen texture which captures all opaque objects drawn this frame. + </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_DEPTH" value="2" enum="TextureSource"> + The texture source is the depth texture from the depth prepass. + </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_NORMAL_ROUGHNESS" value="3" enum="TextureSource"> + The texture source is the normal-roughness buffer from the depth prepass. + </constant> + <constant name="SOURCE_MAX" value="4" enum="TextureSource"> + Represents the size of the [enum TextureSource] enum. + </constant> </constants> </class> diff --git a/doc/classes/Window.xml b/doc/classes/Window.xml index 4cd6cf41da..c4ea11ab66 100644 --- a/doc/classes/Window.xml +++ b/doc/classes/Window.xml @@ -527,6 +527,39 @@ Set's the window's current mode. [b]Note:[/b] Fullscreen mode is not exclusive full screen on Windows and Linux. </member> + <member name="mouse_passthrough" type="bool" setter="set_flag" getter="get_flag" default="false"> + If [code]true[/code], all mouse event as passed to the underlying window of the same application. See also [member mouse_passthrough_polygon]. + [b]Note:[/b] This property is implemented on Linux (X11), macOS and Windows. + </member> + <member name="mouse_passthrough_polygon" type="PackedVector2Array" setter="set_mouse_passthrough_polygon" getter="get_mouse_passthrough_polygon" default="PackedVector2Array()"> + Sets a polygonal region of the window which accepts mouse events. Mouse events outside the region will be passed through. + Passing an empty array will disable passthrough support (all mouse events will be intercepted by the window, which is the default behavior). + [codeblocks] + [gdscript] + # Set region, using Path2D node. + $Window.mouse_passthrough_polygon = $Path2D.curve.get_baked_points() + + # Set region, using Polygon2D node. + $Window.mouse_passthrough_polygon = $Polygon2D.polygon + + # Reset region to default. + $Window.mouse_passthrough_polygon = [] + [/gdscript] + [csharp] + // Set region, using Path2D node. + GetNode<Window>("Window").MousePassthrough = GetNode<Path2D>("Path2D").Curve.GetBakedPoints(); + + // Set region, using Polygon2D node. + GetNode<Window>("Window").MousePassthrough = GetNode<Polygon2D>("Polygon2D").Polygon; + + // Reset region to default. + GetNode<Window>("Window").MousePassthrough = new Vector2[] {}; + [/csharp] + [/codeblocks] + [b]Note:[/b] This property is ignored if [member mouse_passthrough] is set to [code]true[/code]. + [b]Note:[/b] On Windows, the portion of a window that lies outside the region is not drawn, while on Linux (X11) and macOS it is. + [b]Note:[/b] This property is implemented on Linux (X11), macOS and Windows. + </member> <member name="popup_window" type="bool" setter="set_flag" getter="get_flag" default="false"> If [code]true[/code], the [Window] will be considered a popup. Popups are sub-windows that don't show as separate windows in system's window manager's window list and will send close request when anything is clicked outside of them (unless [member exclusive] is enabled). </member> @@ -695,7 +728,10 @@ Window content is expanded to the full size of the window. Unlike borderless window, the frame is left intact and can be used to resize the window, title bar is transparent, but have minimize/maximize/close buttons. Set with [member extend_to_title]. [b]Note:[/b] This flag is implemented on macOS. </constant> - <constant name="FLAG_MAX" value="7" enum="Flags"> + <constant name="FLAG_MOUSE_PASSTHROUGH" value="7" enum="Flags"> + All mouse events are passed to the underlying window of the same application. + </constant> + <constant name="FLAG_MAX" value="8" enum="Flags"> Max value of the [enum Flags]. </constant> <constant name="CONTENT_SCALE_MODE_DISABLED" value="0" enum="ContentScaleMode"> @@ -735,8 +771,16 @@ Right-to-left layout direction. </constant> <constant name="WINDOW_INITIAL_POSITION_ABSOLUTE" value="0" enum="WindowInitialPosition"> + Initial window position is determined by [member position]. + </constant> + <constant name="WINDOW_INITIAL_POSITION_CENTER_PRIMARY_SCREEN" value="1" enum="WindowInitialPosition"> + Initial window position is a center of the primary screen. + </constant> + <constant name="WINDOW_INITIAL_POSITION_CENTER_MAIN_WINDOW_SCREEN" value="2" enum="WindowInitialPosition"> + Initial window position is a center of the main window screen. </constant> - <constant name="WINDOW_INITIAL_POSITION_CENTER_SCREEN" value="1" enum="WindowInitialPosition"> + <constant name="WINDOW_INITIAL_POSITION_CENTER_OTHER_SCREEN" value="3" enum="WindowInitialPosition"> + Initial window position is a center of [member current_screen] screen. </constant> </constants> <theme_items> diff --git a/doc/classes/XRController3D.xml b/doc/classes/XRController3D.xml index 9e192177e5..0b21002893 100644 --- a/doc/classes/XRController3D.xml +++ b/doc/classes/XRController3D.xml @@ -13,11 +13,18 @@ <link title="XR documentation index">$DOCS_URL/tutorials/xr/index.html</link> </tutorials> <methods> - <method name="get_axis" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="Vector2" /> + <method name="get_float" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="float" /> <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> <description> - Returns a [Vector2] for the input with the given [param name]. This is used for thumbsticks and thumbpads found on many controllers. + Returns a numeric value for the input with the given [param name]. This is used for triggers and grip sensors. + </description> + </method> + <method name="get_input" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Variant" /> + <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> + <description> + Returns a [Variant] for the input with the given [param name]. This works for any input type, the variant will be typed according to the actions configuration. </description> </method> <method name="get_tracker_hand" qualifiers="const"> @@ -26,11 +33,11 @@ Returns the hand holding this controller, if known. See [enum XRPositionalTracker.TrackerHand]. </description> </method> - <method name="get_value" qualifiers="const"> - <return type="float" /> + <method name="get_vector2" qualifiers="const"> + <return type="Vector2" /> <param index="0" name="name" type="StringName" /> <description> - Returns a numeric value for the input with the given [param name]. This is used for triggers and grip sensors. + Returns a [Vector2] for the input with the given [param name]. This is used for thumbsticks and thumbpads found on many controllers. </description> </method> <method name="is_button_pressed" qualifiers="const"> @@ -54,18 +61,18 @@ Emitted when a button on this controller is released. </description> </signal> - <signal name="input_axis_changed"> + <signal name="input_float_changed"> <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> - <param index="1" name="value" type="Vector2" /> + <param index="1" name="value" type="float" /> <description> - Emitted when a thumbstick or thumbpad on this controller is moved. + Emitted when a trigger or similar input on this controller changes value. </description> </signal> - <signal name="input_value_changed"> + <signal name="input_vector2_changed"> <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> - <param index="1" name="value" type="float" /> + <param index="1" name="value" type="Vector2" /> <description> - Emitted when a trigger or similar input on this controller changes value. + Emitted when a thumbstick or thumbpad on this controller is moved. </description> </signal> </signals> diff --git a/doc/classes/XRPositionalTracker.xml b/doc/classes/XRPositionalTracker.xml index db2910f25e..93e6a5497c 100644 --- a/doc/classes/XRPositionalTracker.xml +++ b/doc/classes/XRPositionalTracker.xml @@ -92,18 +92,18 @@ Emitted when a button on this tracker is released. </description> </signal> - <signal name="input_axis_changed"> + <signal name="input_float_changed"> <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> - <param index="1" name="vector" type="Vector2" /> + <param index="1" name="value" type="float" /> <description> - Emitted when a thumbstick or thumbpad on this tracker moves. + Emitted when a trigger or similar input on this tracker changes value. </description> </signal> - <signal name="input_value_changed"> + <signal name="input_vector2_changed"> <param index="0" name="name" type="String" /> - <param index="1" name="value" type="float" /> + <param index="1" name="vector" type="Vector2" /> <description> - Emitted when a trigger or similar input on this tracker changes value. + Emitted when a thumbstick or thumbpad on this tracker moves. </description> </signal> <signal name="pose_changed"> diff --git a/doc/classes/bool.xml b/doc/classes/bool.xml index d0ef664281..e1a98f0ea4 100644 --- a/doc/classes/bool.xml +++ b/doc/classes/bool.xml @@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ _can_shoot = false _cool_down.start() - func _on_CoolDownTimer_timeout(): + func _on_cool_down_timer_timeout(): _can_shoot = true [/gdscript] [csharp] |